Maintenance Manual of Two-wheeled Motorcycle IMPERIALE 400(BJ400-8) a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A O K E RG O E G Y A W CO Y P T O M im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Table of Contents Introduction.............................................................................................................................................................. - 1 Preparatory Information...........................................................................................................................................- 2 General safety.................................................................................................................................................. - 2 Maintenance rules............................................................................................................................................ - 3 Model information......................................................................................................................................... - 13 Motorcycle identification...............................................................................................................................- 15 Important Note............................................................................................................................................... - 15 Special tools................................................................................................................................................... - 16 Specification table (BJ400-8)........................................................................................................................ - 24 Unit conversion table..................................................................................................................................... - 26 Winding method of cables, wires and hoses..................................................................................................- 27 Troubleshooting Guide.................................................................................................................................. - 64 Torque and locking agent...............................................................................................................................- 74 Inspection / adjustment.................................................................................................................................. - 79 Inspection and Maintenance of Electrical System...............................................................................................- 110 I. Battery/Charging System..................................................................................................................................- 112 1.1 Preparatory Information.........................................................................................................................- 112 1.2 Fault Diagnosis...................................................................................................................................... - 113 1.3 Battery.................................................................................................................................................... - 114 1.4 Charging System.................................................................................................................................... - 120 1.5 Disassembly of Voltage and Current Regulator.................................................................................... - 121 1.6 Alternator............................................................................................................................................... - 122 II. Ignition System................................................................................................................................................- 126 2.1 Preparatory Information.........................................................................................................................- 126 2.2 Fault Diagnosis...................................................................................................................................... - 128 2.3 Trigger....................................................................................................................................................- 129 2.4 Ignition Coil........................................................................................................................................... - 129 2.5 Spark Plug.............................................................................................................................................. - 131 2.6 ECU........................................................................................................................................................- 132 III. Starter System................................................................................................................................................ - 134 3.1 Preparatory Information.........................................................................................................................- 134 3.2 Fault Diagnosis...................................................................................................................................... - 135 3.3 Starter Motor.......................................................................................................................................... - 135 3.4 Starter Relay...........................................................................................................................................- 136 IV. Bulbs /Switches/Meters..................................................................................................................................- 139 4.1 Preparatory Information.........................................................................................................................- 140 4.2 Fault Diagnosis...................................................................................................................................... - 140 4.3 Replacement of headlight bulb.............................................................................................................. - 141 4.4 Replacement of Turn Signal Light Bulb................................................................................................- 142 4.5 Replacement of Taillight Bulb............................................................................................................... - 143 4.6 Replacement of License Light Bulb...................................................................................................... - 143 4.7 Meters.....................................................................................................................................................- 144 4.8 Ignition Switch.......................................................................................................................................- 146 4.9 Electric horn...........................................................................................................................................- 147 - b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A O K E RG O E G Y A W CO Y P T O M im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d 4.10 Handlebar Switch.................................................................................................................................- 149 4.11 Inspection of switch............................................................................................................................. - 151 4.12 Speed sensor.........................................................................................................................................- 152 4.13 Oxygen sensor......................................................................................................................................- 153 4.14 Fuel level sensor.................................................................................................................................. - 154 4.15 Relay and fuse box...............................................................................................................................- 156 4.16 Fuse...................................................................................................................................................... - 160 Inspection and Maintenance of Chassis...............................................................................................................- 163 V. Brake................................................................................................................................................................- 170 5.1 Preparatory Information.........................................................................................................................- 170 5.2 Fault Diagnosis...................................................................................................................................... - 171 5.3 Front Brake Disc.................................................................................................................................... - 172 5.4 Rear Brake Disc..................................................................................................................................... - 174 5.5 Brake lever, brake pedal........................................................................................................................ - 177 5.6 Caliper....................................................................................................................................................- 180 5.7 Brake pad............................................................................................................................................... - 187 5.8 Master cylinder...................................................................................................................................... - 190 5.9 Brake fluid............................................................................................................................................. - 195 5.10 Brake hose............................................................................................................................................- 199 5.11 Anti-lock brake system (ABS).............................................................................................................- 202 VI. Body Cover.................................................................................................................................................... - 237 VII. Front Wheel/Front Suspension.....................................................................................................................- 244 7.1 Preparatory Information.........................................................................................................................- 244 7.2 Fault Diagnosis...................................................................................................................................... - 245 7.3 Front Wheel............................................................................................................................................- 245 7.4 Handlebar............................................................................................................................................... - 250 7.5 Front Fork.............................................................................................................................................. - 254 7.6 Front Shock Absorber............................................................................................................................ - 262 VIII. Rear wheel/rear suspension.........................................................................................................................- 272 8.1 Preparation of Information.................................................................................................................... - 272 8.2 Fault Diagnosis...................................................................................................................................... - 272 8.3 Rear wheel............................................................................................................................................. - 273 8.4 Rear shock absorber...............................................................................................................................- 278 8.5 Rear Rocker Arm................................................................................................................................... - 280 8.6 Chain drive.............................................................................................................................................- 283 IX. Fuel Tank/Seat............................................................................................................................................... - 294 9.1 Preparatory Information.........................................................................................................................- 294 9.2 Fault Diagnosis...................................................................................................................................... - 294 9.3 Seat.........................................................................................................................................................- 295 9.4 Fuel Tank................................................................................................................................................- 296 X. Frame...............................................................................................................................................................- 306 10.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 306 10.2 Fault Diagnosis.................................................................................................................................... - 307 10.3 Frame................................................................................................................................................... - 307 10.4 Sidestand.............................................................................................................................................. - 309 10.5 Center stand......................................................................................................................................... - 310 - b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A O K E RG O E G Y A W CO Y P T O M im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d 10.6 Pedal.....................................................................................................................................................- 311 10.7 Muffler................................................................................................................................................. - 315 10.8 Disassembly/installation of engine...................................................................................................... - 317 Inspection and maintenance of engine.................................................................................................................- 331 XI. Lubrication System........................................................................................................................................- 338 11.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 338 11.2 Troubleshooting................................................................................................................................... - 339 11.3 Fuel Pump............................................................................................................................................ - 340 XII. Cylinder Head Cover....................................................................................................................................- 346 12.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 346 12.2 Fault Diagnosis.................................................................................................................................... - 346 12.3 Cylinder head cover............................................................................................................................. - 347 XIII. Cylinder Head............................................................................................................................................. - 355 13.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 355 13.2 Fault Diagnosis.................................................................................................................................... - 356 13.3 Cylinder head....................................................................................................................................... - 357 XIV. Cylinder Block and Piston.......................................................................................................................... - 372 14.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 372 14.2 Fault Diagnosis.................................................................................................................................... - 375 14.3 Cylinder Block..................................................................................................................................... - 375 14.4 Piston....................................................................................................................................................- 377 14.5 Crankshaft connecting rod................................................................................................................... - 381 XV. Crankcase......................................................................................................................................................- 386 15.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 386 15.2 Disassembly and Installation of Crankcase Bearing........................................................................... - 387 15.3 Crankcase............................................................................................................................................. - 388 XVI. Clutch.......................................................................................................................................................... - 395 16.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 395 16.2 Fault Diagnosis.................................................................................................................................... - 396 16.3 Right Cover.......................................................................................................................................... - 397 16.4 Clutch................................................................................................................................................... - 397 XVII. Gearshift Mechanism................................................................................................................................ - 405 17.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 405 17.2 Fault Diagnosis.................................................................................................................................... - 405 17.3 Gearshift Mechanism...........................................................................................................................- 406 XVIII. Drive System............................................................................................................................................- 414 18.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 414 18.2 Fault Diagnosis.................................................................................................................................... - 415 18.3 Drive system........................................................................................................................................ - 415 18.4 Installation............................................................................................................................................- 420 XIX. Electric Starter Mechanism.........................................................................................................................- 425 19.1 Preparatory Information.......................................................................................................................- 425 19.2 Troubleshooting................................................................................................................................... - 425 19.3 Electric starter mechanism...................................................................................................................- 426 XX. Exhaust Emission Control System...............................................................................................................- 432 20.1 Guarantee of Exhaust Emission Control System................................................................................ - 432 - b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A O K E RG O E G Y A W CO Y P T O M im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d 20.2 Regular Maintenance Notice............................................................................................................... - 432 20.3 Mechanical Function of Exhaust Control System...............................................................................- 433 20.4 Catalyst Conversion System................................................................................................................ - 434 XXI. Fuel injection system (EFI)........................................................................................................................ - 436 21.1 Introduction to EFI...............................................................................................................................- 436 21.2 EFI system........................................................................................................................................... - 437 21.3 EFI part position.................................................................................................................................. - 439 21.4 Technical parameters........................................................................................................................... - 440 21.5 Precautions for EFI Overhaul.............................................................................................................. - 441 21.6 ECU......................................................................................................................................................- 443 21.7 Fuel Pump............................................................................................................................................ - 446 21.8 Throttle Body....................................................................................................................................... - 453 21.9 Fuel injector......................................................................................................................................... - 459 21.10 Intake pressure and temperature sensor.............................................................................................- 465 21.11 Oxygen sensor....................................................................................................................................- 467 21.12 Temperature sensor of engine cylinder head..................................................................................... - 470 21.13 Canister solenoid valve (ECP)...........................................................................................................- 472 21.14 Ignition coil........................................................................................................................................- 474 21.15 Fault maintenance and diagnosis method of EFI system.................................................................. - 474 21.16 Common troubleshooting methods for electronic fuel inject system................................................- 484 Circuit Diagram of BJ400-8 (electronic injection version, exported)........................................................- 492 - a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A O K E RG O E G Y A W CO Y P T O M im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Introduction This Maintenance Manual is the explanation for the maintenance essentials of motorcycle (BJ400-8, electronic injection version). Preparatory Information includes all matters needing attention for operation in the Maintenance Manual. Please read this Manual carefully before operation. Inspection and adjustment is the explanation for the essentials of inspection and adjustment, as well as the safety of motorcycles and performance maintenance methods of parts, which should be implemented from the time of regular inspection. Chapter II and subsequent chapters are the explanations for the decomposition, combination and inspection of the others of electrical equipment, motorcycle and engine. Exploded diagrams and system diagrams, maintenance fault diagnosis and instructions are provided above all chapters. a Note: is n ra k -d b Ka The style or structure of the motorcycle and the photographs, pictures iosor instructions on the Manual are subject to change without further notice. . S S D A I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M -1- i tr i m Preparatory Information General safety Specification table Maintenance rules Unit conversion table Model information Winding method of cables, wires and hoses Motorcycle identification Troubleshooting Guide Important Note Torque and locking agent Special tools Inspection / adjustment General safety Carbon monoxide If the engine must be started, ensure that the workplace is well-ventilated and do not operate the engine in a closed place. Note Exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide, a kind of toxic gas, which may cause people to lose consciousness and possibly lead to death. It is necessary to operate the engine in an open place, and exhaust cleaning system should be used when the engine is operated in a closed place. Gasoline a is n ra Workers should operate in a well-ventilated workplace. Smoke and fire are strictly prohibited in the workplace or the place where gasoline is stored. b Accumulator im D - s o i r it Ka Battery may emit explosive gas. Keep it away from spark, open flames and smoking area. Keep it well ventilated when it is being charged. .A S S I N A Battery contains sulfuric acid (electrolyte). Burns may be caused when it contacts with skin or eyes. Therefore, workers should wear protective clothing and mask. R B A K E RG ——If electrolyte splashes on the skin, rinse it immediately with fresh water. O ——If electrolyte splashes in the eyes, rinse them with fresh water immediately for more than 15 minutes and consult a doctor. E G Y A W O The electrolyte is toxic. If you accidentally drink electrolyte, you should immediately drink plenty of water, milk and magnesium oxide milk (a laxative antacid) or vegetable oil, and consult a doctor. Keep it out of the reach of children. CO Y P T O M -2- k -d Maintenance rules Please read the following precautions before checking, disassembling or assembling the motorcycle. In order to facilitate the actual operations, each chapter is provided with remarks, illustrations, pictures, Note and detailed instructions as needed. This section describes the special considerations in the process of removing and reassembling or disassembling and reassembling common parts. Pay special attention to the followings: Installation of Battery Disconnect the battery cable and battery before any operation on the motorcycle to prevent the engine from accidentally starting. Disconnect the negative wire (-) first, then disconnect the positive wire (+). After completing the operation, connect the positive wire (+) to the positive terminal (+) of the battery, then connect the negative wire (-) to the negative terminal (-). Sharp edge of part To avoid scratching the hand with sharp edges, wear gloves when moving parts with large size or weight. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M -3- im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Solvent Use a solvent with a high flash point when cleaning parts. Use a solvent with a high flash point according to the instructions provided by the solvent manufacturer. Cleaning the motorcycle before disassembly Thoroughly clean the motorcycle before disassembly. If dust or other foreign matter enters the sealed part during the disassembly process, excessive wear may be caused and thus the performance of motorcycle may be reduced. Sort out and clean the removed parts a The removed parts may be confused. Therefore, the removed parts should be arranged in the order of disassembly, and the parts should be cleaned and reinstalled. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M -4- im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Store the removed parts After cleaning all parts (including subassemblies), store the parts in a clean area. Cover the parts with a clean cloth or plastic film to prevent any foreign objects from falling into them before reassembly. Check Major accidents may be caused in case of using worn or damaged parts. Visually inspect the removed parts for corrosion, discoloration or other damage. The limits for the use of individual parts are detailed in the corresponding sections of this Manual. If any damage is found, or the part has exceeded the operating limit, the part must be replaced. Replacement part Replacement parts must be original Benelli parts or parts recommended by Benelli. Parts such as washers, O-rings, oil seals, grease seals, circlips or cotter pins must be replaced with new ones once removed. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M -5- im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Assembly sequence In most cases, the assembly sequence is the reverse of disassembly sequence, but if the Maintenance Manual describes the assembly sequence, it must be assembled in the order given. Fastening sequence In general, when fixing parts with a few of bolts, nuts or screws, place the parts in the corresponding holes, then screw them in without applying torque, and then tighten them in the specified order to prevent warping or deformation which may result in part failure. Conversely, if you want to unscrew the bolt, nut or screw, first twist a quarter turn, loosen it, and then continue to unscrew it. If the tightening sequence is not specified, tighten the fasteners alternately in a diagonal way. Locking torque If you apply the wrong torque to a bolt, nut or screw, serious damages may be caused. Therefore, the fastener must be tightened to the specified torque with a high-quality torque wrench. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M -6- im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Force Common sense and basic judgment are required during the process of removing and installing parts to prevent excessive force which may result in difficult maintenance or excessive maintenance costs. If necessary, use a pneumatic wrench to remove the screw with locking agent. If you need to hit the fastener, please use a mallet. Gasket, O-ring If the gasket or O-ring is hardened, shrunk or damaged after being removed, its sealing performance will be reduced. Remove the old gasket and thoroughly clean the sealing surface to prevent any gasket material or other materials from remaining on the sealing surface. A new gasket must be used for reinstallation and the used O-ring seal should be replaced. Liquid gasket, locking agent If you need to use liquid gasket or locking agent, you must first clean the contact surface to avoid any oil residue on the contact surface before using the liquid gasket or locking agent. Do not use too much liquid gasket or locking agent, as excessive liquid gasket or locking agent may block the oil passage and cause serious damage. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra -7- im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Press fitting Parts such as bearings and oil seals must be pressed for proper fitting, so it is required to apply a small amount of oil to the contact area. It must be aligned with the contact area and slowly pressed into the part during installation. Ball bearing and needle bearing Do not remove the balls or needles in the bearing unless necessary. Once removed, it must be replaced with a new one. When pressing the bearing, pay attention to making the manufacturer and the size mark face outward. Apply force to the correct bearing race (as shown) and press the bearing into place. If the force is applied to incorrect bearing race, the bearing may be damaged because of stress in the inner and outer races. Oil seal, grease seal Do not remove the compressed oil seal or grease seal if it is not necessary. Once removed, it must be replaced with a new one. When pressing the new oil seal, pay attention to making the manufacturer and the size mark face outward. Make sure the oil seal is in the proper position during installation. a b is n ra Apply a specified amount of grease to the edges of oil seal before installation. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M -8- im D - s o i r it Grease Ka k -d Circlip, cotter pin Replace the removed circlip or cotter pin with a new one. In order to prevent deformation, the opening of circlip or cotter pin should not be too large during installation. Lubrication In order to minimize the wear during running-in period, it is necessary to lubricate the rotating or sliding parts. Inject the proper amount of lubricating oil or grease as specified, and each lubrication point will be given in this Manual. Engine rotation direction When the crankshaft is rotated by hands, an incorrect direction of rotation may cause a misjudgment of relevant gap adjustment. So please rotate the crankshaft in the positive direction (clockwise from the output). a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M -9- im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Wire Two-color line: first the base color, then the color of stripe. Only the wires of the same color are allowed to be connected, except as noted. Cable connector check Make sure that there are no rust, moisture or other defects on the connector. 1. Disconnect Wire Connector Joint a 2. Check b Wire Connector Joint If there is moisture, use compressed air to dry. If there is rust, connect the connected parts for several times or use a rust remover. Replace the seriously rusted parts timely. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 10 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 3. Check All connectors If any of the joints are loose, reconnect them properly. Note If the “A” pin on the terminal is flat, please bend it. 4. Check Wire Connector Joint Note Make sure all joints are securely assembled. 5. Check Continuity (using a multimeter) Note If there are no items that need to be checked, please clean the terminals. When checking the wire sheath, follow Steps I to III For quick correction, please use the [Contact Reagent] available from most of parts stores. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 11 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Cable arrangement Loose cable is a potential safety hazard of electrical safety.Check the next cable after clamping the cable, to ensure electrical safety; Wire clamps are not allowed to bend in the direction of the solder joint; Bundle the cable at the designated location; Cables are not allowed to be placed at the end of frame or at the corners; Cables are not allowed to be placed at the ends of bolts or screws; Keep cables away from heat source or the position where the cable may be caught during movement; Cables should not be kept too tight or loose when being placed along the faucet handle, and must not interfere with adjacent parts in any steering position; Cables should be smoothly placed and must not be twisted or knotted; Before connectors are mated, check whether the connector sheath is damaged and the connector is opened excessively; If the cable is at a sharp or corner, please protect it with tape or a hose; After the cable is repaired, use tapes to securely bind the exposed area; The control wire must not bend or twist. If the control line is damaged, inflexible operation may be caused; a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 12 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Model information Europe BJ400-8 (European regulation) left view BJ400-8 (European regulation) right view a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 13 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Non-European BJ400-8 (non-European) left view BJ400-8 (non-European) right view a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 14 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Motorcycle identification 1.The representation method of frame number ① is: *ZBNP09 ? ? ? ? ? ? ? ? ? ? ? *, as shown in the figure. The 10th digit of vehicle identification code is the year, the 11th digit is the production factory code, and a “*” mark is added at the beginning and the end of the frame number. 2. Frame nameplate riveting position, as shown in the figure. Frame nameplate, as shown in the figure. 3. The serial number of engine is marked at the housing of crankcase, as shown in the figure. Engine number: BJ173FMQ-A*□□□□□□□*(exported) a is n ra b .A S S im D - s o i r it Ka I N A R B A K E RG EO G Important Note Y A W TO 1. Please use the parts from dealers. Damage may be caused to the engine when the parts that do not meet the design O M - 15 Y P CO k -d specifications of dealers used. 2. Only metric tools can be used for maintenance work. Metric bolts, nuts and screws are not interchangeable with imperial fasteners. 3. During reassembly work, use new washers, O-rings, split pins and locking plates. 4. When tightening bolts or nuts, first tighten the bolts with large diameter or leaning to the inner side, and then gradually tighten them to the specified torque in the diagonal order, unless otherwise specified. 5. Wash the removed parts with a cleaning solution. Lubricate all sliding surfaces before assembly. 6. After assembly, check whether all parts have been correctly installed and operated. 7. Degrease and remove oil before measurement. Add recommended lubricant to the lubrication location during assembly. 8. When the engine and drive system need to be stored for a long time after being disassembled, please apply lubricant to the surface of the parts to prevent rust and dust. Special tools Special tool refers to a tool specially designed for assembling or disassembling some parts of motorcycle and using it on a specific location. Appropriate special tools are indispensable for complete and accurate adjustment and assembly operations. Parts should be disassembled and assembled safely, reliably and quickly using special tools, so as to improve work efficiency and save labor. 1. Tools for maintenance of engine When disassembling the engine, certain parts can be smoothly assembled and disassembled only using specially designed tools. The list and pictures of special tools for the disassembly and assembly of engine parts are shown in Tables 1-1 and 1-2. Table 1-1 Designation: Note Special socket wrench Used to remove the flywheel bolts, Fig. 1-3 Clutch holder Fig. 1-4 Flywheel puller Fig. 1-5 Feeler gauge Fig. 1-6 Bearing removal tool Fig. 1-7 Bearing installation tool Fig. 1-8 Oil seal replacer Fig. 1-9 Disassembly tool handle Fig. 1-10 Piston pin pull-out device Fig. 1-11 Piston ring opening clamp Fig. 1-12 Spark plug socket wrench Fig. 1-13 Measuring clutch thickness im D - Fig. 1-15 s o i r it .A S S Dial gauge Measure inner diameter of piston pin, Fig. 1-16 I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P - 16 - is n ra b Ka Fig. 1-14 Cylinder diameter tester T O M a k -d Table 1-2 Fig. 1-3 Fig. 1-4 Thickness gauge (feeler gauge) Fig. 1-5 Fig. 1-6 a Fig. 1-7 Fig. 1-8 .A S S im D - s o i r it I N A R B A K E RG O E G YFig. 1-9 A W Fig. 1-10 ①Handle O CO Y P T O M - 17 - Ka b is n ra k -d Fig. 1-12 Fig. 1-11 ①Opening clamp ②Piston a Fig. 1-13 is n ra Fig. 1-14 b .A S S im D - s o i r it Ka I N A R B A K E RG Fig. 1-16 O E 2. Tools for chassis maintenance G Y The list and pictures of Acommon and special tools for the disassembly and assembly of chassis parts are shown in W Tables 1-17 and 1-18. TO O M - 18 Y P CO Fig. 1-15 k -d Table 1-17 Designation: Note Torque wrench Fig. 1-19 Allen wrench Fig. 1-20 Socket wrench Fig. 1-21 Micrometer Fig. 1-22 Magnetic frame, V-shaped block Fig. 1-23 Dial gauge Fig. 1-24 Vernier caliper Fig. 1-25 Spring snap ring pliers Fig. 1-26 Knock-on screwdriver Fig. 1-27 Front fork oil seal installation tool Fig. 1-28 Hook wrench Fig. 1-29 Jack Fig. 1-30 Accessories of jack Fig. 1-31 Screwdriver for outer race of head tube Fig. 1-32 Mounting tools for steering tube bearing Fig. 1-33 Front fork seal driving tool Fig. 1-34 Four-jaw 300-QCLM4-001 Fig. 1-35 Seven-jaw 300-QCLM7-001 Fig. 1-36 (1) Common tools for chassis maintenance Table 1-18 (continued) Fig. 1-19 a Fig. 1-20 b is n ra 1. Socket head 2. Jiggle bar 3. Ratchet wrench .A S S I N A 4. Connecting rod R B A Fig. 1-21 K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 19 - im D - s o i r it Fig. 1-22 Ka k -d Fig. 1-23 Fig. 1-24 Fig. 1-25 Fig. 1-26 a b is n ra s o i r it Fig. 1-27 .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 20 - imFig. 1-28 D - Ka k -d Fig. 1-29 Fig. 1-30 Fig. 1-31 Fig. 1-32 Fig. 1-33 (2) Special tools for maintenance of chassis: Front fork seal driving tool. a b is n ra .A S S Fig. 1-34 I N A (3) Steering nut wrench. R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 21 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fig. 1-35 Fig. 1-36 3. Tools for electrical parts The list and pictures of special tools for the testing of electrical parts are shown in Table 1-37, Table 1-38 and 1-39. Table 1-31 Designation: Note Multimeter Fig. 1-37 Ignition tester Fig. 1-38 Electronic fuel injection fault diagnosis tester Fig. 1-39 Table 1-32 (continued) a b Fig. 1-37 .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 22 - is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fig. 1-38 Fig. 1-39 a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 23 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Specification table (BJ400-8) Model Full length Full width Full height Wheel Base Terrain clearance Seat height Tank capacity Frame type Front identity Rear Front Specifications Air pressure Specifications Rim Engine type Fuel type Number of cylinders Inner diameter * stroke Total displacement Compression ratio Maximum horsepower Maximum torque Idle speed Cylinder pressure Fuel vaporization system QJ73FMQ-A Unleaded gasoline 1 Ø72.7×90 374cm³ 8.5:1 15.5kW/5500 r/min 29.0N.m/4500 r/min 1400±100 r/min 1.25MPa/1500rpm EFI (fuel injection) Cradle back bone frame Common inner and outer tire Common inner and outer tire 100/90-19 Throttle valve D37-1 Starting mode Electric starting Ignition mode ECU Spark plug model BR7ES/CR7HSA Front axle Rear axle Total Weight (Curb weight) Tire BJ400-8 2170mm 820mm 1120mm 1440mm 170mm 880mm 12L±0.5L 92kg 114kg 205kg identity Rear 130/80-18 Spark plug gap 0.6~0.7mm Front 220±10Kpa Cooling mode Rear 250±10Kpa Lubrication mode Front Rear 2.15×19 3.00×18 Air-cooled Pressure and splash lubrication API SE, SF or SG SAE 10W-50 Front Spoke Rear Spoke Telescopic sleeve, oil damping type 121mm Type of front shock absorber Stroke of front shock absorber Type of rear shock absorber Electric equipment Oil type Oil viscosity Completely Oil disassembled capacity When replaced Air Cleaner Hydraulic spring, damping shock absorber Stroke of rear shock absorber Brake Engine 55.5mm Paper Rated air flow: below 127m3/h, air intake resistance: 1.2±0.1KPa Compound impedance Intake resistance Type Catalyst (with/without) identity Manual Rear brake Single disc φ240×5mm Clutch type Operation method Battery capacity/type Type of alternator Alternator capacity Type of ignition coil Foot-operated 12V8Ah-(YTX9-BS) Three-phase alternator 320W/pm Open magnetic circuit ignition coil 4Ω/13.5KΩ Speed-varying mode First Second Third Gear ratio Fourth 12V/29KV Delphi MT05 s o i r it A BR A K E G R im D Fifth .A S S Final drive mode NI O E G Y A W O CO Element Operation method Final reduction ratio Maximum speed It is subject to change without notice and may not be applicable in every country. Y P Dry type Single disc φ300×5mm Transm ission gear T O M - 24 - 2.4L Type Front brake: Primary/secondary resistor Primary/secondary voltage ECU ECU model Muffler 2.8L With Redox type Wet multi-plate friction type Five-speed transmission 2.643 1.684 1.278 is n ra b Ka 1.000 0.864 Chain drive 3.286 120km/h a k -d BJ400-8 a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 25 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Unit conversion table Unit prefix: Length unit: Prefix Sign: Power Km × 0.6214 = miles mega M × 1 000 000 m × 3.281 = miles kilo k × 1 000 mm × 0.03937 =feet centi c ×0.01 milli m ×0.001 Unit of torque: micro μ × 0.000001 N·m × 0.1020 = kgf·m N·m × 0.7376 = ft·lb N·m × 8.851 = in·lb Unit of mass: kg ×2.205=lb g × 0.03527 = oz kgf·m × 9.807 = N·m kgf·m × 7.233 = ft·lb kgf·m × 86.80 = in·lb Unit of volume L × 0.2642 = gallon (US) L × 0.2200 = gallon (imp) L × 1.057 = quart (US) L × 0.8799 = quart (imp) Unit of pressure: kPa × 0.01020 = kgf/cm² kPa × 0.1450 = psi kPa × 0.7501 = cmHg L × 2.113 = pint (US) L × 1.816 = pint (imp) mL × 0.03381 = ounce (US) mL × 0.02816 = ounce (imp) mL × 0.06102 = cubic inch kgf/cm² × 98.07 = kPa kgf/cm² × 14.22 = psi cmHg×1.333=kPa Mechanical unit: N × 0.1020 = kg N × 0.2248 = lb Unit of speed: km/h × 0.6214 = mph Unit of power: kW ×1.360=PS kW ×1.341=HP kg ×9.807=N kg ×2.205=lb PS × 0.7355 = kW PS × 0.9863 = HP I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 26 - is n ra b Unit of temperature: .A S S a im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Winding method of cables, wires and hoses Alignment of main cable: Arrange the main along the left side of tube at the head, and fix it using a tie Arrange the main along the left side of tube at the head, and fix it using a hook a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 27 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the main along the left side of tube at the head, and fix it using a hook a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 28 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the main along the left side of tube at the head, and fix it using a clamp a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 29 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the main cable and ABS tube above the engine, and fix it with ABS front hydraulic brake tube using a clamp a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 30 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the main cable along the mounting lug and inside the frame a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 31 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ECU inserter a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O Fix the power output line E G Y A W using a tie O CO Y P T O M - 32 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a Fix the cylinder temperature sensor inserter with the upper throttle valve inserter wire using a tie b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 33 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the main cable along the left side of headlight holder, and fix it using a tie a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A Fix the positive wire of battery using a tie K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 34 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Pass the positive wire of battery and main cable above the battery box a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 35 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fix the motor wire at the inside of engine outlet pipe, and clip the motor wire into the place between the outlet pipe and motor a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 36 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the motor wire a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O O E G Y A W CO Y P T O M Connect the motor wire - 37 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Position for connecting the bond strap a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 38 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Alignment of brake pipe: Arrange the ABS front hydraulic brake tube wire downward along the inside of mounting lug a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 39 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ABS front hydraulic brake tube wire a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 40 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fix the ABS rear hydraulic brake tube wire using M cable clip a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 41 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the rear inlet tube of ABS rear hydraulic brake, and pass the rear oil pump plug wire through the left by bypassing the frame a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 42 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fix the rear oil pump plug wire and rear outlet tube of rear hydraulic brake using M cable clip a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 43 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the reservoir along the inside of rear frame a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 44 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fix the rear wheel speed sensor and the rear outlet tube of rear hydraulic brake using M cable clip Clip the rubber cover on the rear outlet tube of rear hydraulic brake in the mounting clamp at the front of rear rocker arm a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 45 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fix the rear wheel speed sensor and the rear outlet tube of rear hydraulic brake using M cable clip Clip the rubber cover on the rear outlet tube of rear hydraulic brake in the mounting clamp at the rear of rear rocker arm a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 46 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Rear outlet tube of rear hydraulic brake a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A O K E RG E G Y A W Fix ABS tube line using mounting clamp O CO Y P T O M - 47 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fix ABS tube and speed sensor wire of front wheel using M cable clip a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 48 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a Fix ABS tube and speed sensor wire of front wheel using M cable clip .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 49 - im D - s o i r it Ka b is n ra k -d 使用绑扎带将前轮速传感 Fix the speed sensor wire of front wheel using a tie a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 50 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Other matters: Arrange the accelerator cable and meter headlight wire along the right side of tube at the head, and fix it using a tie a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 51 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the accelerator cable and clutch cable along the left of frame, and fix it using a tie Arrange the ABS tube line and oxygen sensor wirealong the left side of frame, and fix them using a tie a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 52 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the accelerator cable a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 53 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the motor cable along the outlet pipe of engine, and fix it using a tie a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 54 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the wire along the frame, and fix it using a tie Arrange the clutch a b is n ra .A S S im D - I N A R B A O K E RG E G Y A W Arrange the oxygen sensor wire along the frame, and fix it using a tie O CO Y P T O M - 55 - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the oxygen sensor wire along the frame, and fix it using a clamp a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 56 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the accelerator cable and right handle combination switch wire along the right of headlight holder, and fix it using a tie, and pass it through the mounting clip at the right a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 57 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the clutch cable and and left handle combination switch wire along the left of headlight holder, and fix it using a tie, and pass it through the mounting clip at the right a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W Fix the sidestand stop switch wire using a soft wire clip O CO Y P T O M - 58 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the sidestand stop switch wire a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 59 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the wire of rear fender a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 60 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the wire of rear fender a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 61 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Arrange the wire of rear fender a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 62 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fix the outlet tube of tank using a upper mounting clip of mounting lug a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 63 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Troubleshooting Guide Note ○ For most of the faults of EFI, see the chapter “EFI”. ○ This table is not exhaustive. It is not possible to list the possible causes of each problem. It can only be used as a basic guide to help solve some common problems. Diagnostic procedure for the fault that engine cannot be started or it is difficult to start the engine: Starter motor does not work: The main switch or engine stop switch is not turned on; The starter lock switch or the gear switch has failed; The starter motor has failed; Battery voltage is low; The starter relay is in poor contact or cannot operate normally; The contact of start button is poor; The starting system circuit is shorted or open; The main switch has failed; The engine stop switch has failed; 30 A main fuse or main switch fuse is burnt out The starter motor is rotating, but the engine does not work: Motorcycle rollover sensor (EFI) is working; The anti-theft control system has failed; The overrunning clutch has failed; The starting idler gear has failed. a The engine does not run: The valve is seized; The valve ejector rod is seized; Cylinder and piston are seized; Crankshaft is seized; The small end of the connecting rod is seized; The big end of the connecting rod is seized; The drive gear or bearing is seized; Camshaft is seized; Starting idler gear is seized; Balance shaft bearing is seized; b Fuel does not flow: There is no fuel in the fuel tank; The fuel pump has failed; The tank vent is blocked; Check whether the fuel filter is blocked; Fuel hose is blocked .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 64 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No sparks; sparks are weak: Motorcycle rollover sensor (EFI) is detached; The main switch is not rotated to "ON". The engine stop switch is not rotated to "OFF"; The clutch handle is not pinched or the gear position is not in the neutral position; Battery voltage is low; The anti-theft control system has failed; The spark plug is dirty, broken or the gap is improper; Spark plug is not applicable Short circuit or poor contact of ignition coil; The ignition coil has failed; The engine control unit (ECU) has failed; The camshaft position sensor has failed; The gear switch, starting lock switch or sidestand switch has failed; The crankshaft sensor has failed; The main switch or engine stop switch is short circuited; The starting system circuit is shorted or open; Main fuse or main switch fuse is burnt out There is a problem with the fuel/air mixture: Bypass screw and / or idle adjustment screw is out of order; Air duct is blocked; Air filter is clogged, poorly sealed or missing; The oil filling port cover, crankcase vent pipe or air filter drain pipe leaks; Too low cylinder pressure: The spark plug is loosened; The cylinder head is not tightened; The cylinder or piston is worn; The piston ring is damaged (worn, weakened, damaged or stuck); The clearance between piston ring and piston ring groove is too large; The cylinder head gasket is damaged; The cylinder head is deformed; Valve spring is damaged or or its elasticity is poor; There is no valve clearance; The valve is not installed properly (valve bending, wear or carbon deposits on the valve seat) It cannot run properly at a low speed: Sparks are weak: Battery voltage is low; The anti-theft control system has failed; The ignition coil has failed; Short circuit or poor contact of ignition coil; The spark plug is dirty, broken or the clearance is improper; Spark plug is not applicable; The engine control unit (ECU) has failed; The camshaft position sensor has failed; The crankshaft sensor has failed .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 65 - im D - s o i r it a Ka b is n ra k -d There is a problem with the fuel/air mixture: Bypass screw is not adjusted properly; Air duct is blocked; Exhaust pipe or vent hole is blocked; The idle air way is blocked; Air filter is clogged, leaking or missing; The tank vent is blocked; The fuel pump has failed; Throttle valve assembly holder is loosened; Breather pipe holder is loosened The cylinder pressure is low: The spark plug is loosened; The cylinder head is not tightened firmly; There is no valve clearance; The cylinder or piston is worn; The piston ring is damaged (worn, weakened, damaged or stuck); The clearance between piston ring and piston ring groove is too large; The cylinder head gasket is damaged; The cylinder head is deformed; Valve spring is damaged or or its elasticity is poor; The valve is not installed properly (valve bending, wear or carbon deposits on the valve seat) Camshaft or cam is worn The main switch continues to run after being cut off: The main switch has failed; The engine stop switch has failed; Fuel injector has failed; The negative terminal (-) of battery or the engine control unit (ECU) ground wire is loosened; There is carbon deposit on the valve seat; Engine overheating Others: The engine control unit (ECU) has failed; The negative pressure value of throttle valve is out of balance; The oil viscosity is too high; The drive system has failed; Brake drags; The clutch is slipping; Engine overheating; Air suction valve has failed; Secondary air compensating valve has failed a b is n ra s o i r it Ka im D - is insufficient: It cannot run properly at a high speed or the power A . S S I Ignition is abnormal: AN R B The spark plug is dirty, broken or not adjusted properly; A K Spark plug is not applicable; E Short circuit or poor contact of ignition coil;G R The ignition coil has failed O E The engine control unit (ECU) has failed G Y Awith the fuel/air mixture: There is a problem W TOpoorly sealed or there is no air filter; O Air filter is clogged, M - 66 Y P CO k -d Vent pipe holder is loosened; There is water or foreign matter in the fuel; Throttle valve assembly holder is loosened; Insufficient fuel supply to fuel injector; The air duct of tank is blocked; Fuel hose is blocked; The fuel pump has failed; The cylinder pressure is low: The spark plug is loosened; The cylinder head is not tightened firmly; There is no valve clearance; The cylinder or piston is worn; The piston ring is poor (worn, weakened, damaged or stuck); The clearance between piston ring and groove is too large; The cylinder head gasket is damaged; The cylinder head is deformed; Valve spring is damaged or or its elasticity is poor; The valve is not installed properly (valve bending, wear or carbon deposits on the contact surface) There is a click sound: There is carbon deposit in the combustion chamber; The fuel is inferior or fuel type is not applicable; Spark plug is not applicable; The engine control unit (ECU) has failed Others: The throttle valve cannot be fully opened; Brake drags; The clutch is slipping; Engine overheating; The fuel level is too high; The fuel viscosity is too high; The drive system has failed; Camshaft or cam is worn; Air suction valve has failed; Secondary air compensating valve has failed; Catalyst is melted due to overheating of muffler a b The temperature is too high: Ignition is abnormal: The spark plug is dirty, broken or not adjusted properly; Spark plug is not applicable; The engine control unit (ECU) has failed .A S S I N A R B A K E RG The muffler is overheated: For the Benelli emission control system, do not start the engine even if the cylinder does not ignite or is not running properly (must be repaired by the nearest maintenance point); For the Benelli emission control system, if the battery has run out, do not start the motorcycle (connect the other fully O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 67 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d charged battery with a jumper and then electrically start the engine); For the Benelli emission control system, do not start the engine if the ignition is not normal due to dirty spark plugs or poor contact of ignition coil; For the Benelli emission control system, when the main switch is turned "off", do not ride the motorcycle and taxi using inertia force (turn "on" the main switch and start the engine); The engine control unit (ECU) has failed There is a problem with the fuel/air mixture: Throttle valve assembly holder is loosened; Vent pipe holder is loosened; Air filter is poorly sealed or there is no air filter; The fuel filter is blocked The cylinder pressure is high: There is carbon deposit in the combustion chamber; The output force of engine is insufficient: The clutch is slipping; The fuel level is too high; The fuel viscosity is too high; The drive system has failed; Brake drags Not properly lubricated: The fuel level is too low; The fuel is inferior or fuel type is not applicable; a The clutch is not working properly: The clutch is slipping: b The friction pad is worn or deformed; The steel sheet is worn or deformed; Clutch spring is damaged or or its elasticity is poor; The clutch housing is unevenly worn; The master cylinder of clutch has failed; The slave cylinder of clutch has failed; The clutch cannot be separated properly: The clutch pad is deformed or too rough; Clutch spring is not pressed evenly; Engine oil is deteriorated; The fuel viscosity is too high; The fuel level is too high; The clutch housing is seized to the drive shaft; The clutch housing nut is loosened; The clutch housing spline is damaged; The friction pad of clutch is not installed properly .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 68 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d The slave cylinder of clutch has failed; Clutch oil is deteriorated; There is air in the clutch fuel tube; The primary cup or the secondary cup of master cylinder of clutch is broken; The inner wall of master cylinder of clutch is damaged; There is a problem with shifting: It is unable to operate the gear smoothly; control pedal cannot be reset: The clutch cannot be separated: The fork is bent or stuck; The gear gear is stuck on the shaft; Gear lever is blocked The elasticity of shifting and resetting spring is poor or or it is damaged; The pin of shifting and resetting spring is loosened; The spring at the claw of shift connecting rod is damaged; The spring at the claw of shift connecting rod is damaged; The shift claw is damaged Jump The fork of shift fork is worn or bent; Shift gear groove is worn; The joint between the protrusion of the inner edge of gear and recess is worn; The groove of shift drum is worn; The elasticity of gear lever spring is poor or or it is damaged; The guide pin of shift fork is worn; Drive shaft, output shaft and/or gear spline is worn Excessive speed change: The elasticity of gear lever spring is poor or or it is damaged; The spring at the claw of shift connecting rod is damaged; a The engine makes an unusual noise: b There is a click sound: The engine control unit (ECU) has failed; There is carbon deposit in the combustion chamber; The fuel is inferior or fuel type is not applicable; Spark plug is not applicable; Engine overheating The piston makes a sound: .A S S I N A R B A K E RG The clearance between the cylinder and the piston is too large; The cylinder or piston is worn; The connecting rod is bent; The piston pin or its hole is worn; O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 69 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d The valve makes noise: The valve clearance is incorrect; Valve spring is damaged or or its elasticity is poor; The camshaft bearing is worn; The valve lifter is worn Other noises: The clearance at t he small end of connecting rod is too large; The clearance at t he big end of connecting rod is too large; The clearance between piston ring and piston ring groove is too large; The piston ring is worn, damaged or stuck; Piston ring groove is worn; Piston is seized or damaged; The cylinder head gasket is leaking; The exhaust pipe of cylinder head connecting portion is leaking; The crankshaft runout is too large; The engine is loosened; The crankcase bearing is worn; The main gear is worn or notched; Camshaft chain tensioner has failed; The camshaft chain, sprocket or guide is worn; Air suction valve is damaged; Secondary air compensating valve is damaged; The alternator rotor is loose; The catalyst is melted due to overheating of muffler (Benelli emission pollution control system) The drive system makes an unusual noise: Clutch makes a noise: The function of clutch shock absorber is weak or it is damaged; The clearance between the clutch housing and the friction pad is too large; The clutch housing is worn; The outer friction pad is not installed properly a b The drive device makes a noise: The bearing is worn; The drive gear is worn or notched; Metal fragments are stuck on the rotating teeth of gear; Insufficient oil; .A S S The drive system makes a noise: I N A R B A The chain is not properly adjusted; Chain is worn; The rear sprocket and/or the engine sprocket are worn; The chain is not applied with sufficient lubricant; The rear wheel is not adjusted evenly K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 70 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d The frame makes an unusual noise: The front fork makes a noise: The lubricant is insufficient or the film is too thin; The elasticity of spring is poor or or it is damaged; The rear shock absorber makes a noise: The shock absorber is broken; The brake disc makes a noise: The brake pads are not installed correctly; The surface of brake pad is polished; The brake disc is deformed; The caliper has failed; Other noises: Brackets, nuts, bolts and other parts are not properly installed or locked. Excessive exhaust gas: White exhaust: Piston oil ring is worn; The cylinder is worn; Valve seal is damaged; Valve guide is worn; The fuel level is too high a Black exhaust: is n ra The fuel filter is blocked b Brown exhaust: Breather pipe clamp is loosened Air filter is poorly sealed or there is no air filter; Poor performance and / or stability: It is difficult to rotate the handlebar: I N A .A S S R B The wires and cables are not wound in the correct way;A K The hoses are not wound in the correct way; E The wires are not wound in the correct way;G R The steering stem nut is too tight; O E The steering stem bearing is broken; G The steering stem bearing isY not applied with sufficient lubricant; The steering stem is bent;A Wlow The tire pressure isO too T O M - 71 Y P CO im D - s o i r it Ka k -d The handlebars vibrate or shake severely: The tire is worn; The main axis bearing of swing arm is worn; The rim is deformed or unbalanced; The wheel bearing is worn; Handlebar holder bolt is loosened; The steering stem nut is loosened; The runout of front and rear axles is too large; Engine mounting bolt is loosened; The handlebar is placed on one side: The frame is bent; The wheels are not aligned properly; The swing arm is bent or twisted; The runout of main axis of swing arm is too large; The steering stem is not adjusted properly; The front fork is bent; The oil level of left and right front shock absorber is uneven The damping effect is not ideal: (too hard) Excessive front shock absorber oil; The viscosity of front shock absorber oil is too high; Rear shock absorber oil is too thick The tire pressure is too high; The front fork is bent; (too soft) The tire pressure is too low; The font shock absorber oil is insufficient and / or leaking; The viscosity of front shock absorber oil is too low; Rear shock absorber oil is too thin The front fork and rear shock absorber springs have poor elasticity; Rear shock absorber is leaking a Brake is unable to work properly There is air in the brake tube; The friction pad or brake disc is worn; The brake fluid is leaking; The brake disc is deformed; The friction pad is polluted; The brake fluid is deteriorated; The primary cup or the secondary cup of master cylinder is broken; The inner wall of master cylinder is damaged R B A K E RG Battery has run out: O Power is insufficient; There is a problem with the battery (voltage is too low); Poor contact of battery cable; The load is too large (eg, the power of bulb is too large); The main switch has failed; The alternator has failed; E G Y A W O CO Y P .A S S I N A Battery has failed T O M b - 72 - is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka k -d There is a problem with the line; The regulator/rectifier has failed Battery is overcharged: The alternator has failed; The regulator/rectifier has failed There is a problem with battery; a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 73 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Torque and locking agent Locking torque and related parameters of nuts, bolts and screws The table below lists the basic torques for bolts and nuts (different thread diameters correspond to different locking torques). This table is only for the bolts and nuts that do not require specific torque values. All values in the table below apply to the threads cleaned with an anhydrous solvent. Locking torques and related parameters of nuts Basic locking torques Nut N·m kgf·m 4 2.3 0.2 5 4.5 0.4 6 10 1.0 8 25 2.5 10 45 4.5 12 80 8.0 14 130 13.0 16 200 20.0 18 240 24.0 20 325 32.5 Locking torque and related parameters of bolts and screws Basic locking torques Grade 10.9 Grade 8.8 Bolt/screw M4×0.7 M5×0.8 M6×1 M8×1.25 M8×1(*) M10×1.5 M10×1.25(*) M12×1.75 M12×1.5(*) M12×1.25(*) M14×2 M14×1.5(*) M16×2 M16×1.5(*) M18×2.5 M18×1.5(*) M20×2.5 M20×1.5(*) M22×2.5 M22×1.5(*) M24×3 M24×2(*) *: fine thread N.m 3 6 10 22 25 45 50 80 85 90 130 150 200 225 265 320 390 440 540 600 670 750 N.m 4.2 7.5 13 30 36 65 70 110 120 130 185 205 280 310 370 450 550 630 750 850 950 1050 O CO Y P T O M - 74 - Kg.f·m 0.4 0.8 1.3 3.0 3.6 6.5 7.0 11.0 12.0 13.0 18.5 20.5 28.0 31.0 37.0 45.0 55.0 63.0 75.0 85.0 95.0 105.0 .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W Kg.f·m 0.3 0.6 1.0 2.2 2.5 4.5 5.0 8.0 8.5 9.0 13.0 15.0 20.0 22.5 26.5 32.0 39.0 44.0 54.0 60.0 67.0 75.0 im D - Grade 12.9 N.m 5.2 9 16 40 45 80 85 135 145 150 220 245 335 360 450 550 650 750 900 1000 1130 1250 s o i r it Kg.f·m 0.5 0.9 1.6 4.0 4.5 8.0 8.5 13.5 14.5 15.0 22.0 24.5 33.5 36.0 45.0 55.0 65.0 75.0 90.0 100.0 113.0 125.0 Ka b is n ra a k -d Main locking torque specifications The table below lists the locking torques for the primary fasteners that require locking agent or silicone sealants. The letters in the "Remarks" column have the following meanings: AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. Torque Fastener Note N·m kgf·m Fuel Injection System (EFI) Air filter element cover bolt 6 0.70 Air filter element bracket screw 6 0.70 Camshaft position sensor bolt 10 1.0 Crankshaft sensor bolt 5.9 0.60 Pipe clamp bolt 2.0 0.20 Fuel tank mounting bolt 10 1.0 Fuel pump bolt 4 0.4 S Inlet air pressure sensor bracket screw 10 1.0 Oxygen sensor 25 2.5 ECU bolt 3.9 0.40 L Speed sensor bolt 3.9 0.40 L Engine cylinder head and cylinder head cover Cylinder head cover bolt 10 1.0 L Camshaft sprocket mounting bolt 15 1.5 L Camshaft cover bolt 10 1.0 S Camshaft chain guide bolt 12 1.2 S Camshaft chain tensioner mounting bolt 10 1.0 Cylinder head bolt (M11) 50 5.0 L(3) Exhaust pipe mounting bolt 22 2.2 Spark plug 25 2.5 Clutch Clutch cover bolt 10 1.0 L(1) Clutch wheel hub nut 120 12.0 R Clutch spring bolt 10 1.0 Engine lubrication system Engine oil drain bolt M12 30 3.0 Stopper of oil filler Tighten fuel pump bolt using hands 10 1.0 Fuel pump cover bolt 10 1.0 Crankshaft/ drive mechanism Balancer shaft clamp nut M14 40 4.0 12 1.2 S Assembling bolt M6 Crankcase bolt 12 1.2 S b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 75 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d Continued Fastener Flywheel locknut Driving gear nut Shift positioner bolt M6 Disassembly/Installation of Engine Front bracket bolt of engine (M10) Front mounting bolt of engine (M10) Rear mounting bolt of engine (M10) Wheel/tire Front axle nut Front wheel axle Rear wheel axle Rear wheel axle nut Final drive mechanism Upper stop block bolt of chain Chain protective block bolt Engine sprocket cover bolt Engine sprocket nut Rear sprocket nut Speed sensor bolt Brake Purge valve Hollow bolt of brake hose Pivot bolt of brake lever Pivot bolt locknut of brake lever Brake pedal bolt Mounting bolt of front brake disc Front brake light switch screw Mounting bolt of primary cylinder reservoir cap of front brake Front caliper assembly bolt Front caliper mounting bolt Purge valve of front master cylinder Clamp bolt of front master cylinder Mounting bolt of rear brake disc Rear caliper assembly bolt Rear caliper mounting bolt Rear primary cylinder mounting bolt Rear master cylinder push rod locknut Suspension system Front axle clamp nut Front shock absorber clamp bolt (upper) Front shock absorber clamp bolt (lower) Top plug of front shock absorber Piston rod nut of front shock absorber Rear shock absorber bolt (upper) Rear shock absorber bolt (lower) Rear shock absorber nut (lower) Mounting nut of rear rocker arm axis Rear rocker arm shaft N·m 90 80 12 4.5 5.0 5.0 S AL、S AL、S 100~113 100~113 100~113 100~113 10.0~11.3 10.0~11.3 10.0~11.3 10.0~11.3 AL G G AL 10 10 10 125 50 3.9 1.0 1.0 1.0 12.5 5.0 0.4 L L 7.8 30 6 6 22 12 1.2 1.2 0.80 3.0 0.6 0.6 2.2 1.2 0.12 0.12 27 22 7.8 12 22 22 22 12 12 2.8 2.2 0.80 1.2 2.2 2.2 2.2 1.2 1.2 20 22 22 22 28 45 45 45 108 108 2.0 i D2.0m .A S S I N A K E RG O O CO Y P T O M Note kgf·m 9.0 8.0 1.2 45 50 50 R B A E G Y A W Torque - 76 - - 3.1 2.2 2.8 4.5 4.5 4.5 10.8 10.8 MO L Si L、S S L、S is n ra b s o i r it Ka AL AL a k -d Continued Fastener Steering system Steering stem clamp nut Steering stem locknut Clamp screw of upper bracket Handlebar positioning double-end stud mounting nut Handlebar bolt Left switch clamp screw Right switch clamp screw Rear clamp bolt of left lever Pivot bolt of left lever Pivot bolt locknut of left lever Grip end bolt Frame Front seat cushion bolt Rear seat lock bolt Bolt of rear grab rail Mounting bolt of holder of rear fender bracket Mounting bolt of rear fender bracket Front left pedal bracket mounting bolt Shift rod mounting base bolt Shift rod assembly bolt Front right pedal bracket bolt Rear left pedal bracket bolt Rear right pedal bracket bolt Muffler cylinder mounting bolt Rear bolt of muffler cylinder Rear locknut of muffler cylinder Sidestand bolt Locknut of side stand bolt Sidestand flameout switch bolt Battery holder bolt Electrical System Alternator cover bolt Alternator wire holding plate Alternator rotor bolt Camshaft position sensor bolt Camshaft sensor bolt Camshaft sensor cover bolt Grounding terminal bolt of engine Front brake light switch screw Front turn signal light mounting nut Fuel level sensor nut Lower bracket bolt of headlight Lower mounting bolt of headlight Left switch clamp screw License plate light cover mounting screw Oil pressure switch Oxygen sensor Rear turn signal light mounting nut N·m CO Y P 10 10 22 10 10 45 10 10 45 25 25 22 22 22 50 45 6 10 1.0 1.0 2.2 1.0 1.0 4.5 1.0 1.0 4.5 2.5 2.5 2.2 2.2 2.2 5.0 4.5 0.6 1.0 10 10 100 9.8 5.9 9.8 10 1.2 6 10 10 10 3.5 0.90 15 25 6 1.0 1.0 10.0 1.0 0.60 1.0 1.0 0.12 0.6 1.0 10 1.0 0.35 0.09 1.5 2.5 0.6 I N A R B A K E RG O T O M 0.25 2.4 2.5 4.5 2.5 0.35 0.35 1.0 0.6 0.6 1.0 - 77 - - Note kgf·m 2.5 24 25 45 25 3.5 3.5 10 6 6 10 .A S S O E G Y A W Torque Dim AL AL AL L L S is n ra L L(1) b s o i r it Ka L SS a k -d Continued Fastener N·m 10 3.5 6 3.9 10 6 10 10 6 Rectifier bolt Right switch clamp screw Sidestand flameout switch bolt Speed sensor bolt Starter relay bolt Starter motor joint nut Bond strap bolt Starter motor mounting bolt Starter motor binding post locknut Torque Note kgf·m 1.0 0.36 0.6 0.40 0.6 0.6 0.6 1.0 0.6 L L L a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 78 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Inspection / adjustment Preparation standard Inspection of brake Regular maintenance checklist Inspection of brake fluid level Engine Oil/Filter Inspection of wear of brake pad Inspection/adjustment of throttle cable Inspection of CBS Air filter Inspection of brake light switch Spark plug Headlight Accumulator Clutch cable Ignition timing Front/rear suspension system Cylinder pressure Bolt/nut/fixture Drive chain slackness Tire specifications Free stroke of front/rear brake Rim / tire Inspection of brake fluid for leakage Steering Column Bearing and Handlebar Fixator a Preparation standard b Satisfactory Warning! • Before the engine is running, make sure that the surrounding air is well ventilated. Do not start the engine in a confined place, because exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide which may cause people to lose consciousness or die. •Under certain conditions, gasoline is volatile and explosive. Workplaces must be ventilated and flame should be extinguished. Smoke and fire are strictly prohibited in the workplace or the place where gasoline is stored. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P is n ra T O M - 79 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Specifications Engine Idle speed 1400±100rpm/min Spark plug gap 0.6~0.7mm Spark plug specifications BR7ES/CR7HSA Combustion chamber type Spherical Ignition time BTDC 15degrees ±1 degree 1500±100rpm Motorcycle body Free stroke of front brake lever 10~20mm Free stroke of rear brake pedal 20~30mm Specifications Tire pressure unit: Kpa Tire pressure Front tire 100/90-19 220±10kpa Rear tire 130/80-18 250±10kpa Torque Front axle locknut 100~113N·m value Rear wheel mounting nut 100~113N·m Relevant component certifications Model Designation: Certification number Note Front tire (tire and tube) E4-75R-0013977 Use environment-friendly Rear tire (tire and tube) E4-75R-0013978 tubeless tire Headlight E9 50R-00 11971 Taillight/brake light E9 50R-00 11972 Front / rear turn signal light E3 50R-00 1027 Rear license plate light E9 50R-00 11973 Rear view mirror Rear view mirror E7 00050 1 Horn Horn E4 000148 Side reflector E4 023273 Amber (oval) Rear reflector E4 02.3327 Red (rectangle) Tire Lights Reflector is n ra ab K Muffler barrel with Muffler IS N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 80 - S.A im D - sEuropean regulation o i r it mark: e13 BENELLI EX-P09 a k -d Mark: e13 BENELLI Air filter AF-P09 a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 81 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Regular maintenance checklist Maintenance mileage and time Inspection item 300KM New motorcycle 1000KM One month Every 3000 KM Every 6000 KM Every 12000 KM Every 15000 KM Three months Six months Twelve months Fifteen months C C R C R R Tools * Air Cleaner I * Gasoline filter * Oil filter I R I R Replacement of engine oil level gauge R Replaced once every 3000KM Tire pressure I I I I I I Tire pressure gauge, inflator Storage battery check I I I I I I Hydrometer, multimeter Actuation clearance inspection I I I I I I General tools Handlebar loosening inspection I I I General tools Shock absorber operation inspection I I I General tools Inspection of bolt loosening at all parts I I I I I I Torque wrench Inspection of gearbox for oil leakage I I I I I I General tools Inspection or replacement of spark plug I I R R I General tools L L * Lubrication of parts of body General tools General tools General tools General tools Oil lubricator is n ra Muffler I I I I I I * Ignition timing I I I I I I * Throttle valve A I A A A A Timing ab light KTachometer * Idle exhaust gas inspection A I A A A A CO HC analyzer * Throttle inspection I I I I General tools Fuel pipeline inspection I I I I General tools Electrical equipment of lighting instrument I I Visual multimeter Side stand of main footpeg I Dampers * Engine bolt torque Front/rear brake I Drive chain * E G Clutch Y Valve A OW T O M Y P O C O E G R I I I I A BR I I I I I I General tools I I I I Torque wrench I I I I General tools I I I A General tools I I I I General tools I I I I Feeler gauge KA I NIS SI .A I im D I - s o i r it General tools - 82 - General tools a k -d Expected inspection 1 Ignition system – If there is obviously abnormal continuous ignition, engine misfire, post-ignition overheating or other phenomena, conduct maintenance inspections. 2 Carbon removal – If there is an obvious lack of horsepower, remove the carbon from cylinder head, piston head and exhaust system. 3 Piston, cylinder – If cylinder is excessively worn, please replace it with a new one. Please go to dealers regularly for inspection and adjust it to ensure the best conditions. The table above is based on the monthly mileage of 1,000 kilometers. I—Inspection A—Adjustment R—Replacement C—Cleaning L—Lubrication Note: 1. “*” is the item in which exhaust emissions are involved. Normal maintenance must be conducted in accordance with the provisions of the State Environmental Protection Agency and the Company’s operating instructions, and it should not be adjusted and repaired without approval, otherwise, we will not assume any responsibility for it. 2. When riding on gravel roads or under severe environmental pollution conditions, add the number of cleaning air filter to extend the service life. 3. Maintenance frequency should be added to the motorcycles which often run at a high speed and have a large mileage. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 83 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Engine Oil/Filter Inspection of engine oil level When the oil is continuously consumed, check the oil amount regularly and add it to the appropriate location. *Note •When checking the oil level, the motorcycle must be parked on a flat surface. Place the center stand properly and keep the motorcycle vertical. •Check the oil level after the engine has run for 2-3 minutes or been parked for about 2-3 minutes. Check the oil level. After the engine stops, clean the dust on the oil level indicator at the right cover [A] with a clean cloth. Put the engine on a level surface, and check the oil level position at the oil level indicator. If the oil level is below or near the lower limit, add the recommended oil to the upper limit mark. If the oil level is too high, the operation of engine and clutch may be affected; if it is too low, engine overheating may be caused and thus components are worn seriously. If you add inferior or other brands and grades of oil, the lubrication effect may be reduced. Replacement of engine oil level gauge a Warm up the engine. *Note The oil should be changed when warming up the engine and the engine should be supported on the side bracket to ensure that the oil is completely discharged. b Place a suitable container under the oil drain bolt of engine to collect the oil. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 84 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the plug screw of oil filler [A]. Remove the oil drain screw *Note When the oil drain cap is removed, the oil filter and spring may pop out. Backwash the starter motor for several times to completely drain the oil. After draining the oil, check the oil filter assembly. Disassemble: Inner hexagon screw M6×30[A] Filter cover [B] O-Ring [C] Oil filter element assembly[D] a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 85 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Check O-ring If damaged, replace it with a new one. Replace the oil filter element assembly with a new one. Make sure the oil filter element assembly and O-ring are intact before installation. Tighten oil drain screw. Add the recommended oil to the crankcase from the oil filler [A] . a Recommended oil Model: API SE, SF or SG Viscosity: SAE 10W-50 Capacity: 2.4 L (when replaced); 2.8 L (completely disassemble the engine) b Note ○ Do not add any chemical additives to the oil!The oils that meet the above requirements are carefully formulated to provide adequate lubrication action to the engine and clutch. ○ Although oil with a viscosity of 10W-50 is recommended for most cases, it is also necessary to make corresponding changes according to the atmospheric conditions in the specific use area. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 86 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Install the plug screw of oil filler. Start the engine, and idle for 2-3 minutes. Stop the engine and check whether the oil level is marked at the upper limit of oil level indicator after a few minutes. When checking, the engine should stand upright on the ground. Make sure there is no oil leakage. Inspection/adjustment of throttle cable *Note The engine idle speed should be properly adjusted before adjusting the stroke of throttle cable. Check the free stroke [A] of throttle cable Free stroke: 3-5mm. If it is inconsistent with the specified value, make adjustment. Adjust the free stroke of throttle cable. Adjustment steps: Loosen the locknut [A]. Screw the adjusting nut [B] inward or outward until the specified free stroke is reached. If it is screwed in, the free stroke will increase; if it is screwed out, the free stroke will decrease. Tighten the locknut. After adjusting the free stroke, rotate the lever to the left and right to confirm whether the idle speed of engine has changed. If the upper end of adjusting throttle cable cannot reach the specified free gap, adjust the lower end of throttle cable. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 87 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble: Screw [A] Right cover of engine [B] Adjust the lower end of throttle cable. Adjustment steps: Loosen the locknut [B]. Screw the adjusting nut [C] inward or outward until the specified free stroke is reached. If it is screwed in, the free stroke will increase; if it is screwed out, the free stroke will decrease. Tighten the locknut. After adjusting the free stroke, rotate the lever to the left and right to confirm whether the idle speed of engine has changed. Air filter a Filter element replacement Disassemble: Screw [A] Right cover [B] b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P is n ra T O M - 88 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble: Screw [A] Upper cover of air filter [B] Disassemble: Screw [A] Filter element assembly Check whether the filter element is contaminated or damaged. If there is any contamination and damage, please replace it with a new one. Clean the air filter element. a is n ra *Note Do not use the gasoline so as not to cause fires. b .A S S Replacement time R B A If motorcycle often runs on bad roads or in rainy days, it should be replaced ahead of time. K E Gnot rotate the When disassembling the air cleaner core, do R O engine. Otherwise, unfiltered airEmay enter the engine, G thus causing rapid wear of Yits components and possibly A damaging the engine.In W addition, operation without the O filter element T may affect subsequent adverse operation of O M Y P CO *Note I N A - 89 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d throttle and may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, operation without the filter element may affect subsequent adverse operation of throttle and may cause the engine to overheat. Installation It should be conducted in the reverse order of disassembly *Note •Make sure whether the air filter has been installed before installing air filter cover. Spark plug Remove the connecting wire of spark plug cap at both sides of engine [A]. a b is n ra Remove spark plug [A] at both sides of engine using spark plug wrench or alternative tool .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 90 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d test. . Whether insulator is cracked or damaged . Whether electrode is worn . Burning conditions, color —If it is light gray, combustion conditions are good. —If it is pale white, ignition system is out of order or the mixture is too thin. If it is damp or black with carbon deposit, the mixture is too thick. In the above cases, clean it a wire brush or spark plug cleaner, and replace it when necessary. Check the spark plug visually. If there is crack or wear in the insulator, please replace it with a new one. the gap of spark plug Check the gap of spark plug. Gap: 0.6-0.7mm a *Note Reinstall the spark plug on the cylinder head and tighten it according to the specified torque. Torque value: 15N.m Install the spark plug with hands and then tighten it using spark plug sleeve. b Accumulator .A S S Battery disassembly I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 91 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the right protector [B] using key [A]. 1. First remove the negative cable [A]. 2. Remove the positive cable [A]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 92 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the air pipe of battery from the battery. Remove the battery holder [A]. Remove the battery [B]. Warning When disassembling the positive electrode, tools should not touch the frame, otherwise, short circuit and sparks may be caused and thus gasoline may ignite, and battery may be damaged, which are very dangerous. Warning The positive and negative electrodes should be removed in the operation order. When installing the battery, first connect the positive electrode and then negative electrode. Installation It should be conducted in the reverse order of disassembly. Warning To prevent short circuit, first connect the positive electrode and then the negative electrode. Do not disengage the battery during the commissioning of motorcycle; otherwise, the internal components may be damaged. Inspection of charging state (closed-circuit voltage) Open the seat mat and remove the right protector. Remove the battery from the battery box. Remove the negative lead and then the positive lead. Take out the battery. a Measure the voltage between battery terminals. Fully charged: 13.1V Undercharge: 12.3V (the battery has not worked for 1 hour) b *Note Inspection under the charged state must be conducted using a voltmeter. .A S S im D - s o i r it I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W voltmeter O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 93 - Ka k -d Charging Connection method: The positive electrode of charger is connected to the positive electrode of battery. The negative electrode of charger is connected to the negative electrode of battery. Warning • Never use a source of ignition near batteries. • First turn off the charger switch before starting charging or after completing charging. to prevent sparks at the connection position and avoid the danger of explosion. •In the process of charging, conduct the standard operation according to the current time marked on the battery. *Note •Battery cannot be used generally during the quick charging of battery, except in emergencies. •Measure the voltage 30 minutes after charging. Charging current: Standard: 0.6A Quick: 6.0A Charging time: Standard: 10-15 hours Quick: 30 minutes Completion of charging: open circuit voltage: 12.8V or more Ignition timing a *Note Check the ignition system when the ignition timing is incorrect. ●Warm up the engine for 3 to 5 minutes. ●Turn off the engine, and connect the timing light to the spark plug wire. ●Remove the timing observation hole cover. ● Start the engine and let it idle. ● Check the ignition timing, and see whether the timing light is on. If the “T” symbol on the flywheel is aligned with the marking symbol on the left cover, the ignition time is correct. ●Increase the engine speed and check if the “T” symbol starts moving. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG EO G Y A It should be conducted in the W reverse order of disassembly. O T Adjustment Method: Ignition Timing O M Y P CO is n ra - 94 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble: Timing access plate [A] Crankcase access plate [B] Observe the flywheel [A] of timing access plate on the left cover. Timing mark [A] on the flywheel assembly. a b is n ra Insert the sleeve [A] into the crankcase access hole. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 95 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Slowly turn the sleeve to rotate the flywheel assembly, and align the timing mark on the flywheel assembly with the timing mark on the left cover access hole [A]. After ensuring that the timing mark below is aligned, put the chain on the driven sprocket of camshaft, align the timing mark [A] on the driven sprocket of camshaft with that on the cylinder cover and put them into the camshaft, and then complete aligning the timing marks. Cylinder pressure Warm up the engine. Insert a pressure gauge. Move the choke handle to the fully open position. Rotate the throttle handle to the fully open position, and backflush to start the engine. Cylinder pressure: 1 ~ 1.2mpa *Note Start the engine until the meter reading no longer rises. Reasons for low pressure: . Improper valve adjustment . Valve leakage . Wear of piston ring or cylinder . Washer of cylinder head for damage Reasons for high pressure: Carbon deposition in the combustion chamber or piston Turn off the engine and remove the spark plug/spark plug cap It should be conducted in the reverse order of disassembly. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 96 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Drive chain slackness Park the motorcycle in a flat position to keep it in an upright position. Check the slackness of drive chain . Slackness of drive chain: 20-30mm. Adjust the slackness of drive chain: Loosen the locknuts [A] of rear axle nut and two drive chain adjusting nuts [B]. Rotate the adjusting nuts [B] at both sides of rear rocker arm, until the slackness of chain is normal. *Note Do not install the new drive chain on a worn sprocket or install the worn chain on a new sprocket. Both the sprocket and the chain must be in good conditions; otherwise, the replaced chain or sprocket may be worn soon. Free stroke of brake Free stroke of front brake a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 97 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Measure the free stroke of front brake lever at the tip of brake lever. Free stroke: 10-20mm Free stroke of brake pedal Measure the free stroke of brake pedal. Free stroke: 20-30mm. Adjust if it does not meet the specified value. a Adjust the free stroke of brake pedal. Loosen the locknut [A] Screw in or screw out the adjusting device [B] If the adjusting device is screwed in, the free stroke will be reduced; If the adjusting device is screw out, the free stroke will be increased. Screw in or screw out it until the free stroke meets the specified value. Tighten the locknut [A]. After adjustment, the brake dragging phenomenon shall be avoided. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 98 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Inspection of brake fluid for leakage The precautions for models equipped with CBS are as follows: Rotate the brake lever or pedal to check whether brake fluid leaks from the brake hose [A] and brake line [B]. ★ If brake fluid leaks from any position, check or replace the defective part. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 99 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra Check brake hoses and brake lines for damage and ensure their installation status ●The precautions for models equipped with CBS are as follows: R B A I N A .A S S K E Gfor corrosion, ●Check brake hoses, brake lines and fittings R cracks or leaks. EO G ○If the brake hoses and Y brake lines are not properly A serviced, the high pressure W inside the brake lines may cause O brake fluid to T leak [A] or the brake hoses and the brake O M - 100 Y P CO im D - s o i r it Ka k -d forming tubes to burst. When checking rubber hoses, bend and twist them. When checking rubber hoses, bend and twist them. ★If any cracks [B], swelling [C] or leaks are found on the brake hose or brake forming tube, they must be replaced. ●Tighten all hollow bolts and nuts of brake hose. Tightening torque for hollow bolt of brake hose: 30 N•m ●Check the winding method of brake hose. ★If the brake hoses and brake lines (models equipped with CBS) are not wound correctly, please discharge brake hoses and brake lines by correct winding method. Inspection of brake ● Check whether front brake and rear brake are normal when riding a motorcycle on a dry road. ★ If the brake is abnormal, check the brake system. Warning If you need to test-ride a motorcycle during the inspection, make sure to do it at a place under safe traffic conditions. Inspection of brake fluid level ● Check whether the level of brake fluid in the front brake fluid reservoir [A] is higher than the lower limit [B]. Note ○ When checking the brake fluid level, make the brake fluid reservoir level. a ★If the level is lower than the lower limit, add brake fluid to the reservoir until the liquid level reaches the high liquid level line. b ● Follow the following procedure to properly install the cover of the front brake fluid cup. ○After aligning the reservoir cover, tighten the two screws [A] of the reservoir cover with a screwdriver. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 101 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Check whether the brake fluid level in the rear brake fluid reservoir [A] is higher than the lower limit [B]. ★ If the liquid level is lower than the lower limit, add brake fluid to the reservoir until the liquid level reaches the high liquid level line [C]. Warning If you need to add brake fluid but are not sure about the type and brand of brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir, you must replace the brake fluid in the brake fluid tube. After replacing brake fluid, use only brake fluid of the same type and brand. Recommended disc brake fluid Grade: DOT4 ●Properly install the cover of rear brake fluid reservoir according to the following procedures. ○ First, tighten the cover [B] of rear brake fluid reservoir with your hands clockwise [C] until you feel a little resistance, indicating that the cover has been fixed on the reservoir, then hold the reservoir [A] and rotate it by 1/6 turn [D]. Inspection of wear of brake pad ●Remove the brake pads (see “Disassemble front/rear brake pad” in chapter “Brake” for details). ●Check the thickness of friction plate of brake pad inside the caliper [A]. ★If the thickness of friction plate of any brake pad is lower than the operating limit [B], replace the two brake pads inside the caliper simultaneously. Thickness of friction plate of brake pad Standard: Front wheel brake pad: 6.0 mm Rear wheel brake pad: 4.0 mm Operating limit: 3 mm a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 102 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Inspection of brake light switch ●Open the electric door lock. ● When the brake lever is pulled by about 15 mm, the brake light is on. ★ If the brake light is off, check whether the brake light switch plug is inserted properly. ★ If the brake light is off, check or replace the following parts: Battery; Brake light; Fuse; Front brake light switch; Rear brake light switch; Cable harness. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 103 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Headlight Remove headlight Remove Clamp screw [A] Headlight [B] Disconnect the headlight cable connector [A]. Remove the headlight Take out Headlight bulb [A] Front position light bulb [B] a b *Note When the bulb is on, keep the flammable product and your hand at a distance from the bulb, because the bulb is hot and should be cooled before it can be touched. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 104 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Install headlight Install the front headlight bulb and front position light bulb in the reverse order of disassembly. *Note Avoid touching the glass part of the bulb directly and do not expose it to oil during installation. Otherwise, it may affect the transparency, life and luminous flux of bulb. ★ If it is stained with oil, wipe it thoroughly with a cloth dampened with alcohol or volatile rubber water. Check the headlight accuracy ● Check the accuracy of headlight beam. ★ If the headlight beam is pointing to one side instead of pointing straight ahead, adjust the beam. Correctly adjust the beam of headlights as follows: Park the vehicle about 10 meters in front of the upright wall and park it on a completely flat surface.Fig. A Ride on the motorcycle and sit in the rider position. Make sure that the highest point of beam, such as on the wall, which is less than 1/10 of the horizontal axis of the headlights. If the beam does not fall within these ranges, make adjustments to make it in the correct position. Adjustment of headlight beam ● Remove the inner cover (see “Removing the Inner Cover” in the chapter “Frame”). ● Screw in or out the adjusting screw [A], until the beam is directly pointing to the front. ★ If the headlight beam is too low or too high, adjust the vertical beam. a b Rotating screw [A] Rotate the screw counterclockwise to reduce the beam Rotate the screw clockwise to raise the beam .A S S I N A R B ○ When the motorcycle is supported by its wheelsA and K someone is riding on the motorcycle, turn E on the G high-beam light, the brightest point should R be slightly O E lower than the horizontal line.Adjust the angle of the G headlights according to local regulations. Y A W TO O M - 105 Y P CO Note is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Clutch cable Check the free stroke [A] of clutch cable. Free stroke: 10-15mm. Check the free stroke of clutch cable. Loosen the fastening nut [1] first. Screw in or screw back the adjusting device[2]. Screw in or screw out it until the free stroke meets the specified value. Finally tighten the fastening nut. If the specified free clearance cannot be reached after adjusting the clutch handle, adjust the lower end of clutch cable. Check the lower end [A] of clutch cable. Adjustment steps: Loosen the locknut [C]. Screw the adjusting nut [B] inward or outward until the specified free stroke is reached. If it is screwed in, the free stroke will increase; if it is screwed out, the free stroke will decrease. Tighten the locknut. After adjusting the free stroke, rotate the lever to the left and right, to ensure that the lever of clutch can not reach the specified free clearance. a b .A S S I N A Front/rear suspension system GE R B A K R Front part Y A W O GE O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 106 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Tighten the front brake and compress the front shock absorber up and down to check the operation. Check whether the front shock absorber leaks and its parts are damaged and loosened. Compress it up and down Rear part Compress rear shock absorber up and down to check the operation. Check whether the parts of rear shock absorber are damaged and loosened. Suspend the rear wheel, and swing the rear wheel to check whether the engine suspension bushes are loosened. Compress it up and down Bolt/nut/fixture Check whether the bolts, nuts and fixtures of various parts of motorcycle are loosened. If they are loosened, tighten it to the specified torque value. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 107 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Front / rear tire Check tires for cracks, iron nails or other damages. Check tire surface Wear → Replace 1. Tire tread depth 2. Side wall 3. Wear indication Wear limit: 1mm Check tire pressure. *Note Tire pressure measurement should be conducted at cold state. Specified air pressure Unit: Kpa Tire specifications Tire pressure Front tire 100/90-19M/C 220±10 Rear tire 130/80-18 M/C 250± 10 Note If there is a rotation direction at the tire, mark it with “1” Point the mark to the rotation direction when installing the tire. Align mark “2” to the installation position of rim valve a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 108 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Rim / tire Check whether the front axle mounting nut is loose. Check whether the rear axle mounting nut is loose. If loose, tighten it to the specified torque value. Torque value: Front axle fixing nut 100-113N·m Mounting nut of rear wheel 100-113 N•m Front rim 2.50×19 Rear wheel rim 3.00×18 Steering Column Bearing and Handlebar Fixator Swing the handlebar from side to side, and check whether wires are involved. Rotate the front wheel, and freely swing the handlebar to confirm. If the handlebar cannot be swung smoothly, check the steering column bearing when it is loosened. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 109 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Inspection and Maintenance of Electrical System Torque Table of Fastener of Electrical System Fastening location and fastener name Tightening torque (N•m) Rectifier bolt 5N·m High-voltage coil mounting bolt 9N·m Flywheel mounting nut 90N·m Motorcycle protector bolt 9N·m Starter motor clutch cover bolt 12N·m Meter seat mounting screw 5~7N·m Ignition switch mounting screw 10~12N·m Horn mounting bolt 10~12N·m Oxygen sensor 25N·m Mounting nut of fuel level sensor 10N·m Precautions: There are the following important precautions in the process of overhauling the electrical system. Learn and follow all of the following rules. ○ Do not reverse the positive and negative terminals of battery, otherwise, the diodes of electrical components may be burned out. ○ Check the battery status before checking other parts of the electrical system. The battery must be fully charged before conducting accurate electrical system testing. ○ The electrical components should be protected from severe impact by hammers, and are not allowed to fall on hard surfaces. This impact on electrical components may cause damage. ○ To prevent damage to electrical components, do not disconnect the battery cable or any other electrical connections while the ignition switch is on or while the engine is running. ○ When the starter motor cannot rotate due to large current, do not press the start button all the time, otherwise, the current may burn out the starter motor coil. ○ Be careful not to short connect the cable between the positive terminal of battery and the ground wire of frame. ○ Sometimes a fault may involve one project, and sometimes it may involve all projects. Do not replace the faulty part if the exact cause of fault is not found. If the fault is caused by other causes, it must be repaired or replaced immediately, otherwise, the new parts may be damaged again. ○ Ensure that all circuit connectors are clean and tight, and check the wires for signs of burnout or wear. Broken wires and poor contact may affect the operation of power system. ○ Measure the coil and winding resistance after the component is cooled (at room temperature). b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 110 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d Charging System a is n ra b Serial number CO Designation: Serial number 1 Klaxon 2 Voltage regulator 3 Ignition coil 4 Front right turn signal light O NI A R B A 8 Gauge K 9 E Fuse box RG 7 E G Y 5 Headlight A 6 Front left turn OW signal light T O M Y P Designation: .A S S Ignition switch 10 Variable-frequency flasher 11 Relay unit 12 ECU - 111 - im D - s o i r it Ka Serial number Designation: 13 Accumulator 14 Taillight 15 Rear right turn signal light 16 License plate light k -d I. Battery/Charging System Preparatory Information--------------------- 1.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 1.2 Battery----------------------------------------- 1.3 Charging System----------------------------- 1.4 Voltage and current Regulator-------------- 1.5 Alternator--------------------------------------1.6 1.1 Preparatory Information Note for operation *Note 1. The battery can be used repeatedly by charging and discharging. If the battery is placed after discharging, the service life will be shortened and the performance will be degraded. Generally, the performance of battery that has been used for about 2-3 years will be degraded. For the battery with degraded performance (reduced capacity), the voltage will recover but the voltage will drop rapidly when a load is applied. 2. Overcharging of battery: Generally, overcharging can be observed on the battery body. If the battery is short-circuited internally, no voltage is detected at the battery terminal or the voltage is low. Regulator fault: The battery voltage will be too high, and the battery life will be shortened. 3. If the battery is placed for a long time, the battery will discharge by itself, and the power capacity will be reduced, so battery must be charged once about every 3 months. 4. Charging system should be inspected in the order of fault diagnosis table. 5. If current flows through the electrical components, do not remove the connectors. Otherwise, the voltage may become too high and the electronic components in voltage regulator may be damaged. The main switch must be turned off before operation. 6. Maintenance-free (dry-charged) batteries do not need to be inspected, so electrolyte and distilled water are not required. 7. Check all electrical loads. 8. Emergency charging should not be used unless in an emergency. 9. When the battery is charged in an emergency, the battery must be removed from the motorcycle before charging. 10. Do not use liquid-filled batteries when the batteries are a b K E RG O O CO Y P T O M .A S S I N A R B A E G Y A W is n ra - 112 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d exchanged. 11. Use a voltmeter when checking the charging state of battery. Technical parameters Item Specifications Capacity/type Voltage (20℃) Accumulator Alternator 12V8Ah(YTX9-BS) When fully charged 13.1V Must be charged 12.3V (Have not run for 1 hour) Charging current Standard: 0.8A, quick: 8A Charging time Standard: 10-15 hours, quick: 30 minutes Capacity 160W/5000rpm Coil impedance value (20℃) 0.8±0.3Ω between white and white Type Three-phase full-wave rectifying type Battery charging voltage 14.5V±0.5V/5000rpm Rectifying voltage regulator Lock torque value Rectifier bolt High-voltage coil mounting bolt Flywheel mounting nut Motorcycle cover bolt Tool 5.0 N·m 9.0 N·m 90N·m 9.0 N·m Universal wrench Flywheel puller Testing instrument Multimeter 1.2 Fault Diagnosis 1.2.1 No power a Overdischarge of battery Battery wire is not connected The fuse is broken Defective power switch b 1.2.2 Discontinuous current Battery wire is not connected properly Discharging system contact is defective Lighting system is in poor contact or short circuit .A S S 1.2.3 Low voltage Poor battery charging Poor contact Poor charging system Defective rectifying voltage regulator I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 113 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 1.2.4 Poor charging system Defective contact, short wire or short circuit of wire connector Defective voltage and current regulator Poor alternator 1.3 Battery 1.3.1 Battery Disassembly Remove the right protector [B] using key [A]. 1. First remove the negative cable [A]. a b is n ra 2. Remove the positive cable [A]. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 114 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the air pipe of battery from the battery. Remove the battery holder [A]. Remove the battery [B]. Warning When disassembling the positive electrode, tools should not touch the frame, otherwise, short circuit and sparks may be caused and thus gasoline may ignite, and battery may be damaged, which are very dangerous. Warning The positive and negative electrodes should be removed in the operation order. When installing the battery, first connect the positive electrode and then negative electrode. 1.3.2 Install battery ●Load the battery into the bracket ●Connect the negative electrode (-) of cable to the battery ● Apply a thin layer of grease to the terminals to prevent corrosion ●Connect the positive electrode (-) of cable to the battery ● Cover the (+) terminal block with the red cover [A] ● Install the battery cover on the battery and hook the strap ●Connect connector ●Connect the negative electrode (-) of cable to the frame ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly. a 1.3.3 Activation of battery b ●Fill the electrolyte ○ Make sure that the model number [A] marked on the electrolyte bottle matches the model number [B] of the battery. These models must be the same. Battery model: YTX9-BS Warning Always use the same type of electrolyte as the one marked on the battery. Because of different battery types, the volume and density of the electrolyte used are different.This is to prevent overfilling the electrolyte and shorten battery life and battery performance. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 115 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Warning Do not tear the aluminum sealing piece [A] from the filling port [B] before use.Ensure that a dedicated electrolyte storage container is used to ensure the correct volume of electrolyte is filled ○ put the battery on the horizontal surface ○ Check the seal for peeling, cracks or holes ○Removing the sealing strips *Note ○ The battery is vacuum sealed. If the seal leaks air into the battery, the first charge may take longer. ●Take out the electrolyte bottle from the plastic bag ●Remove the strip cover [A] from the container and set it aside, and later use these to seal the battery later. *Note Do not puncture or open the seal layer [B] of electrolyte bottle. Do not attempt to separate a single reservoir. ● Lay the electrolyte bottle down and place the six sealing slots into the filling port of battery. Keep the electrolyte bottle level and push down to puncture the seal of all six reservoirs. As the seal reservoir is inserted into the filling port, you will see bubbles rising in the reservoir. *Note ○ Do not tilt the electrolyte bottle a ●Check the electrolyte flow ★ If there is no air bubble rising in the filling port [A], or if the electrolyte is not completely injected into the battery, tap the electrolyte bottle [B] for several times. ● Keep the electrolyte bottle in this position for 20 minutes or longer. Do not remove the container from the battery before it becomes empty. The normal operation of battery requires all the electrolyte in the container. Warning If the electrolyte in the electrolyte bottle is not completely injected into the battery, the battery life may be shortened.It takes at least 20 minutes for the electrolyte to completely fill the battery. Do not remove the electrolyte bottle until then. ● Gently remove the electrolyte bottle from the battery ● Allow the battery to stand for 60 minutes before charging so that the electrolyte penetrates into the metal plate for optimum performance. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 116 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d *Note ○ If the battery is charged immediately after filling, the battery life may be shortened.Allow the battery to stand for at least 60 minutes after filling. 1.3.4 First charge ● Gently cover the strip [A] cover on the filling port, do not press it completely ●The newly activated maintenance-free battery needs to be charged for the first time. Standard charging: 0.9A x 5-10 hours *Note ○ Charging rate depends on the storage time and temperature of battery and the type of charger used ○ After the first charge, allow the battery to stand for 30 minutes, then check the voltage with a voltmeter. If the voltage is less than 12.6V, repeat the charging cycle. ● After charging is completed, press firmly with both hands to make the strip cover [A] enter the battery (do not hit or beat). When properly installed, the strip cover will be flush with the top of battery. Warning Once the strip cover is installed in the battery, do not move the lid or add water or electrolyte to the battery. a b is n ra *Note ○ To ensure maximum battery life and increased customer satisfaction, it is recommended to perform a 15-second load test on the battery at the speed that is three times greater than the ampere-hour rate of battery. Recheck the voltage; if it is less than 12.6V, repeat the charge cycle and load test.If it is still below 12.6V, the battery is faulty. Precautions 1) It is not required to replenish liquid This battery does not require replenishing liquid and can be used before the end of its life under normal use. It is very dangerous to pry up the sealing cap and add water.Never do this. 2) Replenish power .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 117 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d If the engine fails to start, the horn sound is very weak and the lights are dim, which means that the battery has lost power. Replenish the power for 5-10 hours using the charging current specified in the instruction manual (see the section "Replenishment of Power"). If a fast charge is necessary, strictly follow the maximum charge current and time conditions indicated on the battery. Warning If the charge is replenished according to the method specified above, quality problems will not be caused to the battery under normal conditions. However, if the charging is not performed under the conditions described above, the performance of battery will be greatly degraded. Do not disassemble the seal cap during the period of replenishing the power. If excessive gas is inadvertently generated due to overcharging, the safety valve will release gas to keep the battery normal. 3) When you do not use a motorcycle for more than one month Recharge the battery before storing it, then remove the negative cable. The power shall be replenished once a month during storage. 4) Battery life If the engine still fails to start after the battery power has been replenished for several times, the battery has exceeded its service life. The battery needs to be replaced at this point (but first make sure there is no problem with the starting system of motorcycle). Warning Keep the battery away from sparks and open flames during charging as the battery may release an explosive gas mixture containing hydrogen and oxygen.When using the battery charger, you need to connect the battery to the charger before turning on the charger. This process can prevent causing sparks at the battery terminals and avoid igniting any battery gas. There should be no fire source near the battery, otherwise, any locked terminals should not be loosened. The electrolyte contains sulfuric acid.Be careful not to let it touch your skin or eyes.If case of skin or eye contact, rinse using a plenty of water.If the situation is serious, seek medical attention. Exchange Full play can be given to the performance of maintenance-free battery only when it is connected to a suitable vehicle electrical system. Therefore, the battery can be replaced with a maintenance-free battery when the motorcycle is originally equipped with a maintenance-free battery. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 118 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 1.3.5 Inspection of charging state ● The battery can be inspected by measuring the battery terminal voltage using a voltmeter [A]. ●Disassemble battery ●Measure the voltage between battery terminals. *Note ○ Use a digital voltmeter that can read a decimal place to measure voltage ● If the reading is 12.6V or higher, there is no need to replenish the battery; however, if the reading is below the specified value, it is required to replenish the power. Battery terminal voltage Standard: 12.8V or above Terminal voltage (V) [A] Battery charging ratio (%) [B] Need to replenish power [C] Note [D] Good [E] Replenish power ●Remove the battery [A] (see battery removal section) ●Make sure to replenish the power based on the battery terminal voltage in the following way. Warning The battery is sealed.Do not remove the sealing cap [B] even while charging.Do not add water.Charging is performed according to the current and time described below. a b Terminal voltage: between 11.5 and 12.6V Standard charging: 0.9A × 5-10h (see the right figure) Fast charging: 9A×1h Warning Do not charge quickly if possible.If fast charging is unavoidable, standard charging will be performed later. Terminal voltage: less than 11.5V Charging method: 0.9A×20h Note If the battery cannot be charged initially, the charging voltage shall be increased to 25V.After increasing the voltage, charge for no more than 5 minutes, then check whether current is flowing to the battery.If the battery has received current, the voltage should be reduced back to the standard voltage and continue the operation in the .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 119 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ways as described in the battery packing.If there is no current flowing to the battery after 5 minutes, please replace the battery. Battery [A] Battery charger [B] Standard value [C] Current begins to flow [D] • Determine battery state after replenishing power ○ After charging is completed, let the battery stand for 30 minutes and then determine the battery state by measuring the terminal voltage according to the following table. Standard Judgment 12.6V or above Good 12.0-less than 12.6V Undercharge→Recharge Less than 12.0V Unavailable→Replacement ● When the battery is inspected, it should be tested with a multimeter under the state of full charge. ●After the engine is warmed up, install the fully charged batteries. ●Connect a voltmeter between battery terminals. ●Start the engine, slowly increase the speed and measure the limit voltage. Limit voltage/speed: 15V (5000rpm) (DC voltage) ●When the limit voltage is not within the specified value range, check the voltage regulator. 1.4 Charging System 1.4.1 Inspection of Charging State Test the battery with a multimeter in a fully charged state. After the engine is warmed up, install the fully charged batteries. Connect a voltmeter between battery terminals. Remove the main fuse, and connect an ammeter between two terminals. Measure the current engine, slowly increase the speed and measure the limit voltage and current. a b Limit voltage/speed: 14.5±0.5V (5.000rpm) When the limit voltage is not within the specified value range, check the rectifying voltage regulator and lighting system limiting voltage. *Note The multimeter is set to the position of DC voltage during voltage detection, and the limiting voltage will change slightly when the lighting system is turned on. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG EO G Y (general version) Charging simple function diagram A OW T O M Y P O C is n ra - 120 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 1.5 Disassembly of Voltage and Current Regulator 1.5.1 Disassembly of voltage and current regulator Disconnect the plugs of voltage and current regulator and cable [A] Disassemble: Bolt [A] Disassembly of Voltage and Current Regulator [B] a b is n ra 1.5.2 Inspection of Circuit at Main Wiring End Remove the 6P plug of voltage and current regulator. .A S S Check the continuity between main wiring terminals in the following way. Item (wire color) Judge Between battery (red) and bond strap of body A K E G R Between bond strap wire (black) and bond strap of body Y A W O CO Y P T O M BR There is battery voltage O GE Between charging coil (white) and bond strap of body I N A There is wire There is resistance in alternator coil - 121 - B im D W3 W2 R W1 s o i r it Ka k -d 1.5.3 Inspection of Voltage and Current Regulator 1、 Rotate the multimeter to the position of diode; 2、 Connect the black probe to the red terminal of regulator, and connect the red probe to the white terminals (white 1, white 2, white 3) of regulator respectively. The pointer gauge will display a certain value, otherwise, it indicates that regulator is damaged and needs to be replaced. 3、 Connect the red probe to the black terminal of regulator port, and connect the black probe to the white terminals (white 1, white 2, white 3) of regulator respectively. The pointer gauge will display a certain value, otherwise, it indicates that regulator is damaged and needs to be replaced. *Note •Do not touch the metal part of test rod of multimeter with fingers during inspection. •Use a multimeter to check. The impedance values may be different when different multimeters are used, so the check may not be correct. The voltage regulator should be replaced when the impedance between the terminals is abnormal. 1.5.4 Installation of voltage and current regulator ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly. Locking torque of voltage and current regulator mounting bolt: 10-12 N·m 1.6 Alternator a 1.6.1 Disassembly b ●Alternator power cable connector ● Place a suitable container under the magnet cover ● Loosen the left cover mounting bolt [A] and remove the left cover and coil ● Pull the alternator power cable from the engine and bracket .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 122 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Remove stator coil: Alternator cover (see "Removing alternator cover) Stator coil [A] Stator coil bolt [B] Alternator lead wire sleeve [C] Trigger [D] Tension disc bolt [E] ●Remove the flywheel: Remove alternator cover (see "Removing alternator cover) Use the flywheel remover to remove the flywheel mounting bolts [A]. Remove it from the crankshaft using the flywheel puller Remove the flywheel a 1.6.2 Inspection *Note Check the alternator charging coil and operate at the engine. ● There are three types of alternator faults: short circuit, open circuit (wire is burnt out) or the magnetic property of rotor disappears. A short or open circuit of coil will result in low output or even no output. The disappearance of the magnetic property of rotor will result in a low output that may be caused by falling of alternator or hitting, or by being placed near the electromagnetic field, or simply because of aging. ● Turn off the ignition switch ●Remove alternator connector. ●Use a multimeter to measure the impedance between the three white terminals of alternator. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 123 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d test. Stator assembly Remove alternator connector. Use a multimeter to measure the impedance between the white coils of alternator. Standard value: 0.8±0.3Ω (20°C) Replace the alternator coil when the measured value exceeds the standard value. ★ If the resistance is greater than the above, or if any two power cord multimeters have no reading (infinite value), the stator line is broken and must be replaced. It the value is far below this resistance, the stator is shorted and must be replaced. ● Measure the resistance between each white power cord and the chassis ground wire using the maximum resistance range of the multimeter. ★ If the tester coil is used to test whether the engine body is conducting or not; if it is conductive, there is a short circuit between the coil and the engine, and the charging coil needs to be checked. ★ If the resistance of stator coil is normal, but the voltage check indicates that the alternator is faulty, it is possible that the rotor is magnetically weakened and the rotor must be replaced. ●Start the engine ○Run according to the revolutions per minute (rpm) given in the Table below. ○ Keep a record of voltage readings (total of 3 measurements) Table Output voltage of alternator Tester range 750 V AC Wring Connect tester (+) to A white power cable Connect tester (-+) to Another white power cable a Reading at 5000 rpm b 80V or higher ★ If the value displayed on the output voltage is the value in the table, the alternator is operating normally. ★ If the reading is much lower than the value in the table, the alternator is faulty. 1.6.3 Installation ●Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. .A S S I N A R B A K E Locking torque of stator coil and tensionGdisc bolt: 10-12 N·m OR E Locking torque of trigger bolt:G 7-9N·m Y Locking torque of alternator A cover bolt: 10-12N·m W Locking torque of flywheel mounting nut: 9N·m O T O M Y P O C is n ra - 124 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Ignition System a is n ra b Trigger probe Power supply Serial number Designation: Serial number 1 Klaxon 7 2 Voltage regulator 8 3 Ignition coil 4 Front right turn signal light 5 Headlight 6 Front left turn signal light Y A W Ignition system .A S S NI Designation: RA switch Ignition B A Gauge O GE K 9E Fuse box G R 10 Variable-frequency flasher 11 Relay unit 12 ECU O CO Y P T O M - 125 - im D - s o i r it Ka Serial number Designation: 13 Accumulator 14 Taillight 15 Rear right turn signal light 16 License plate light k -d II. Ignition System Preparatory Information-------------------------2.1 Fault Diagnosis --------------------------------- 2.2 Crankshaft sensor-------------------------------- 2.3 Ignition Coil -------------------------------------2.4 Spark Plug---------------------------------------- 2.5 ECU------------------------------------------------2.6 2.1 Preparatory Information 2.1.1 Precautions for operation 1、 Ignition system should be inspected step by step in the order of fault diagnosis table. 2、 The ignition system is an electronic automatic angle feeding device and it has been solidified in the ECU group, so the ignition time does not need to be adjusted. 3、 Ignition system should be inspected in the order of fault diagnosis table. 4、 The main reason for ignition system fault is poor contact of connector, so first check whether the connectors are in poor contact. 5、 Check whether the heat value of spark plug is appropriate, because improper spark plug may cause the engine to run unsmoothly or burn the spark plug. a 6、 Check the main switch according to the conduction table of switch part. (Attached) is n ra 7、 Alternator and stator should be removed according to b the disassembly instructions. Warning Ignition system may generate an extremely high voltage.Do not touch the spark plug or coil while the engine is running; otherwise, you may be exposed to a .A S S I N A serious electric shock. *Note R B A K E RG Do not disconnect battery cable or any other electrical connections while the ignition is on or the engine is EO G the electrodes of battery.The side of negative electrode Y should be grounded.This A is to prevent damage to ECU. OW T O M Y P O C running.This is to prevent damage to ECU.Do not reverse - 126 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Technical parameters Item Spark plug standard value Standard BR7ES/CR7HSA 0.6~0.7mm Spark plug gap 0.6Ω±15% Primary coil Impedance of trigger (20°C) Secondary coil There is a spark plug cover 18.6KΩ±15% There is no spark plug cover 13.6KΩ±15% Impedance of trigger (20°C) 240±20Ω Maximum voltage in one measurement of ignition coil 15V Trigger voltage Above 1.7V Tools Accessories of maximum voltmeter Multimeter a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 127 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 2.2 Fault Diagnosis Incorrect ignition (no spark) Battery inspection Not good Charge or replace battery Not good Repair or replace damaged parts Not good Replace spark plug Not good Replace ignition coil Not good Electric Good Ignition system wire and connector inspection Good Spark plug inspection Good Primary coil peak voltage inspection Good Primary coil peak voltage inspection lower than the specified value Good If ignition coil fails, replace it Not good The voltage is zero or Check: almost zero Not good 1. Voltage of multimeter 2. Peak voltage of crankshaft sensor a 3. Peak voltage of position sensor of camshaft Not good Check: b a K with a multimeter s o i test. r t Good Replace faulty parts or check them 1. The adapter is not properly connected or the adapter is faulty 2. Ignition switch and engine switch flames out 3. Peak voltage of crankshaft sensor 4. Peak voltage of position sensor of camshaft .A S S I N A Good K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P - Dim i R B A If electronic control unit is faulty, replace it Replace faulty parts T O M - 128 - is n ra k -d 2.3 Trigger 2.3.1 Disassembly of trigger ●Trigger [A] cannot be disassembled separately, because it is integrated with alternator (see “Disassembly of Alternator” for details) ●Use the tester *Note The trigger can be checked on the engine. 2.3.2 Inspection ● Remove trigger wire connector. ● Measure the impedance values of blue / white and green / white outgoing lines of engine. Standard value: 240±20Ω (20°C) ★ If the measured resistance value is higher than the specified value, the coil circuit is disconnected and needs to be replaced. ★ If the resistance value is lower than the specified value, the coil is short-circuited and must be replaced. a 2.4 Ignition Coil b 2.4.1 Disassembly of ignition coil: ●Remove the fuel tank (see Chapter IX “Disassembly of Fuel Tank” for details). ●Remove the spark plug cover [A] ●Remove the primary wire of ignition coil. K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P .A S S I N A R B A T O M is n ra - 129 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Remove the ignition coil connector [A]. ● Remove the clamp nut of ignition coil mounting bolt [A]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 130 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Remove the ignition coil mounting bolt [A], and remove the ignition coil [B]. ●Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Torque value Clamp nut of ignition coil mounting bolt 10-12N·m 2.4.2 Inspection of Ignition Coil + *Note • When there is no spark in the spark plug, it is necessary to check whether the parts of wiring are loosened or in poor contact; • There are many brands of multimeter, the internal impedances are different and the tested values are different. ●Check the primary coil ●Measure the impedance among the terminals of primary coil. Standard value: (0.6±10%)Ω(20℃) ★The impedance value is good in the standard value. ★If the impedance value is “∞”, it indicates that the wire in the coil is disconnected and the ignition coil needs to be replaced. - a 2.5 Spark Plug b 2.5.1 Inspection of spark plug ●Disassemble spark plug (see section “disassembly of spark plug”) ●Visually inspect the spark plug ○ If the center electrode of spark plug [A] and/or side electrode [A] is corroded or damaged, or insulated terminal [C] is broken, replace the spark plug ★If the spark plug is dirty or there is carbon deposit, replace the spark plug ○Use a wire feeler to measure the gap [D] ○If the gap is incorrect, replace the spark plug Spark plug gap: 0.6-0.7mm ○Use standard spark plugs or their equivalents Spark plug: BR7ES/CR7HSA .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 131 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 2.6 ECU ●System inspection ●Remove ECU and check the parts at wiring terminal related to ignition system. (See section “ECU” of electronic injection system for details) a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 132 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Starter System THE ON OFF SWITCH BATTERY B RELAY R FLAMEOUT SWITCH START SWITCH a G/Y O/R B O/R G R/W G is n ra b Gr G/Y O/R STARTOR MOTOR im D - s o i r it Ka MAIN SWITCH Serial number Designation: 1 Klaxon 7 2 Voltage regulator 8 3 Ignition coil 4 Front right turn signal light 5 Headlight 6 Front left turn signal light Y A W O OT M Y P O C Serial number .A S S NI Designation: RAswitch Ignition B A Gauge Serial number Designation: 13 Accumulator 14 Taillight Fuse box 15 Rear right turn signal light 10 Variable-frequency flasher 16 License plate light 11 Relay unit 12 ECU O GE K E 9 RG - 133 - k -d III. Starter System Preparatory Information--------------------- 3.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 3.2 Starter Motor----------------------------------3.3 Starter Relay---------------------------------- 3.4 3.1 Preparatory Information Precautions for operation Starter motor can be removed on the engine. Starter clutch should be disassembled in accordance with the working procedures. Technical parameters Item standard value Operating limit Length of starter motor brush 12.5mm 8.5mm Stater idle shaft bushing 8.3mm Outer diameter of starter idle shaft 7.94mm a Lock torque value Starter motor clutch cover bolt 12 N•m b Tools Mounting nut wrench Universal fixing wrench .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 134 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 3.2 Fault Diagnosis 3.2.1 Start failure •The fuse is broken •Insufficient battery power •Detective ignition switch • Defective starter clutch • Defective brake switch • Defective starter relay • Defective connecting wire • Defective starter motor 3.2.2 Too weak rotation force of starter motor •Insufficient battery power • Defective connecting wire •The gear of starter motor is struck by foreign body 3.2.3 Starter motor can rotate but rotation engine cannot work • Defective starter clutch •Reverse rotation of starter motor •Insufficient battery power 3.3 Starter Motor a 3.3.1 Disassembly *Note b Before disassembling starter motor, first turn off the main switch, remove the bond strap of battery, then turn on the power and check whether starter motor is running to confirm safety. remove starter motor cable [B] connector. Remove the starter motor mounting bolt [A], and remove the starter motor. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 135 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 3.3.2 Installation Install the starter motor in the reverse order of disassembly. Torque value Starter motor mounting bolt 10-12 N•m 3.4 Starter Relay 3.4.1 Operation Inspection Remove the body protector. When the main switch is related to “ON”, check whether a “click” sound is made after turning on starter motor. It is normal when a sound is made. When there is no sound: • Check starter relay voltage. •Check bond strap circuit of starter relay. •Check the operation of starter relay. Starter relay 3.4.2 Inspection of Voltage of Starter Relay Erect main foot, and measure the voltage between the negative electrode (green/yellow) of starter relay connector and bond strap of motorcycle body. Place the main switch at the position of “ON”, pull the brake lever and ensure that the battery voltage meets the regulations. When no voltage is applied to the starter relay wire, check the continuity and wire of brake switch. R B A K E RG CO Y P S.A im D - s o i r it Black Bond strap Starter relay O GE O T O M is n ra b Ka IS N A Y A W a - 136 - Green/ yellow k -d 3.4.3 Inspection of Bond Strap Circuit of Starter Relay Remove starter relay connector. Check the continuity between black wire connector terminal and bond strap of body. Ensure that the continuity between black wire connector terminal and bond strap of body is good after start button is pressed. When it is nonconductive, check the continuity and wire of start button. Green yellow / line 3.4.4 Operation Inspection Connect the starter relay to the battery and connect the terminal of starter motor to multimeter. Connect the fully charged battery between the black and green/yellow wires of the relay. At this point, “Da” sound is made in the relay and the resistance indication of multimeter is “zero”. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 137 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Bulbs/Meters a is n ra b Ka Serial number Designation: Serial number Designation: 1 Klaxon 7 Ignition switch 2 Voltage regulator 8 Gauge 3 Ignition coil 9 Fuse box 4 Front right turn signal light 10 5 Headlight 6 Front left turn signal light Y A W O GE 11E G R 12 CO Y P .A S S NI RA Variable-frequency B flasher KA Relay unit ECU O T O M Serial number - 138 - im D - s o i r itDesignation: 13 Accumulator 14 Taillight 15 Rear right turn signal light 16 License plate light k -d IV. Bulbs /Switches/Meters Preparatory Information---------------------------------- 4.1 Fault Diagnosis-------------------------------------------- 4.2 Replacement of Headlight Bulb------------------------- 4.3 Replacement of Front Turn Signal Light Bulb-------- 4.4 Replacement of Taillight Bulb--------------------------- 4.5 Replacement of License Plate Light Bulb--------------4.3 Meters------------------------------------------------------- 4.7 Ignition Switch---------------------------------------------4.8 Electric Horn----------------------------------------------- 4.9 Handlebar Switch------------------------------------------4.10 Inspection of Switch-------------------------------------- 4.11 Speed Sensor----------------------------------------------- 4.12 Oxygen sensor--------------------------------------------- 4.13 a Fuel Level Sensor----------------------------------------- 4.14 Relay and Fuse Box--------------------------------------- 4.15 Fuse----------------------------------------------------------4.16 .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 139 - im D - b is n ra s o i r it Ka k -d 4.1 Preparatory Information Precautions for operation Switch can be removed from motorcycle for measuring the continuity of switch. All plastic connectors have claws. Remove the claws before disassembly. Be sure to align the claws with the card when reinstalling. When looking for an electrical fault, check the continuity of the circuit passing through the electronics. Before performing any inspection, confirm the battery status, including checking whether the battery voltage is normal. Lock torque value Meter mounting holder mounting screw Ignition switch mounting bolt Horn mounting bolt Oxygen sensor: Fuel level sensor mounting nut: 5-7N·m 10-12N·m 10~12N.m 25 N·m 10 N·m a b 4.2 Fault Diagnosis 4.2.1 The “ON” light of main switch is off. • Defective light bulb. • Defective switch. • The connector is in poor contact or disconnected. • The power of battery is weak or there is no voltage. R B A K E RG O CO Y P T O M .A S S I N A O E G Y A W is n ra - 140 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.3 Replacement of headlight bulb 4.3.1 Disassembly Remove Clamp screw [A] Headlight [B] Disconnect the headlight cable connector [A]. a Remove the headlight Take out Headlight bulb [A] Front position light bulb [B] b is n ra *Note When the bulb is on, keep the flammable product and your hand at a distance from the bulb, because the bulb is hot and should be cooled before it can be touched. I N A R B A K E RG .A S S EO G 4.3.2 Installation Y A W O bulb and front position light bulb Install the frontT headlight O M - 141 Y P CO im D - s o i r it Ka k -d in the reverse order of disassembly. *Note Avoid touching the glass part of the bulb directly and do not expose it to oil during installation. Otherwise, it may affect the transparency, life and luminous flux of bulb. ★ If it is stained with oil, wipe it thoroughly with a cloth dampened with alcohol or volatile rubber water. 4.4 Replacement of Turn Signal Light Bulb 4.4.1 Disassembly Remove Self-tapping screw of turn signal light [A] Turn signal light cover [B] Turn signal light bulb [C] Specifications Turn signal light bulb Rl0W 4.4.2 Installation The bulb should be installed in the reverse order of disassembly. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 142 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.5 Replacement of Taillight Bulb 4.5.1 Disassembly Remove Self-tapping screw of taillight [A] Taillight cover [B] Taillight bulb [B] Specifications Turn signal light bulb P21/5W 4.5.2 Installation The taillight bulb should be installed in the reverse order of disassembly. *Note Ensure that the sealing washer of taillight cover is in the good state and correct position when installing the taillight. 4.6 Replacement of License Light Bulb a is n ra 4.6.1 Disassembly b Remove License plate light holder [A] .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 143 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove License plate light bulb [A] Specifications License plate light bulb: W5W 4.6.2 Installation The license plate light bulb should be installed in the reverse order of disassembly. 4.7 Meters 4.7.1 Disassembly Remove: Meter and cable connector [A] Remove: Bolt M5×16[A] Meter assembly [D] a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 144 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra .A S S I N A 4.7.2 Installation R B A K E RG The meter should be installed in the reverse order of disassembly. Torque value: Meter holder mounting screw 5-7N·m O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 145 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.8 Ignition Switch 4.8.1 Disassembly Remove the headlight. (see replace of headlight bulb-"Disassembly" for details) Remove the power lock cable connector [A] Check the conduction of connector terminal. Color Gear Red Brown Diameter a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 146 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.8.2 Replacement of Ignition Switch 4.8.2.1 Disassembly Remove the hexalobular socket pan head screw M6 × 20[A] and replace the ignition switch [B]. 4.8.2.2 Installation The ignition switch should be installed in the reverse order of disassembly. Torque value: Ignition switch mounting bolt 10-12N·m 4.9 Electric horn a 4.9.1 Disassembly Remove Horn cable connector [A] Mounting bolt [B] Horn [C] b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 147 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.9.2 Installation The horn should be installed in the reverse order of disassembly. Torque value: Horn mounting bolt 10~12N.m 4.9.3 Inspection Remove the horn wire. If the horn sounds after being connected to the battery, it is in good conditions. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 148 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.10 Handlebar Switch Left Handlebar Switch 1. Dimmer switch 2. Steering switch 3. Horn switch 4. Passing switch Dimmer switch Blue Yellow / red Steering switch Light blue Red / white Green / Black black Horn button Green /white Red and Brown white Right handlebar switch (The headlight is very bright) 5. Light control switch 6. Stop switch 7. Starting switch Red / white Orange/ blue Blackish green Yellow/ red Green/ yellow Blackish green Red a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 149 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Right handlebar switch (The headlight is always on) 5. Warning switch 6. Stop switch 7. Starting switch Green- Orange Greenwhite black Stop switch Red Dark green Start button Greenish Dark yellow green a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 150 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.11 Inspection of switch ● Use a handheld multimeter to check whether only the switches in the table have been turned on ○ For the switch housing and main switch, refer to the table in the wiring diagram section ★ If the switch is open or shorted, repair or replace it with a new switch 4.11.1 Connect the rear brake light switch Connect the rear brake light switch Color BR BL When the brake pedal is pressed When the brake pedal is released 4.11.2 Connection of sidestand switch Connect the sidestand switch Color BK G When the brake pedal is pressed When the brake pedal is released a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 151 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.12 Speed sensor 4.12.1 Disassembly of speed sensor Warning Do not drop the sensor, especially on a hard surface. The shock of impact may cause damage to the sensor. ●Remove the speed sensor (see 5.11.6) 4.12.2 Inspection of speed sensor ● Remove the speed sensor (see 5.11.6) ●Connect the speed sensor connector [A] and battery [B], 10kΩ resistor [C] and handheld multimeter [D], as shown in the figure ●Set the multimeter to the range of DC 20V (digital multimeter) ● Use a screwdriver to slide over the entire surface of speed sensor, and adjust the end voltage from the battery voltage value to about 0-1V a b is n ra 4.12.3 Installation of speed sensor ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 152 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.13 Oxygen sensor 4.13.1 Disassembly of oxygen sensor Warning Do not drop the sensor, especially on a hard surface.The shock of impact may cause damage to the sensor. ● Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector. ●Remove the oxygen sensor [A]. 4.13.2 Inspection of oxygen sensor ● See section “Inspection of Oxygen Sensor” in the chapter “Electronic Fuel Injection System”. 4.13.3 Installation of oxygen sensor a Warning Do not drop the oxygen sensor [A], especially on a hard surface.The shock of impact may cause damage to the sensor.Do not touch the sensing part [B] of sensor to prevent it from being polluted with oil stains.Oil on your hands may affect sensor performance. ● Tighten: Torque-oxygen sensor: 25 N·m ● Operate the oxygen sensor wires correctly (see section "Arrangement of Cables, Wires and Hoses" in Chapter "Appendixes") b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 153 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.14 Fuel level sensor 4.14.1 Disassembly of fuel level sensor ●Remove the fuel tank (see 9.4.1). ● Remove the four tightening nuts [A] and remove the fuel level sensor [B] and the fuel level sensor seal [C]. ○Check sensor seal ★If the sensor seal is found to be broken or swelled, it must be replaced! 4.14.2 Inspection of fuel level sensor ● Check whether the fuel sensor float is moving smoothly and not stuck. It should move downwards under its own weight. ★ If the float does not move smoothly, the sensor must be replaced. When the float is in the position of "full" [A] When the float is in the position of "empty" [B] Floating arm stopper [C] ● Use the hand-held multimeter [A] to measure the resistance around the terminal of fuel level sensor connector [B]. Special tool - handheld multimeter: Pointer adapter device: ★ If the multimeter reading does not meet the requirements, or does not change smoothly according to the up and down movement of the float, replace the sensor. Fuel level sensor component Standard: full fuel level [C]: 5-12Ω Empty fuel level: 96-103Ω a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 154 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.14.3 Installation of fuel level sensor ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly. Locking torque: Fuel level sensor mounting nut: 10 N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 155 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.15 Relay and fuse box 4.15.1 Disassembly of relay and fuse box ● The relay is directly on the wire harness. ● The relay [A] is in the area under the front seat cushion. a ●Open the upper cover when disassembling ● Pull out No. 1 and No. 4 relays [A] b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 156 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Unscrew the mounting bolts with five large socket head wrench ●Remove the relay *Note The relay is equipped with a diode.The relay diode cannot be removed Warning Do not drop the sensor, especially on a hard surface.The shock on relay may cause damage to it. 4.15.2 Inspection of relay circuit ● Disassemble the relay (see the section "Removing relay"). ● Check the conductivity of the terminals with the following numbers by connecting a hand-held multimeter and a 12V battery to the relay (see the internal circuit of relay box in this section). ★ If the reading of multimeter does not meet the requirements, replace the relay box. 4.15.3 Inspection of relay circuit (disconnect battery) Connect the multimeter Reading of multimeter (Ω) 3-4 ∞ 1-2 Not ∞* 7-8 ∞ 5-6 Not ∞* 11-12 ∞ 9-10 NOT ∞* Fuel pump relay Main relay Light relay a b *: Actual readings may vary depending on the handheld multimeter used. 4.15.4 Inspection of relay circuit (with battery)S.A Fuel pump relay Connect the multimeter 1-2 3-4 M Y Multimeter reading (Ω) IS N A R B A K E RG O E G AY 7-8 5-6 W O OT Main relay P O C Battery connection (+) (-) is n ra 0 0 - 157 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Light relay 9-10 11-12 0 (+): Connect the positive wire (-): connect the negative wire 4.15.6 Internal circuit of relay box 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 LG/B R/W R/WGr/RB/RG/RBL/BR/B B DG LR B/RG/RR/W R Y/R Fuel pump relay ECU relay 油泵继电器 ECU继 电器 主Main 继电relay 器 Headlight relay 大 灯继电器 b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 158 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d ● State 1: relay ● State 2: relay ●The headlights are not always on. The relay of the motorcycle does not contain the No. 3 relay in the state 1. Others are the same as the above-mentioned export inspection methods. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 159 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.16 Fuse 4.16.1 Disassembly of fuse ●Remove seat cushion (see 9.3.1) ●Remove the right cover (see Chapter VI) ●Remove the seat cushion mounting base [A] ● Remove the cover [A] a ● Use a needle-nosed pliers to pull the main fuse [A] out of the fuse holder in a straight line Fuse: 40A b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 160 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Fuse box [A] ●Open the buckle and lift the cover [A] . ●Use a needle-nosed pliers to pull the main fuse [B] out of the fuse holder in a straight line Fuse line, as shown in the right figure A. Fuel pump: 15A (blue) B. Headlight: 15A (blue) C. ECU: 15A (blue) B. ABS: 15A (blue) a E. Power lock: 10A (red) D. ABS:10A (red) is n ra G. Spare fuse 10A (red) H. Spare fuse 15A (blue) b I. Spare fuse 15A (blue) 4.16.2 Installation of fuse ★ If the fuse fails during operation, check the electrical system to determine the cause and replace it with a one of suitable amperage ● Install the fuse box on the cover in the original position as specified. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 161 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 4.16.3 Inspection of fuse ● Disassemble the fuse (see 4.17.1) ●Check the fuse parts ★ If the fuse is burnt out, replace it with a new one. Check the amperage of the affected circuit before replacing the blown fuse. If the amperage is equal to or greater than the rated current of the fuse, check the wiring and related components to check whether it is shorted. Housing [A] Fuse component [B] Joint [C] Blown fuse [D] Note ○If the battery is seriously undercharged, the fuse may be burnt out by a large current after starting the engine. Warning When replacing the fuse, make sure that the new fuse matches the rated current of specified fuse in the circuit.If a fuse whose current is higher than the rated value is installed, damage may be caused to the line or components. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 162 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Inspection and Maintenance of Chassis Torque Value Table of Chassis Fastener Fastening location and fastener name Tightening torque (N•m) Front axle mounting nut 100~113N·m Rear axle mounting nut 100~113N·m Mounting bolt of front brake cylinder assembly 22~29N·m Mounting bolt of rear brake cylinder assembly 22~29N·m Mounting bolt of front fuel pump assembly 5~9N·m Mounting bolt of rear fuel pump assembly 5~9N·m Mounting bolt of front brake disc 10~12N·m Mounting bolt of rear brake disc 10~12N·m Brake line mounting bolt 30N·m Front caliper mounting bolt 40∼44N·m Rear view mirror mounting bolt 22∼29N·m Meter mounting seat mounting bolt 10∼12N·m b Ka Clamp bolt of upper bracket Upper grip positioner mounting bolt Y P CO .A S Handlebar positioning double-end stud locknut IS N RA Steering column bearing locknut B A K E Steering columnGbearing nut R O Ebolt Upper clamp of shock absorber G Y A W Lower O clamp bolt of shock absorber T O M - 163 - im D - is n ra s o 22∼29N·m i r it 22∼29N·m 45∼50N·m 70N·m 2N·m 22∼29N·m 22∼29N·m a k -d Headlight bracket locknut 37∼44N·m Clamp mounting bolt 10∼12N·m Headlight mounting bolt 10∼12N·m Nut at the top of rear shock absorber 45∼50N·m Nut at the bottom of rear shock absorber 45∼50N·m Mounting nut of rear rocker arm axis 85∼98N·m Rear sprocket mounting nut 45∼50N·m Front seat mounting bolt 40∼45N·m Rear seat mounting bolt 10∼12N·m Fuel tank mounting bolt 10∼12N·m Mounting nut of fuel level sensor 5∼9N·m Fuel pump mounting bolt 3∼4N·m Sidestand bolt 45~50N·m Locknut of side stand bolt 45~50N·m Center stand bolt 45~50N·m Locknut of center stand bolt 45~50N·m Mounting screw of front pedal bracket 22~29N·m Ka is n ra b Front exhaust pipe mounting nut Rear mounting bolt of muffler cylinder I N A .A S S Lower mounting bolt of engine R B Upper mounting bolt K ofA engine E G Front mounting OR bolt of engine E G Y Rear upper mounting bolt of engine A OW T O P O C M Y - 164 - im D - s o i r it 22~29N·m 22~29N·m 45~50N·m 45~50N·m 45~50N·m 45~50N·m a k -d Upper hanging panel mounting bolt of engine 22~29N·m Left front hanging panel assembly mounting screw of 22~29N·m engine Right front hanging panel assembly mounting screw of 22~29N·m engine Left rear hanging panel assembly mounting screw of engine Right rear hanging panel assembly mounting screw of 22~29N·m 22~29N·m engine a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 165 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ABS brake a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 166 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 167 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fluid brake ABS A B C D E Free stroke of brake lever: 10-20mm Thickness of friction plate: 6.0 mm Use limit: 3.0mm Mounting torque value of bolt 3 in the figure: 30 N·m Mounting torque value of bolt 8 in the figure: 22-29 N·m Mounting torque value of nut 19 in the figure: 10-12 N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 168 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Chinese name and specifications Torque Number of N·m kgf·m 1 Front fuel pump assembly 1 — — 2 Washer 8 — — 3 Fuel hose mounting bolt 4 30 3.0 4 Front fluid brake fuel hose assembly I 1 — — 5 Front fluid brake fuel hose assembly II 1 — — 6 Front left brake cylinder assembly 1 — — 7 Brake pad assembly 1set — — 8 Double channel ABS assembly 1 — — 9 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×20 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 10 Oil cup assembly 1 — — 11 Rear fuel pump assembly 1 — — 12 Rear brake cylinder assembly 1 — — 13 Component of rear friction pad 1set — — 14 Rear fluid brake fuel hose assembly I 1 — — 15 Rear fluid brake fuel hose assembly II 1 — — 16 Bolt M8×25 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 17 Spring washer 8 2 — — 18 Rear fluid brake bracket 1 — — 19 Collar 2 — — Note AL R R AL AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 169 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d V. Brake Preparatory Information--------------------- 7.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 5.2 Front Brake Disc----------------------------- 5.3 Rear Brake Disc------------------------------ 5.4 Fluid Brake and ABS------------------------ 5.5 5.1 Preparatory Information Operation Precautions *Note • Do not expose the brake assembly to oil when installing or removing. • Use specified cleaning agent to avoid reducing brake performance. * Check brake before riding Technical parameters Item Brake lever, brake pedal Brake lever position Free clearance of brake lever Free clearance of pedal Pedal position Brake pad Thickness of friction pad: Front brake pad Rear brake pad Brake disc Outer diameter: Front brake disc: Rear brake disc: Thickness: Front brake disc: Rear brake disc: Oscillation Brake fluid Grading Y P CO Standard Lower operating limit 4-way adjustable (for riders to choose) Nonadjustable Adjustable Approximately 20 mm above the top of the footpeg ––– ––– ––– ––– 6.0 mm 4.0 mm Φ300mm φ240mm .A S S I N A R B A K E RG 4.8 ∼ 5.0mm 4.8 ∼ 5.0 mm ≤TIR 0.15 mm EO G Y A DOT4 W - 170 - is n ra b Ka 3 mm 3 mm ––– ––– 4.5 mm 4.5 mm TIR 0.3 mm ––– TO O M - - Dim s o i r it a k -d Torque value Front wheel axle mounting nut Rear wheel axle mounting nut Mounting bolt of front brake cylinder assembly Mounting bolt of rear brake cylinder assembly Mounting bolt of front fuel pump Mounting bolt of rear fuel pump assembly Mounting bolt of front fluid brake disc Mounting bolt of rear fluid brake disc Brake tube mounting bolt 100-113 N•m 100-113 N•m 22-29 N•m 22-29 N•m 5-9 N•m 5-9 N•m 10-12 N·m 10-12 N·m 30 N·m 5.2 Fault Diagnosis 5.2.1 Poor brake performance 1. Proper adjustment of brake 2. Wear of brake shoe, friction pad assembly and fluid brake disc 3. Improper installation of brake shoe and friction pad assembly 4. Pollution of brake shoe, friction pad assembly and fluid brake disc 5.2.1 Slow reaction of brake or tight lever 1. Proper adjustment of brake 2. Wear of brake shoe, friction pad assembly and fluid brake disc 3. Improper installation of brake shoe and friction pad assembly 5.2.1 Abnormal noise of brake a 1. Wear of brake shoe, friction pad assembly and fluid brake disc 2. Pollution of brake shoe, friction pad assembly and fluid brake disc b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 171 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.3 Front Brake Disc 5.3.1 Disassembly of front brake disc Remove the front axle Remove the front wheel. (see chapter “Front Wheel” – “Disassembly”) Remove the clamp screw [A] of front brake disc Note: After removing the front brake disc clamp screw, clean the residual glue on the screw thread with alcohol. Note: When disassembling the clamp screw of front brake disc, follow the instructions on the right figure a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 172 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.3.2 Installation of front brake disc ● Mount the brake disc on the wheel with the marked side facing outward. ○ Mount the sensor rotor on the brake disc with the marked side [A] facing outward Insert the front brake disc into the edge of rim, and insert 6 clamp screws [A] after applying one drop of thread sealant at the end of thread. *Note 1. Shake the bottle to make the sealant return to even, and prevent the nozzle from contacting with metallic substances. 2. Each thread engagement position should be applied with the sealant for more than 3-5 buckles, and the thread clearance shall be filled with sealant. Tighten the bolt to the brake disc in the form of a cross step by step, and tighten 6 screws according to the following torque value: Torque value: Clamp screw of brake disc 10-12N·m a b *Note • Do not expose the brake assembly to oil when installing or removing. • Use specified cleaning agent to avoid reducing brake performance. .A S S I N A R B A *Note K E RG If there is grease on the brake shoe, braking performance will be reduced and the brake will fail. O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 173 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.3.3 Inspection of front brake disc Check the brake disc for wear, and replace it if necessary. Measure the brake disc and record the maximum value. If the thickness of brake disc is smaller than the maintenance value, it should be replaced. Specifications Diameter of front fluid brake disc Thickness of front brake disc: Allowable limit: Thickness of front brake disc: *Note φ300mm 5.0mm 4mm • Use a micrometer for measurement. Measure the jump value at the edge of front brake disc Available limit 0.15mm 5.4 Rear Brake Disc 5.3.1 Disassembly of rear brake disc a Remove rear wheel. (see chapter “Rear Wheel” – “Disassembly”) Remove the clamp screw of rear brake disc [A] b Note: After removing the front brake disc clamp screw, clean the residual glue on the screw thread with alcohol. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 174 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Note: When disassembling the clamp screw of rear brake disc, follow the instructions on the right figure. 5.3.2 Installation of rear brake disc ●Mount the brake disc on the wheel with the marked side facing outward. ○ Mount the sensor rotor on the brake disc with the marked side [A] facing outward Insert the rear brake disc into the edge of rim, and insert 6 clamp screws [A] after applying one drop of thread sealant at the end of thread. a is n ra *Note 1. Shake the bottle to make the sealant return to even, and prevent the nozzle from contacting with metallic substances. 2. Each thread engagement position should be applied with the sealant for more than 3-5 buckles, and the thread clearance shall be filled with sealant. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 175 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Tighten the bolt to the brake disc in the form of a cross step by step, and tighten 6 screws according to the following torque value: Torque value: Clamp screw of brake disc 10-12N·m *Note • Do not expose the brake assembly to oil when installing or removing. • Use specified cleaning agent to avoid reducing brake performance. *Note If there is grease on the brake shoe, braking performance will be reduced and the brake will fail. 5.3.3 Inspection of rear brake disc Check the brake disc for wear, and replace it if necessary. Measure the brake disc and record the maximum value. If the thickness of brake disc is smaller than the maintenance value, it should be replaced. Specifications Diameter of rear fluid brake disc Thickness of rear fluid brake disc Allowable limit: Thickness of rear fluid brake disc *Note φ240mm 5.0mm 4mm • Use a micrometer for measurement. Measure the jump value at the edge of front brake disc Available limit 0.15mm a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 176 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.5 Brake lever, brake pedal 5.5.1 Adjustment of position of brake lever ●The brake lever adjuster has 4 positions so that the rider can adjust the position of the brake lever according to the size of his hand. ● Push the brake lever forward and rotate the adjuster [A] so that the number is aligned with the arrow mark [B] on the brake lever. ○ When the arrow mark is aligned with the number 4, the distance between the brake grip and the brake lever is the smallest; when the arrow mark is aligned with the number 1, the distance between the brake grip and the brake lever is the largest. Front 5.5.2 Inspection of position of brake pedal ● Check whether the brake pedal [A] is in the correct position. Footpeg [B] Pedal position [C] Standard: approximately 20 mm above the top of the footpeg ★ If the position of pedal is not correct, adjust the position of brake pedal. a 5.5.3 Adjustment of position of brake pedal b Note ○ Generally, it is not necessary to adjust the position of the pedal, but if the push rod lock nut is removed, the position of the pedal must be adjusted. ● Loosen the lock nut [A] and rotate the push rod [B] to make the pedal n the correct position. ● Locking torque Locking torque of push rod locknut of rear master cylinder: 10 N·m ●Check whether the brake light switch is normal (see “Inspection / Adjustment” – “Checking whether the brake light switch is able to work normally” for details) .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P is n ra T O M - 177 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.5.4 Disassembly of brake pedal ●Disassemble: Rear master cylinder mounting bolt [A] ●Disassemble: Brake pedal return spring [A] Link mounting screw [B] Rear brake pedal mounting bolt and gasket [C] Rear brake pedal [D] 5.5.5 Installation of brake pedal a ● Apply grease to the rear brake pedal mounting shaft [A] b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 178 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Install: Brake pedal [A], Rear brake pedal mounting screw and gasket [B] Torque value: Locking torque of brake pedal bolt: 10-12 N•m ● Hang the lower end of the brake pedal return spring [A] on the spring pin of frame. ● Hang the upper end of the brake pedal return spring [B] on the spring pin of frame. ●Rear rear master cylinder mounting screw [A]. Locking torque of rear master cylinder mounting screw: 10 N·m ○Press the brake pedal [B], align the joint hole of master cylinder, and install the mounting screw [C] and nut. Locking torque of joint mounting screw of rear master cylinder: 10 N·m ●Check the position of brake pedal (see "Checking the Position of Brake Pedal" for details). a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 179 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.6 Caliper 5.6.1 Disassembly of front caliper ● Loosen the hollow bolt [A] at the lower end of the brake hose and tighten it slightly. ●Unscrew the caliper mounting bolt [B], separate the caliper [C] and the brake disc. Note Do not remove the caliper mounting bolts.To remove the caliper, simply remove the caliper mounting bolts, as brake fluid may leak after removing the caliper mounting bolts. ● Remove the hollow bolt [A] and the brake hose on the caliper Note If brake fluid spills out, rinse it immediately! Note ○If you need to disassemble after removing the caliper and there is no compressed air available, please disassemble the caliper before removing the brake hose (see “Removing the Front Caliper” for details). 5.6.2 Disassembly of rear caliper ● Loosen the hollow bolt [A] at the lower end of the brake hose and tighten it slightly. ● Unscrew the caliper mounting bolt [B], separate the caliper [C] and the brake disc. Note Do not remove the caliper mounting bolts.To remove the caliper, simply remove the caliper mounting bolts, as brake fluid may leak after removing the caliper mounting bolts. ● Remove the hollow bolt [A] and the brake hose on the caliper Note If brake fluid spills out, rinse it immediately! Note ○If you need to disassemble after removing the caliper and there is no compressed air available, please disassemble the caliper before removing the brake hose (see “Removing the Rear Caliper” for details). a b is n ra R B A I N A .A S S K E 5.6.3 Installation of caliper G R O ● Install the caliper and the lower end of the brake hose. E G ○ Replace the gaskets on both sides of the hose joint with Y A new ones. OW ● Locking torque T O M - 180 Y P CO im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Locking torque of caliper mounting bolt: Front caliper: 34 N·m Rear caliper: 25 N·m Hollow bolt of brake hose: 25 N•m ● Check the level in the brake fluid reservoir. ● Discharge the air inside the brake line (see “Exhausting the Air inside the Brake Line” for details). ● Check whether the performance of brake is normal and the brake fluid leaks. Warning Clench the brake lever or step on the brake pedal until the brake pad is against the brake disc, thus allowing the brake pedal or brake pedal to perform its normal function.Do not ride a motorcycle before completing the above operations!If the above operations are not completed, the brake lever or pedal may not work properly when used for the first time. 5.6.4 Disassembly of front caliper ● Before removing the front caliper, first drain the front brake fluid. ●Loosen front caliper mounting bolt [B] and hollow bolt [A], and then gently remove them. ●Disassemble: Front caliper [C] (see “Removing the Front Caliper” in the chapter “Brakes”), a ●Disassemble: Front caliper assembly bolt [B] Front caliper assembly bolt [C] Front caliper [F] Front caliper [F] Front caliper [F] b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 181 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Remove the mounting pin [A] of brake pad ●Remove front brake pad spring [D], front left brake pad [B], front right brake pad [C] ●Remove the piston with compressed air. The method for removing piston is as follows: ○ Install a rubber gasket [A] and a wooden board [B] with a thickness of 10 mm (0.4 in.) or more in the middle of the caliper, and secure the rubber gasket and the wood board with the appropriate bolts and nuts, as shown in the figure. Open one of the oil ports [C]. ○Inject the compressed air [D] into oil port slowly, until the piston touches the rubber gasket. If the caliper is half open, block the hose joint [E] during operation. Press bolt [F] and nut: [G]. Warning To avoid serious injuries, do not put your fingers or palms in front of the piston!Otherwise, the piston may crush your hands or your fingers when the compressed air is injected into the caliper. ○ Pull out the piston by hands [A]. ● Remove the dust seal [B] and the oil seal [C]. Note a ○If compressed air is not available, remove the piston from both calipers as follows (connect brake hose to caliper). ○ Prepare a container to hold the brake fluid. Front brake pad spring and brake pad (see “Removing the Front Brake Plate” in the chapter “Brakes”). ○ Press the brake lever until the piston is pushed out of the brake cylinder, and then remove the caliper. b .A S S 5.6.5 Assembly of front caliper ● Clean the caliper parts (except the brake pads). Note I N A R B A K E RG Parts must be cleaned with disc brake fluid, isopropyl alcohol or ethanol! O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 182 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Replace the oil seal [A] with a new one. ○ Add silicone grease to the oil seal and install it into the brake cylinder by hands. ●If the dust seal [B] is broken, replace it with a new one! ○ Add silicone grease to the dust seal and install it into the brake cylinder by hands. ● Apply brake fluid to the outside of piston [A] and press it into the brake cylinder [B] by hands. ●Replace the guide post dust cover II [A] and the guide post dust cover II [D]. ● Apply grease to the guide post dust cover I [A] and the guide post dust cover II [D], and install the guide post [B] and the guide post [C]. ● Apply some thread fastening glue to the threads of the front caliper mounting bolts and tighten the bolts. Locking torque of front caliper mounting bolt: 27 N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 183 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.6.7 Disassembly of rear caliper ● Before removing the rear caliper, first drain the brake fluid. ●Loosen the hollow bolt of rear caliper [A], and then gently tighten them (Tighten them a little bit, and do not tighten too much). ● Unscrew the caliper mounting bolt [B], separate the caliper [C] and the brake disc. ●Disassemble: Rear caliper [B] (see “Removing the Rear Caliper” in the chapter “Brakes”), Brake plate (see “Removing rear brake pad” in the chapter “Brakes”), Rear caliper assembly bolt, O-Ring ● Remove the piston on the caliper as follows. ● The method of removing the piston on the caliper is the same as the method of removing the front caliper. ● Use a piece of wood against the piston on the caliper, blow compressed air into the brake hose joint to squeeze the piston of caliper Warning To avoid serious injuries, do not put your fingers or palms behind the piston!Otherwise, the piston may crush your hands or your fingers when the compressed air is injected into the caliper. ●Disassemble: Oil seal [A], Dust seal [B], Guide post dust cover I [C], Guide post dust cover II [D], Dust cover of bleed screw [E] a b is n ra Note ○If compressed air is not available, remove the piston from both calipers as follows (connect brake hose to caliper). ○ Prepare a container to hold the brake fluid. Front brake pad spring and brake pad (see “Removing rear brake pad” in the chapter “Brakes”). ○ Press the brake lever to remove the caliper piston. .A S S I N A R B A K E G 5.6.8 Assembly of rear caliper R EO ● Clean the caliper parts (exceptG the brake pads). Y Note A Parts must be cleaned OW with disc brake fluid, isopropyl T alcohol or O ethanol! M Y P O C - 184 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Install the bleed screw and bleed screw cap. Locking torque of bleeder screw: 7.8 N·m ●Apply brake fluid to the inner wall of brake cylinder. ● Replace the oil seal [A] with a new one. ○ Add silicone grease to the oil seal and install it into the brake cylinder by hands. ● Replace the dust seal [B] with a new one. ● Apply brake fluid to the outside of piston and press it into the brake cylinder by hands. ●Replace the guide post dust cover II [C] and the guide post dust cover II [D]. ● Apply grease to the guide post dust cover I [C] and the guide post dust cover II [D], and install the guide post [A] and the guide post [B]. ●Apply some thread fastening glue to the threads of the rear caliper mounting bolts and tighten the bolts. Locking torque of rear caliper mounting bolt: 37 N·m Install brake pad (see “Installing rear brake pad” in the chapter “Brakes”). ●Wipe the brake fluid splashed onto the caliper with a damp cloth. a b 5.6.9 Inspection of fluid sea of caliper for damage ●In order to maintain a gap between the brake pad and the brake disc, an oil seal (piston seal) [A] is placed around the piston. If the oil seal is damaged, the brake pads may be excessively worn and the brakes may fail, thus causing the temperature of the brake pad or brake fluid to rise. ● If any of the following conditions occur in the fluid seal, please replace it! ○ The brake fluid leaks around the brake pads. ○The brake temperature is too high. ○ The wears of the inner and outer surfaces of brake pad vary greatly. ○ The oil seal and the piston are stuck together. ★ If you replace the oil seal, please replace the dust seal .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 185 - is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka k -d [B]. In addition, all oil seals must be replaced each time when the brake pads are replaced. 5.6.10 Inspection of dust seal of caliper for damage ● Check the dust seal [B] for cracks, wear, expansion or other damage. ★ If any dust seal is damaged, please replace it with a new one! Piston [C], Oil seal [A] a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 186 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.6.11 Inspection of the caliper piston and brake cylinder for damage ● Visually inspect the piston [A] and the brake cylinder surface [B]. ★ If the brake cylinder and piston are severely worn or rusted, please replace the caliper! 5.7 Brake pad 5.7.1 Remove the front brake pad a ● Before removing the front caliper, first drain the front brake fluid. ●Loosen front caliper mounting bolt [B] and hollow bolt [A], and then gently remove them. ●Disassemble: Front caliper [C] (see “Removing the Front Caliper” in the chapter “Brakes”), b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 187 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Remove the mounting pin [A] of brake pad ● Remove front brake pad spring [D], front left brake pad [B], front right brake pad [C] Note When the pin A is pulled out, the safety spring B should be pressed 5.7.2 Installation of front brake pad ● Push the caliper piston by hand as far as possible. ●Install: Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. ● Check: brake fluid level [A]; if it is below the minimum score, add the recommended brake fluid to the correct level. ● Check: Brake lever operation; if the brake lever is soft or slight, exhaust the air in the brake circuit. Warning Grasp the brake lever until the brake pad is against the brake disc, thus allowing the brake lever to perform its normal function.Do not ride a motorcycle before completing the above operations!If the above operations are not completed, the brake may not work properly when used for the first time. 5.7.3 Disassembly of Rear Brake Pad a ● Remove the bolt [A] from the brake caliper and rotate the rear caliper [C] in the B direction. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 188 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Completely lift rear brake caliper[C] ●Disassemble: Brake pad [D] 5.7.4 Installation of rear brake pad ● Push the caliper piston by hand as far as possible. ●Install: Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. ● Install the caliper (see “Installing Caliper” for details). ●Check brake fluid level [A]; if it is below the minimum score, add the recommended brake fluid to the correct level. ● Check: Brake pedal operation; if the brake pedal is soft or slight, exhaust the air in the brake circuit. Warning Grasp the brake lever until the brake pad is against the brake disc, thus allowing the brake lever to perform its normal function.Do not ride a motorcycle before completing the above operations!If the above operations are not completed, the brake may not work properly when used for the first time. a b 5.7.5 Inspection of wear of brake pad ● See “Inspection / Adjustment” – "Inspection of Wear of Brake Pad" for details. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 189 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.8 Master cylinder 5.8.1 Disassemble front master cylinder ● Loosen the hollow bolt [A] at the lower end of the brake hose and tighten it slightly. Note Do not remove the caliper mounting bolts.To remove the caliper, simply remove the caliper mounting bolts, as brake fluid may leak after removing the caliper mounting bolts. ●Disconnect the front brake light switch connector [A]. a ●Disconnect the front master cylinder mounting bolt [A]. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 190 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Remove the hollow bolt [A] and the brake hose on the caliper [B] Note If brake fluid spills out, rinse it immediately! ● Remove the front master cylinder component. ●Disassemble: Brake lever pivot shaft bolt [A] Locknut [B] Brake lever [C] Front brake light switch mounting screw [D]. Spring shim [E] Flat washer [F] Front brake light switch [G] Front master cylinder [H] 5.8.2 Installation of front master cylinder ●Install: Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. ●Lock the upper clamp bolt [A] first, and then tighten the lower clamp bolt [B]. Locking torque of front master cylinder fastening bolt: 10 N·m ●Replace the gaskets on both sides of the hose joint with new ones. ● Locking torque Locking torque for hollow bolt of brake hose: 30 N•m ● Discharge the air inside the brake line (see “Exhausting the Air inside the Brake Line” for details). ● Check whether the performance of brake is normal and the brake fluid leaks. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 191 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.8.3 Disassembly of rear master cylinder ●Remove the reservoir [A] ● Discharge the brake fluid into a container. Note If brake fluid spills out, rinse it immediately! ●Disassemble: Rear brake light switch sensor [A] Brake hose [B], Fuel pump mounting screw [C] Rear master cylinder [D] Note If brake fluid spills out, rinse it immediately! 5.8.4 Installation of rear master cylinder ● Replace the gaskets on both sides of the hose joint with new ones. ●Install: Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. ● Locking torque Locking torque of rear master cylinder mounting screw: 10 N·m Locking torque of rear brake light switch sensor: 30 N•m ●Discharge the air inside the brake line (see “Exhausting the Air inside the Brake Line” for details). ●Check whether the performance of brake is normal and the brake fluid leaks. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 192 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.8.5 Disassembly of front master cylinder ● Remove the front master cylinder (see “Disassembly of Front Master Cylinder” in the chapter “Brakes”). ● Remove the reservoir cap mounting screw [F], reservoir cap [E], connector [C] and O-ring. ● Unscrew the locknut [E] and the pivot bolt [F], and then remove the brake lever. ● Remove the circlip [G]. Special tool—inside circlip pliers: ● Pull out the piston assembly [H]. Note It is forbidden to remove the cup [I] from the piston, because it may be damaged once removed. ●Replacement Sealing cap: [A], Circlip: [B], O-ring seal: [D], Circlip: [G], Piston assembly: [H], Diaphragm: [I]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 193 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.8.6 Disassembly of rear master cylinder ● Remove the rear master cylinder (see “Disassembly of Rear Master Cylinder” in the chapter “Brakes”). ● Remove the connector [H] and the seal [H]. ● Slide the dust cover [A] out ● Remove the circlip [B]. Special tool—inside circlip pliers: ●Remove the piston assembly [D] and the return spring [F]. Note It is forbidden to remove the cup [C] and cup [E] from the piston, because it may be damaged once removed. ●Replacement Dust cover [A] Circlip: [B], Piston assembly [D], Seal [H], Diaphragm: [I]. 5.8.7 Assembly of master cylinder ● Before assembly, clean all parts with brake fluid or alcohol, including master cylinder. Note Except brake pad and disc, other brake parts can only be cleaned with disc brake fluid, isopropyl alcohol or ethanol. Dot not clean the above parts with other liquid.Gasoline, oil or other gasoline distillates may corrode rubber parts.If oil spills onto any part, it will be difficult to clean thoroughly and eventually corrode the rubber parts inside the disc brake. ●Apply brake fluid to new parts and inner wall of brake cylinder. ●Be careful not to scratch the piston or the inner wall of brake cylinder. ●Apply silicon grease to the brake lever pivot bolt. ●Tighten the brake lever pivot bolt and locknut. Locking torque of fastening screw of front brake fluid reservoir cap: 1.2N·m Locking torque of front brake lever pivot bolt: 3.0 N·m; Locking torque of locknut of front brake lever pivot bolt: 6 N·m; a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 194 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.8.8 Check the master cylinder (visual inspection) ● Remove the master cylinder (see “Disassembly of Front / Rear Master Cylinder” for details). ● Remove the front and rear master cylinders (see "Inspection / Adjustment" - "Replacing Rubber Parts of Master Cylinder" for details). ●Inspect the inner wall of each master cylinder and the outer surface of each piston for scratches, rust or dents. ★ If any master cylinder or piston is damaged, please replace them! ● Check the primary cup and secondary cup. ★ If the cup is worn, damaged, softened (corroded) or swelled, the entire piston (including cup) should be replaced. ★ If you find that brake fluid is leaking from the brake lever, replace the the entire piston (including cup)! ●Check the dust cover for damage. ★ If the dust cover is damaged, please replace it! ● Check whether the piston return spring is damaged. ★ If the piston return spring is damaged, please replace it! ● Check whether the relief port and supply port are blocked. ★ If the relief port is blocked, the brake pad may produce resistance to the brake disc. Clean all oil holes using the compressed air 5.9 Brake fluid 5.9.1 Inspection of level of brake fluid ● See "Inspection / Adjustment" — "Inspection of Level of Brake Fluid" for details. a 5.9.2 Replacement of brake fluid ●Park the motorcycle on a flat ground Note ○Support the motorcycle with a parking rack and make sure that it is upright ●Check brake fluid level ★ If it is lower than the minimum mark of oil immersion lens [A], add the recommended brake fluid to the correct level. ● Remove the brake fluid cylinder cover [B] from the brake pump ● Check the brake fluid cylinder diaphragm on the cylinder. If there is any damage/wear, please replace the brake fluid cylinder diaphragm Note Brake fluid may quickly corrode the surface of painted part, so if the brake fluid spills on any plastic part, it must be thoroughly rinsed immediately. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 195 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Hold the brake handle and add brake fluid until the brake fluid level is above the oil immersion lens of master cylinder Warning Use only the prescribed brake fluid.Other brake fluids may cause deterioration of rubber gasket, thus resulting in leakage and improper operation of brake system. Use the same brand of brake fluid in the process of adding brake fluid.The mixture of different brake fluids may cause harmful chemical reactions and thus result in the reduction of brake system performance. When adding brake fluid, be careful not to allow any water to enter the container.Water will significantly reduce the boiling point of the brake fluid, which will generate steam bubbles when heated, and thus lead to a reduction in brake system. Note ○ The steps for replacing the front brake fluid are as follows.The procedures for replacing the rear brake fluid are the same as the procedures for replacing the front brake fluid. ●Replacement of brake fluid 1. With the main cylinder level, remove the brake fluid cylinder head. 2. Install the pipe on the front end of oil drain screw [A] and prepare the oil pan at the front end of hose. 3. Loosen the oil drain screws. 4. Operate the brakes for several times until the oil drain screw no longer discharges the brake fluid. 5. Tighten oil drain screw. 6. Inject the brake fluid above the lower limit. 7. Pull the brake handle to fill the brake fluid hose with brake fluid. 8. Slowly move the brake handle until no bubbles appear in the small holes in the brake cylinder and a force is felt at the the brake handle. 9. Release the air. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 196 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d After the adjustment is completed, install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Note ○ Frequently check the brake fluid level of reservoir and replenish the new brake fluid as needed. If the brake fluid in the reservoir is used up during the replacement of brake fluid, the air in the brake hose must be drained. ● Remove the transparent plastic hose. ● Install the diaphragm and reservoir cap. ●Properly install the rear brake fluid reservoir cap according to the following procedures. ○ First, tighten the front / rear brake fluid reservoir cap [B] with your hands clockwise [C] until you feel a little resistance, indicating that the cap has been fixed on the reservoir of master cylinder of storage tank, then hold the brake fluid reservoir cap [A] and rotate it by 1/6 turn [D]. ● Tighten: Locking torque of fastening screw of front brake fluid reservoir cap: 1.2N·m ●Tighten the bleeder screw and install the rubber cover. Locking torque of bleeder screw: 7.8 N·m ● After replacing the brake fluid, check whether the performance of brake is good, whether the braking is blocked, and whether the brake fluid leaks. ★ If necessary, blow out the air in the brake hose. a b 5.9.3 Exhaust the air inside the brake line The brake fluid has a very small compression factor, so almost all operations of brake lever or brake pedal are transmitted directly to the caliper, thus producing a braking effect. But the air is easy to compress. If air enters the brake line, part of the operations of brake lever or brake pedal will be used to compress the air, thus causing the brake lever or brake pedal to become soft and reducing braking performance. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG Warning If the brake lever or brake pedal is soft after replacing the brake fluid or loosening the brake line joint, the air inside the brake line must be exhausted. O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 197 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Note ○ The steps for exhausting the air from the rear brake line are as follows.The steps of for exhausting the air from the front brake line are the same. Order of releasing the air 1. Remove the brake fluid cylinder head. 2. Remove the brake fluid cylinder diaphragm. 3. Install the pipe on the front end of oil drain screw and prepare the oil pan at the front end of hose. 4. After braking for a few times, grasp the brake lever and loosen the oil drain screw by about 1/2 turn, and then tighten it again. 5. Repeat the above operations until all bubbles are removed from the oil drain screw. 6. Install the brake fluid cylinder diaphragm 7. Install the brake fluid cylinder head Note ○ The level of brake fluid must be checked frequently in the process of exhausting the air, and replenish the fluid as needed.If the brake fluid in the reservoir is completely exhausted in the process of exhausting air, the exhaust operation must be repeated because the air may have entered the brake line. ○ To exhaust the air more thoroughly, tap the brake hose between the caliper and reservoir. Warning The precautions for handling disc brakes are as follows: 1. It is forbidden to reuse brake fluid! 2. If the container containing the brake fluid is not sealed or has been opened for a long time, the brake fluid inside the container must not be used! 3. Do not mix brake fluids of different types or brands. This will reduce the boiling point of the brake fluid, resulting in brake failure or corrosion of rubber brake parts. 4. Do not open the reservoir cap for a long time to prevent the brake fluid from getting wet. 5. Do not replace brake fluid in rain or strong winds! 6. In addition to brake pads and brake discs, only disc brake fluid, isopropyl alcohol or alcohol can be used to clean the brake parts. Do not clean the above parts with any other liquid! Gasoline, oil or other gasoline distillates may corrode rubber parts. Gasoline, oil or other gasoline distillates may corrode rubber parts. If oil is splashed on any part, it will be difficult to completely clean and eventually corrode the rubber parts inside the disc brake. 7. When handling brake pads or brake discs, prevent any brake fluid or other oil from splashing on them. If you accidentally spill any brake fluid or other oil on the brake pads or discs, clean them using solvent with a high flash point! Do not use any solvents that may leave oily residues! If the brake fluid or oil cannot be completely removed from the brake pad, replace it with a new one! 8. The brake fluid may quickly corrode the surface of a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 198 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d painted part, so if any brake fluid spills, it must be wiped! 9. The air in the brake line must be drained whenever the brake line connector or exhaust valve is opened! 5.10 Brake hose 5.10.1 Disassembly / installation of brake hose and brake line Note Brake fluid may quickly corrode the surface of painted part, so if the brake fluid spills on any plastic part, it must be thoroughly rinsed immediately. ●Remove the hollow bolt of brake hose [A]. ●When removing brake hose, be careful not to spill brake fluid on any painted part. ●When removing brake hose [B], temporarily fix the end of brake hose in a high place to minimize the loss of brake fluid. ●If brake fluid overflows, clean it immediately. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 199 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra ●All sides of brake line fittings are equipped with washers. They needs to be replaced with new ones when installed. ● Tighten: Locking torque for hollow bolt of brake hose: 25 N•m ● Avoid excessively bending, snarling, squeezing or twisting the brake hose when installing, and arrange the brake hose in accordance with the section "Winding Method of Cables, Wires and Hoses" of chapter "Appendix". ●Fill the brake line with brake fluid after installing brake hose. (See “replacement of brake fluid” for details). .A S S im D - s o i r it I N A R B A K E RG EO G 5.10.2 Inspection Y of brake hoses and replacement of brake lines A OW Note T O M - 200 Y P CO Ka k -d Brake fluid may quickly corrode the surface of painted part, so if the brake fluid spills on any plastic part, it must be thoroughly rinsed immediately. Remove the rear brake hose clamp [A]. ●When removing the rear brake hose, be careful not to spill brake fluid on any painted part. ●When removing the rear brake hose [B], temporarily fix the end of brake hose in a high place to minimize the loss of brake fluid. ●If brake fluid overflows, clean it immediately. ●The rear brake fuel hose needs to be replaced with new ones when installed. ● Avoid excessively bending, snarling, squeezing or twisting the brake hose when installing, and arrange the brake hose in accordance with the subsection "Winding Method of Cables, Wires and Hoses" of chapter "Appendix". ●Fill the rear brake hose with brake fluid after installation. (See “replacement of brake fluid” for details). a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 201 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11 Anti-lock brake system (ABS) 5.11.1 Part position a 1. Front wheel speed sensor 2. Gear ring of front wheel speed sensor 3. Rear wheel speed sensor 4. Gear ring of rear wheel speed sensor 5.ABS self-diagnosis system connector 6.ABS fuse box 7. ABS hydraulic mechanism 8. ABS indicator (LED). b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 202 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.2 ABS system circuit diagram 1. ABS Switch 2. Ignition Switch 3. Installation of Ground Wire 5. Ignition Fuse 6.ABS Fuse (40A) 7. Meter panel 8.ABS Diagnostic System Connector 9. Front Wheel Speed Sensor 10. Rear Wheel Speed Sensor a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 203 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.3 Pin name a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 204 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.4 ABS overhaul 5.11.4.1 Precautions for ABS overhaul There are the following important precautions in the process of overhauling the ABS system. ○The power supply of this ABS system must be supplied by a 12V sealed battery.Do not use any other power source! ○Do not connect the battery cable reversely. Otherwise, the ABS hydraulic mechanism will be damaged. ○ To avoid damage to ABS parts, do not disconnect the battery cable or any other electrical connectors while the ignition switch is in the “ON” position or while the engine is running. ○Be careful not to short-circuit the wire that directly connect the positive (+) electrode of the battery and the ground wire of the chassis. ○If any ABS electrical connector is disconnected, do not turn the ignition switch to “ON”! The ABS hydraulic mechanism will remember the fault code. ○Do not spray water on electrical parts, ABS parts, joints, wires and electric wires! ○If the motorcycle is equipped with a transceiver, ensure that the operation of the ABS system is not affected by the radio waves emitted by the antenna.The antenna shall be as far away as possible from the ABS hydraulic mechanism. ○Turn the ignition switch to “OFF” before the ABS electrical connector is disconnected. ○Do not hit the ABS parts with a hammer or drop the ABS parts on a hard surface. Otherwise, the ABS parts will be damaged. It is not allowed to disassemble the ABS parts!Even if it is found that the ABS parts are faulty, do not disassemble the ABS parts for repair. Please replace them directly! ABS has many brake tubes and wires.And ABS can not detect the faults of traditional brake systems (wear of brake disc, uneven wear of brake pad and other mechanical faults).In order to prevent faults, please check whether the brake tube is properly connected, whether the electric wires are arranged correctly, and whether the brake performance is normal.Remember to check the brake fluid for leakage and completely discharge the air from the brake tube! Warning If any brake tube connectors are loosened, including the coupling nut or bleeder screw of the ABS hydraulic mechanism, the air in the brake tube must be discharged. K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 205 - is n ra b .A S S I N A R B A Note If there is air in the brake tube, do not ride the motorcycle, otherwise the ABS will fail. a im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ○If the tire pressure is incorrect and the other tires or wheels installed instead of those recommended by the manufacturer are deformed, the ABS indicator (LED) [A] will be on. If the indicator is on, please remove the faults and delete the fault code! Warning If the other tires are used instead of those recommended by the manufacturer, the ABS will fail and the braking distance will increase, resulting in a traffic accident for the rider. Therefore, this motorcycle must use the standard tires recommended by the manufacturer.If the other tires are used instead of those recommended by the manufacturer, the ABS will fail and the braking distance will increase, resulting in a traffic accident for the rider. Therefore, this motorcycle must use the standard tires recommended by the manufacturer. ○If the engine is started when the motorcycle is supported by the bracket and it is not in the neutral position, the ABS indicator (LED) will be on. If the indicator is on, turn the ignition switch to “OFF” and clear the fault code (front wheel speed sensor failure). ○ ABS will make noise when it is running, and the rider will feel the reaction force of the brake rod and brake pedal. This situation is normal and is intended to alert the rider that ABS is running normally.○ ABS will make noise when it is running, and the rider will feel the reaction force of the brake rod and brake pedal. This situation is normal and is intended to alert the rider that ABS is running normally. ○ Once the ABS hydraulic mechanism detects a fault code, it will remember the fault code. Therefore, after the overhaul is completed, remember to delete the fault code! However, do not delete the fault code during troubleshooting. Please delete the fault code until all inspections and repairs have been completed to avoid the repeated entry of the previous fault code and unnecessary overhaul work. ○ All the fault codes stored in the ABS hydraulic mechanism must be deleted before the motorcycle is delivered to the customer. Ensure that the ABS indicator (LED) will be on by using the diagnosis features.In order to make the diagnosis accurate, make sure that the battery is fully charged. Try riding the motorcycle (driving speed: above 20km/h (12mph)) and observe whether the ABS indicator (LED) will be on. Finally, try riding the motorcycle (driving speed: above 30km/h (20mph)), slam the brake and observe whether the motorcycle can stop smoothly, and whether the ABS works normally (you can feel the reaction force of the brake pad and brake pedal).So far, the inspection process is finished. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 206 - is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.4.2 Overview of ABS fault removal If an error occurs to ABS, the ABS indicator (LED) will be on to alert the rider. In addition, the fault information will be stored in the memory of the ABS hydraulic mechanism. Therefore, after faults are removed, you must delete the fault code and start the diagnostic program to confirm that the signal output is normal. If the ABS fault indicator (LED) is constantly on, first thoroughly find out the background of the fault and then start the repair work.For example, ask the rider about the current situation [B] when the fault occurs and try to determine the cause of the fault [C].Do not completely rely on the ABS self-diagnosis function, and combine common sense to remove faults.For example: Check whether the brake performance is normal, whether the brake fluid level is correct and whether the brake fluid leaks. Under the following circumstances, the ABS indicator (LED) will be on even if ABS is running normally.At that time, please turn the ignition switch to “OFF” to turn off the indicator. If you ride the motorcycle again without deleting the fault code, the indicator will become on again. ○ The rider rides the motorcycle on the undulating road all the time. ○ When the motorcycle is supported by the bracket, the engine is started and is not in the neutral position, and the rear wheel is rotated. ○ The front wheel leaves the ground due to sudden acceleration. ○ ABS is suffered from severe electrical interference. ○ The tire pressure is abnormal.Please adjust the tire pressure! ○ The tires with different specifications from those of standard tires are used.Please replace them with standard tires! ○ The wheels are deformed.Please replace the wheels! Most ABS fault removal work involves verifying whether the circuit is normal.The ABS parts have been assembled and adjusted by the manufacturer, so there is no need to disassemble or repair the ABS parts.However, the ABS hydraulic mechanism can be replaced if necessary. The basic fault removal steps are shown below: ●Carry out the pre-diagnosis inspection (preliminary inspection). ●Determine the fault by using the self-diagnostic function. ●Check the joints of the ABS hydraulic mechanism and the circuits and connectors between the suspected faulty ABS parts with a multimeter. Special tool: Multimeter: a b K E RG O O CO Y P T O M .A S S I N A R B A E G Y A W is n ra - 207 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Visually check whether the electric wires are burnt or worn. ★ If any electric wires are damaged, please replace them! ● Disassemble each connector [A] and check whether the inside is corroded, dirty or damaged. ★ If any connector is corroded or contaminated, carefully clean it!If the connector is damaged, replace it! ● Check whether the circuit is normal. ○ Find both ends of the wire that may fail by using the circuit diagram. ○ Connect the multimeter with both ends of the wire. Special tool—multimeter: ○ Set the range of the multimeter to ×1Ω, and then read the reading of the multimeter. ★ If the reading of the multimeter is not 0Ω, it indicates that the wire is damaged.Replace the main cable [B] if necessary. ● Repeat the conduction detection of the circuit to reduce the number of the parts that may fail and then detect the ABS parts. ★ If the circuit and the connectors are normal, the next suspect object is the ABS parts, and they shall be detected one by one. ★ If it is found that any ABS part is abnormal, please replace it! a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 208 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.4.3 ABS diagnostic flow chart A fault occurs Identify the fault Collect information from the rider Carry out the pre-diagnosis inspection (Phase 1 and Phase 2). Make diagnosis Check by other means than diagnosis Check by diagnosis If there is a problem with the cable or connector If there is a problem with the ABS part Repair or replacement Check ABS parts With Replacement NG Final inspection OK End a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 209 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Questions need to be asked for the rider ○ Each rider reacts differently to the fault, so it is necessary to confirm which problem the rider is experiencing. ○ By asking the rider, find out what went wrong and under what circumstances.Only by knowing clearly about the faults can you help yourself to reproduce the problem in the workshop. ○ Diagnostic tables can help you avoid ignoring any key points, so you must use a diagnostic table. Sample of diagnostic table Name of rider: Registration number (license plate number): First registration year: Model: Engine number: Frame number Date of fault: Frequency: Weather Mileage: Phenomenon □The brake lever vibrates or makes noise □The indicator light is flashing □The brake pedal vibrates or makes noise □The indicator light is always on □Brake distance is too long □The brake lever moves abnormally □ The brake pedal is moving abnormally □ABS failure □ABS can run, but the indicator light is out □ ABS runs too frequently □ At startup The state of engine in the event □ After startup of a fault □Speed: ≥5000r/min Road conditions □The road surface is very slippery (□ snow road, gravel road, □ other) □The road is undulating □Other Driving conditions □Turn a corner at high speed □ Driving speed ≥10km/h (6mph) □ Driving speed ≥10km/h(6mph) □ Parking □Turn a corner Brake □ Gentle braking □ Sudden braking Other conditions □The brake lever stroke is large □ The pedal stroke is large a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 210 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.4.4 Carry out the pre-diagnosis inspection (Phase 1) ● Level in the brake fluid reservoir. NG Replenish brake fluid. NG Repair the brake line. NG Repair or replace the master cylinder. NG Replace the defective parts. NG Repair or replace the caliper. NG Replace the wheel bearing or rear axle. OK Check the brake fluid for leakage. OK Check the function of the brake lever and brake pedal. OK Check the brake pads and brake discs. OK The front and rear wheels should be able to rotate smoothly without any braking resistance. OK The free clearance of the wheel bearing should not be too large. The bending amount of rear axle or the runout of brake disc should not be too large. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 211 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.4.5 Carry out the pre-diagnosis inspection (Phase 2) Check the ABS indicator (LED). No (not be on) ○ Is the indicator light on after the ignition switch is turned "on"? Check power cables and meter panels Yes Check whether the light is flashing after pressing and holding the ABS switch for 3-5 seconds. No (not flash) Check the cable line, check whether the connector is plugged in properly, and check whether the front and rear wheel speed sensors are damaged. Yes Is the indicator light on after the ignition switch is turned "off" and then "on"? No (not be on) Check power cables and meter panels Yes (on) Drive for more than 1 minute (including 1 minute) at ≥6km/h (3.7mph) Is the indicator light off when the motorcycle is Yes running? ABS is normal No Make a diagnosis and find the fault code for repair or replacement. Ask the rider whether the fault has occurred again. 5.11.4.6 Overview of diagnosis The ABS hydraulic mechanism will remember and store the fault code so that the service personnel can easily troubleshoot it. The fault code memory is directly powered by the battery and cannot be removed by the ignition switch. The ABS hydraulic mechanism is able to remember all the fault codes (6 codes). If there are more fault codes, all the existing fault codes (6 codes) must be deleted before they can be stored in the ABS hydraulic mechanism. If there is no fault, the ABS indicator (LED) light will be on, indicating that "ABS is OK". Self-diagnostic procedures ○If any fault occurs in ABS, the ABS indicator (LED) [A] will be on. b is n ra Note ○ A fully charged battery must be used for diagnostics, otherwise, the indicator light may flash very slowly or not flash. ○The motorcycle is in a stopped state. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 212 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d 5.11.4.7 Check the ABS indicator (LED) ● Rotate the ignition switch to "ON". ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) [A] is on for a while and automatically goes out, it is normal. ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) is always on, skip to the following steps: “ABS indicator light (LED) is on (motorcycle is driving – no fault code)”. ● Rotate the ignition switch to "OFF". ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) [A] is out, it is normal. ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) is always on, skip to the following steps: “ABS indicator light (LED) is on (rotate the ignition switch to "OFF")”. 5.11.4.8 ABS indicator (LED) is on (rotate the ignition switch to "OFF") ● Conduct the Step I of test. ○ Check the pin voltage between the black/white lead terminal of the meter connector [A] and the ground wire. Special tool—multimeter: ○ Rotate the ignition switch to "ON". Pin Voltage Standard: about 10V ★ If the pin voltage is not within the specified range, perform the Step II. ★ If the pin voltage is correct, replace the meter. ● Conduct the Step II of test. ○ Disconnect the meter connector. ○ Check the line between the black/white lead terminal of the connector at main cable side [A] and the ground wire. ★ If the line is normal, replace or repair the main cable. ★ If the line is abnormal, perform Step III. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 213 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Conduct the Step III of test. ○ Disconnect the ABS hydraulic mechanism connector. ○ Check the line between the black/white lead terminal of connector at the main cable side [A] and the black/white lead terminal of connector at the main cable side [B]. ★ If the line is normal, replace the ABS hydraulic mechanism. ★ If the line is abnormal, replace or repair the main cable. 5.11.4.9 ABS indicator (LED) is on (motorcycle is driving - no fault code) ●Test ○ Disconnect the ABS hydraulic mechanism connector and meter connector. ○ Check the line between the black/white lead terminal of ABS connector at the main cable side [A] and the black/white lead terminal of wheel speed sensor connector at the main cable side [B]. Check the front/rear wheel speed sensor and gear ring for damage. Check whether the ABS fuse on the cable is normal. Special tool—multimeter: ★ If the line, front/rear wheel speed sensor and gear ring are normal, and the fuse is also normal, replace the ABS hydraulic mechanism. ★ If the line, front/rear wheel speed sensor and gear ring, fuse are not normal, replace or repair them. Battery terminal voltage Standard: battery voltage ≥ 12V a ★ If the battery terminal voltage is not within the specified range, replace the battery. ★ If the battery terminal voltage is normal, perform the next step. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 214 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.4.10 The difference between front and rear wheel speeds is abnormal (fault code: front: C0084~C0088; rear: C0104~C0108) ● Conduct the Step I of test. ○Perform the following checks and repair defective parts. The tire pressure is abnormal; Non-recommended standard tires are installed on motorcycles (tire specifications are incorrect); Deformation of wheel or tire; the rotating teeth of sensor rotor are cracked or blocked by foreign matters. ★If the above parts are normal, perform Step II. ● Conduct the Step II of test. ○Recheck the fault code; delete the fault code and regain the fault code. ★If the ABS indicator light (LED) [A] is on, the ECU fault code indicates that the ABS hydraulic mechanism is faulty. Therefore, the ABS should be replaced. ★If the ABS indicator light (LED) is out, the ABS is normal (no fault code is stored; temporary fault). 5.11.4.11 Wheel speed sensor is open or shorted (front: C0080~C0083; rear: C0100~C0103) ○Check whether the ABS sensor connector is loose or not inserted properly ○Check whether the ABS sensor is damaged ★ If the wheel speed sensor is damaged, replace the wheel speed sensor. 5.11.4.12 Check the line of wheel speed sensor (fault code: front: C0080-C0083; rear:C0100-C0103) nis ra ● Conduct the Step I of test. ○ Disconnect the ABS hydraulic mechanism connector and the front wheel speed sensor connector. ○ Connect the two lead terminals of connector at the main cable side with a jumper and check the line between the two lead terminals of connector at the main cable side. ★ If the line is not normal, perform Step II. ★ If the line is abnormal, replace or repair the main cable. .A S S I N A R B A ● Conduct the Step II of test. ○ Connect the two lead terminals of connector at the main cable side with a jumper and check the line between the two lead terminals of connector at the main cable side. ★If the line is normal, replace the front wheel speed sensor. K E RG CO EO G Y or repair the main cable. ★ If the line is abnormal, replace A OW T O M Y P - 215 - im D - s o i r it b Ka a dk 5.11.4.13 Relay fault (C0044-C0046) ★ Replace ABS. 5.11.4.14 ABS normally open valve solenoid circuit is open-circuited or the resistance is too large (front: C0121; rear: C0161) ★Replace ABS. 5.11.4.15 ABS normally closed valve solenoid circuit is open-circuited or the resistance is too large (front: C0131; rear: C0171) ★ Replace ABS. 5.11.4.16 ABS voltage is too high, ABS voltage is too low (too high: C0053; too low: C0047, C0052) Standard: battery voltage ≥ 12V ★ If the battery terminal voltage is not within the specified range, replace the battery or charge and discharge. 5.11.4.17 ABS pump or motor fault (C0070-C0074) ★ There is still a fault after ensuring the line is normal. Please replace the ABS. 5.11.4.18 Intermittent signal of wheel speed sensor (front: C0084-C0088; rear: C0104-C0108) ○ Check whether the clearance between the wheel speed sensor and the gear ring surface is between 0.5-1.2 mm. ○Check whether the wheel speed gear ring is deformed or any tooth is missing ★ If the clearance is not within the range, adjust the clearance ★ If wheel speed gear ring is damaged, replace wheel speed gear ring a 5.11.4.19 ABS wheel speed difference is too high ○ Check whether the wheels or tires with different specifications have been replaced ○Check whether the tire is winded in situ ★Use the wheel and tires the same as the originals ★ Please turn off the electric door lock after the tire is winded in situ, then open the electric door lock b .A S S 5.11.4.20 Brake diode breakdown (C0062) ○Check whether the diode of the main cable of the motorcycle body harness is intact ★ If the diode is damaged, replace it I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 216 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.4.21 Brake switch line fault (C0060-C0061) ○ABS function will not be affected. Please disconnect the ABS hydraulic mechanism connector and check the line between brake signal cable to the ABS connector. ★ If the line is normal, please repair the main cable. ★ Test it for several times; if the line is normal, please clear the fault code and retest the ABS. 5.11.4.22 ABS indicator light (LED) fault (C0210-C0213) ○ Disconnect the ABS hydraulic mechanism connector and check the line between ABS indicator cable to the ABS connector terminal. ★If the line is abnormal, please repair the main cable. ★ If the line is normal, please replace the meter panel and retest. 5.11.4.23 Speed output port fault (C0230-C0231) ○ Disconnect the ABS hydraulic mechanism connector and check the line between wheel speed output port to the ABS connector terminal. ★If the line is abnormal, please repair the main cable. ★ If the line is normal, please replace the meter panel and retest. 5.11.4.24 Front wheel speed sensor signal is abnormal (fault code: C0084-C0088) ● Conduct the Step I of test. ○ Measure the clearance between the front wheel speed sensor and the sensor rotor. Feeler gauge [A] b Clearances Standard: 0.5-1.2mm (0.02-0.047in.) ★ If the measured value is beyond the above standards, check each part for deformation or looseness and adjust accordingly. Re-measure the clearance. ★ If the measured value is normal, perform Step II. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 217 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d ● Conduct the Step II of test. ○ Check whether there are iron filings or other magnetic deposits between the sensor [A] and the sensor gear ring [B], and whether the groove of sensor gear ring is clogged. ○ Check the installation of the sensor and observe whether it is loose. ○ Check the tip of the sensor and sensor gear ring for deformation or damage (eg, the teeth of the sensor gear ring are notched). ★ If the sensor and sensor gear ring are in poor conditions, clean the deposit on it and reinstall or replace the defective parts correctly. ★ If the above parts are normal, perform Step III. ● Conduct the Step III of test. ○ Recheck the fault code; delete the fault code, perform the pre-diagnosis check (Phase I and II), and re-read the fault code. ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) [A] is on, the ECU fault code indicates that the ABS hydraulic mechanism is faulty. Therefore, the ABS hydraulic mechanism should be replaced. ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) is out, the ABS is normal (no fault code is stored; temporary fault). 5.11.4.25 Rear wheel speed sensor signal is abnormal (fault code: C0104-C0108) ● Conduct the Step I of test. ○ Measure the clearance between the rear wheel speed sensor and the sensor gear ring. Feeler gauge [A] Clearances Standard: 0.5-1.2mm (0.02-0.047in.) a b ★ If the measured value is beyond the above standards, check each part for deformation or looseness and adjust accordingly. Re-measure the clearance. ★ If the measured value is normal, perform Step II. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 218 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Conduct the Step II of test. ○ Check whether there are iron filings or other magnetic deposits between the sensor [A] and the sensor gear ring [B], and whether the groove of sensor gear ring is clogged. ○ Check the installation of the sensor and observe whether it is loose. ○ Check the tip of the sensor and sensor gear ring for deformation or damage (eg, the teeth of the sensor gear ring are notched). ★ If the sensor and sensor gear ring are in poor conditions, clean the deposit on it and reinstall or replace the defective parts correctly. ★ If the above parts are normal, perform Step III. ● Conduct the Step III of test. ○ Recheck the fault code; delete the fault code. ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) [A] is on, the ECU fault code indicates that the ABS hydraulic mechanism is faulty.Therefore, the ABS hydraulic mechanism should be replaced. ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) is out, the ABS is normal (no fault code is stored; temporary fault). 5.11.4.26 Check ECU (fault code: C0044-C0046) ● Conduct the Step I of test. ○ Recheck the fault code; delete the fault code, perform the pre-diagnosis check (Phase I and II), and re-gain the fault code. ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) [A] is on, the ECU fault code indicates that the ABS hydraulic mechanism is faulty. Therefore, the ABS hydraulic mechanism should be replaced. ★ If the ABS indicator light (LED) is out, the ABS is normal (no fault code is stored; temporary fault). a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 219 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.5 ABS hydraulic mechanism 5.11.5.1 Disassemble ABS hydraulic mechanism Note The ABS hydraulic mechanism have been precisely set and adjusted before leaving the factory, so care must be taken during operation. Never use a hammer to strike it or drop it on a hard surface and prevent it from touching or be stuck to the mud. ● Discharge the brake fluid from the front brake line and the rear brake line. ○Press the brake lever and pedal to release the brake fluid through the bleed screw. ●Disassemble: battery (see “Electrical System” - “Removal of Battery”). ●Disassemble Bolt [A] ●ABS cover [B] a is n ra ● Clean the ABS hydraulic mechanism. Note Clean all connectors on the ABS hydraulic mechanism and the rear master cylinder, as the dirt around the hollow bolts may contaminate the brake fluid during the removal/installation of brake line. Before removing the brake hose, lay a rag around the ABS hydraulic mechanism to prevent the brake fluid from seeping into the parts. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 220 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Remove the brake line connecting bolts [A], [B], [C], [D]. ● Seal the opening of brake hose with a tape to prevent brake fluid from leaking or foreign matter from contaminating the brake fluid. Note Brake fluid may quickly corrode the painted part, so if the brake fluid spills on any plastic part, it must be thoroughly rinsed immediately. ● Disconnect the connector [A]. ○ Loosen the connector [B] by the method as shown on the right. ●Remove the bolt [A]. ●Remove the ABS hydraulic mechanism and bracket [B]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 221 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Remove the bolt and bracket. Note ABS hydraulic mechanism has been precisely set and adjusted before leaving the factory, so do not disassemble and repair the ABS hydraulic mechanism! 5.11.5.2 Install ABS hydraulic mechanism ● Install the ABS hydraulic mechanism on the bracket [B]. Note Brake fluid may quickly corrode the painted part, so if the brake fluid spills on any plastic part, it must be thoroughly rinsed immediately. ●Lock the bolt [A] to the frame. ●Arrange the wires correctly and securely fasten the connector [A]. ○ Mount the joint [B] by the method as shown on the right. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 222 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Install the brake line correctly, as shown in the figure. ● Lock the brake line connecting bolts [A], [B], [C], [D]. Locking torque for connecting nut of brake line: 17 N•m ● Discharge the air inside the brake line (see “Exhausting the Air inside the Brake Line” for details).| ● Check whether the performance of brake is normal and the brake fluid leaks. ●Install the parts disassembled previously (see the corresponding chapters). 5.11.5.3 Check ABS hydraulic mechanism ●Remove the ABS hydraulic mechanism (see “Removing the ABS Hydraulic Mechanism” for details). ● Visually inspect ABS hydraulic mechanism. ★ If the ABS hydraulic mechanism is cracked or damaged, please replace it! ● Visually inspect the connector terminal [A]. ★ If the ABS hydraulic mechanism or main cable is cracked, bent or damaged, please replace it! ★ If the ABS hydraulic mechanism connector is blocked by mud or dust, blow it off with compressed air. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 223 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.6 Speed sensor 5.11.6.1 Remove front wheel speed sensor Note Wheel speed sensors are precisely machined, so care must be taken during operation. Never use a hammer to strike it or drop it on a hard surface and prevent it from touching or be stuck to the mud. Do not disassemble or repair the wheel speed sensor! ●Disassemble: Headlight [see "Removing Headlight" for details], Front wheel speed sensor connector [A] ● Remove the connector. ●Disassemble: Bolt [A] Front wheel speed sensor [B] a b is n ra 5.11.6.2 Install front wheel speed sensor ●Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. ○Properly arrange the wire (see "Appendix" - "Winding Method of Cables, Wires and Hoses" for details). .A S S I N A R B A K E G sensor 5.11.6.3 Remove rear wheel speed R EO G Note Yare precisely machined, so A Wheel speed sensors OWduring operation. Never use a care must beTtaken O M Y P O C - 224 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d hammer to strike it or drop it on a hard surface and prevent it from touching or be stuck to the mud. Do not disassemble or repair the wheel speed sensor! ●Disassemble: Right cover (see “Removing Right Cover” for details). Rear wheel speed sensor connector [A] ● Remove the connector. ●Disassemble: Bolt [A], Rear wheel speed sensor [B] 5.11.6.4 Install rear wheel speed sensor a ●Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. ○ Properly arrange the wire (see "Appendix" - "Winding Method of Cables, Wires and Hoses" for details). b 5.11.6.5 Check front wheel speed sensor ●Remove the front wheel speed sensor [A] from the front fork. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 225 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Remove the rear wheel speed sensor from the caliper bracket [A] ●Visually inspect wheel speed sensor. ★ If the wheel speed sensor is cracked, bent or damaged, please replace it! 5.11.6.6 Check the clearance of wheel speed sensor ★ Lift the front / rear wheel from the ground with a jack (see “Wheels/Tires” - “Removing Front / Rear Wheel”). ●Slowly rotate the wheel and measure the clearance at several different points between the sensor and the sensor gear ring. Feeler gauge [A] Feeler gauge [B] Clearances Standard: Front wheel: 0.5-1.2mm Rear wheel: 0.5-1.2mm Note ○ Sensor clearance cannot be adjusted. a ★ If the clearance is not within the specified range, check the hub bearing (see “Wheel/Tire” – “Checking Hub Bearing”), the installation and function of sensor (see “Checking Wheel Rotation Sensor” for details). b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 226 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 5.11.6.7 Check the gear ring of wheel speed sensor ●Disassemble: Wheel (see “Wheel/Tire” – “Removing Front / Rear Wheel”) Brake plate mounting bolt [A], Sensor gear ring [B] ● Visually inspect the gear ring of wheel speed sensor. ★ If the rotor is deformed or damaged (there is a notch [A] on the rotating tooth), please replace it with a new one! ★ If there are iron filings or other magnetic deposits on the rotor [B], please clean! a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 227 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 228 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Front fender *Note Do not damage the covering parts of body when disassembling. Remove the body in the following order The insert plate and cover plate of body are aligned with their slots respectively. The hooks of parts should be installed correctly when assembling. Do not damage the fittings when installing covering parts. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 229 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Front fender assembly 1 — — 2 Cross recessed pan head screw M5×106 4 — — 3 Hexagon nut M5 4 — — 4 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×12/polished head 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 5 Fluid brake hose clamp 1 — — 6 Cross recessed pan head screw M6×16 2 — — 7 Front fender rubber assembly 1 — — 8 Hexagon flange nut M6 3 10~12 1.0~1.2 9 Front wheel speed sensor bracket 1 — — 10 Front wheel speed sensor 1 — — 11 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×16 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 12 Hexagon socket cap screw M10×50 2 40~44 4.0~4.4 Note S AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 230 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Cover *Note Do not damage the covering parts of body when disassembling. Remove the body in the following order The insert plate and cover plate of body are aligned with their slots respectively. The hooks of parts should be installed correctly when assembling. Do not damage the fittings when installing covering parts. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 231 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Left cover of engine II 1 — — 2 Left cover of engine I 1 — — 3 Bolt M5×12 5 10~12 1.0~1.2 4 Screw M6×15.2 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 5 Right cover of engine I 1 — — 6 Right cover of engine II 1 — — 7 Screw M6×20 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 8 Collar 2 — — 9 Rubber collar 2 — — 10 Left protector 1 — — 11 Right protector 1 — — Note S AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 232 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Rear fender 1 a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 233 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Front part of rear fender 1 — — 2 Bolt M6×19.2 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 3 Screw M6×15.2 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 4 Rear right turn signal light 1 — — 5 Taillight 1 — — 6 Self-locking nut M6 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 7 Tail of rear fender 1 — — 8 License plate light 1 — — 9 Flat washer Φ5 2 — — 10 Spring washer φ5 2 — — 11 Hexagon nut M5 2 — — 12 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×12/polished head 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 13 Collar 2 — — 14 Rear left turn signal light 1 — — 15 Rear reflector 1 — — 16 Rear license holder 1 — — 17 Connecting plate of rear left and right pedal 1 — — 18 Hexagon flange nut M6 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 19 Reinforcing plate at the tail of rear fender 1 — — 20 Headlight bushing 2 — — Note AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 234 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d Rear fender a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 235 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Bolt M10×1.25×20 6 10~12 1.0~1.2 2 Rear fender assembly 1 — — 1 — — 2 — — 1 — — Front reinforcing plate assembly II of rear 3 fender 4 Rear rack screw I Front reinforcing plate assembly II of rear 5 fender Note 6 All-metal hexagon flange locknut M10 6 40~44 4.0~4.4 AL 7 Left rear pedal assembly 1 — — 8 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×12/polished head 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 9 Handle 2 — — 10 Inner hexagon screw M10×80 2 40~44 4.0~4.4 AL 11 Hexagon socket cap screw M10×60 4 40~44 4.0~4.4 AL 12 Hexagon socket cap screw M10×16 2 40~44 4.0~4.4 AL 13 Washer 10 2 — — 14 Left frame cover assembly 1 — — 15 Hexagon bolt with flange M8×45 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 AL 16 Self-locking nut M8 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 AL 17 Right rear pedal assembly 1 — — 18 Right cover assembly of frame 1 — — 19 Liner tube of container 2 — — 20 Hexagon socket cap screw M10×60 6 40~44 4.0~4.4 AL AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 236 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d VI. Body Cover Remove the body in the following order Seat cushion → left/right cover → left/right cover of engine → left/right handle → left/right cover assembly of frame ↓ → left/right rear pedal assembly → rear fender assembly → rear left/right turn signal light → tail light → tail of rear fender ↓ →license plate light → rear reflector → rear license plate support → reinforcing plate at tail of rear fender → front of rear fender ↓ → front fender assembly *Note Do not damage the covering parts of body when disassembling. Remove the body in the following order The insert plate and cover plate of body are aligned with their slots respectively. The hooks of parts should be installed correctly when assembling. Do not damage the fittings when installing covering parts. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 237 - a b is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Front wheel A Tire size: 100/90-19 Rim specifications: 2.15×19 spoked wheel B Rim runout limit value: Vertical: 2.0 mm Horizontal: 2.0 mm C D Diameter of front fluid brake disc: 300mm Bending limit of front wheel axle: 0.2mm a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 238 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Front wheel axle 1 100~113 10.0~11.3 2 Front wheel left collar 1 — — 3 Screw M6×20 6 10~12 1.0~1.2 4 Front wheel gear ring 1 — — 5 Front brake disc 1 — — 6 Dust ring 2 — — 7 Air valve 1 — — 8 Front wheel rim assembly 1 — — 9 Inner tube and cushion belt 1 — — 10 Inner and outer tubes 1 — — 11 Front wheel right collar 1 — — 12 Slef-locking nut M16×1.5 1 100~113 10.0~11.3 Note G L、S G AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 239 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Console assembly a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 240 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Left rearview mirror assembly 1 — — 2 Right rearview mirror assembly 1 — — 3 Handlebar assembly 1 — — 4 Screw M6×35 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 5 Washer 6 2 — — 6 Spring washer 6 2 — — 7 Handle block 2 — — 8 Left handlebar jacket 1 — — 9 Left combination switch 1 — — 10 Right combination switch 1 — — 11 Right grip assembly 1 — — 12 Throttle cable assembly 1 — — 13 Clutch cable assembly 1 — — 14 Clutch handle component 1 — — 15 ABS switch assembly 1 — — 16 Screw M6×25-8.8-ZG 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 17 Bolt M6×12 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 18 Washer Φ6 1 — — 19 Self-locking nut M6 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 20 Brake pedal welding assembly 1 — — 21 Hexagon socket cap screw M12×50 1 50~55 5.0~5.5 22 Brake mounting base 1 — — 23 Joint M6 1 — — 24 Washer Φ6 1 — — 25 Bolt M6×25 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 26 Rear foot pump piston screw 1 — — 27 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×25 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 28 Brake pedal return spring 1 — — 29 Hexagon bolt M6×30 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 30 Hexagon flange nut M6 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 s o i r it Note a is n ra b Ka AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 241 - im D - k -d Front Fork a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 242 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Chinese name and specifications 1 Torque Number Note of N·m kgf·m Hexagon socket cap screw M18×25 4 22~29 2.2~2.9 2 Upper handlebar holder 1 — — 3 Lower handlebar holder 2 — — 4 Damper 4 5 Handlebar positioning double-end stud 2 — — 6 Clamp screw of upper bracket 1 25 2.5 7 Upper bracket 1 — — 8 Bolt M8×25 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 AL 9 Self-locking nut M10×1.25 2 45~50 4.5~5.0 AL 10 Hexalobular socket pan head screw M6×20 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 11 Clamp nut of upper bracket 1 70 7.0 12 Nut 1 2 0.2 13 Dust ring 2 — — 14 Steering bearing 2 — — 15 Lower bracket assembly 1 — — 16 Bolt M10×1.25×20 4 22~29 2.2~2.9 17 Lower mounting bracket of headlight 1 — — 18 Fluid brake hose clamp 1 — — 19 Front license holder 1 — — 20 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×20 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 21 Front reflector 2 — — 22 Front left shock absorber assembly 1 — — 23 Front right shock absorber assembly 1 — — AL、S AL R、G AL、S AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO:Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 243 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d VII. Front Wheel/Front Suspension Preparatory Information-------------------------7.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 7.2 Front Wheel----------------------------------- 7.3 Handlebar------------------------------------- 7.4 Front Fork------------------------------------- 7.5 Front Shock Absorber----------------------- 7.6 7.1 Preparatory Information Operation Precautions Before the front wheel is disassembled, support the bottom of the motorcycle with jacks and do not reverse the front wheel when it floats above the ground. There should be no grease attached to the friction pad, friction pad assembly or fluid brake disc during operation. Technical parameters Measuring position Item Front wheel axle Bending degree Front wheel Torque value Tools Rim shimmy Standard value (mm) Allowable limit (mm) 0.2 Vertical direction Horizontal direction is n ra 2.0 Within 1.0 s o i r Front axle locknut Bearing removal rod 100∼113 N·m it m Front caliper mounting bolt Locknut wrench 40∼44 N·m Di Rear view mirror mounting bolt Torque wrench 22∼29 N·m A . S Meter mounting seat mounting bolt 10∼12 N·m S I Clamp bolt of upper bracket 22∼29 N·m N A Upper grip positioner mounting bolt 22∼29 R N·m B Handlebar positioning double-end stud 45∼50 A N·m K locknut E G Steering column bearing locknut 70 N·m R O E Steering column bearing nut 2 N·m G Upper clamp bolt of shockY absorber 22∼29 N·m A Lower clamp bolt ofW shock absorber 22∼29 N·m O Headlight bracket 37∼44 N·m T locknut O M - 244 Y P CO 2.0 b Ka a k -d 10∼12 N·m 10∼12 N·m Clamp mounting bolt Headlight mounting bolt 7.2 Fault Diagnosis 7.2.1Turning Difficulty of Handlebar The handlebar bearing fails. The handlebar bearing fails. The tire pressure is too low. Tire leaks. 7.2.2Instability of Direction The handlebar bearing fails. The tire pressure is not enough. The front fork and front wheel axle are bent. The front wheel tire is deformed and deviates. 7.2.3 Front Wheel Shimmy The rim is deformed. The front wheel axle bearing is worn. Detective tire. 7.2.4 Rotation Difficulty of Wheel The wheel axle bearing fails or the gear seat fails. a 7.2.5 Abnormal Sound of Front Shock Absorber Friction sound of shock absorber guard. The bolts of all parts of shock absorber are loose. b 7.3 Front Wheel 7.3.1 Disassembly .A S S I N A Note: The motorcycle must be firmly supported. R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 245 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove Front wheel axle locknut [A]. Remove the front wheel axle [A] Remove the front wheel a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 246 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 7.3.2 Inspection 7.3.2.1 Bending Inspection of Wheel Axle Put the wheel axle on the V-shaped seat and measure the eccentricity with a dial gauge. Available limit: Replace the wheel axle if the eccentricity is 0.2mm above Axle 7.3.2.2 Rim Shimmy Inspection Put the rim on an accurate bracket and check the amplitude of the rim. Rotate the wheel with hands and read the amplitude. Available limit: Vertical direction: Replace the rim if the amplitude is 2.0mm or above. Horizontal direction: Replace the rim if the amplitude is 2.0mm or above. swinging swinging swinging swinging a 7.3.2.3Inspection of Front Wheel Bearing b Bearing The front wheel rotates unsmoothly or it is too loose→Replace the bearing Oil Seal Damage/wear→Replacement .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 247 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 7.3.2.4 Inspection of spoke Check the spoke ①, replace it if bent or damaged; tighten it if loose. Tighten the spoke; the locking torque of spoke is 3.0n ·m. 7.3.3 Replacement of Bearing 7.3.3.1 Disassembly of Bearing Remove the oil seal [1]. Note: To avoid damaging the rim, please put a cloth [2] between the screwdriver and the surface of rim Remove the bearing [3] with a bearing puller. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 248 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 7.3.3.2 Inspection of Bearing Check the rolling conditions of bearing. If the bearing does not roll, it may be worn or loose and thus it should be replaced with a new one. Clearance Clearance Axial direction Radial direction 7.3.3.3 Installation of Bearing Note: The bearing disassembled should be replaced with a new one. Then push the bearing with bearing installation tools. *Note Do not apply pressure on the inner race ring [1] or ball bearing [2] of wheel bearing and only apply pressure to the outer race ring [3] of bearing Use the seat in line with the diameter of outer race ring [4] of bearing 7.3.4 Installation a Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Note •The oil seal on the front wheel should be lubricated. •The engagement part or mobile part of gear seat assembly should be lubricated. b Note • When the odometer gear seat assembly fails to lock the front wheel axle, the odometer gear seat assembly will be deformed. • After the wheel axle is installed, rotate the wheel to confirm whether the speedometer drive shaft rotates. .A S S I N A R B A Torque value: Front wheel axle locknut K E RG EO N·m 100-113 G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 249 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 7.4 Handlebar 7.4.1 Disassembly Disassemble Remove the left rearview mirror assembly [A] Remove the left rearview mirror assembly [B] a Remove Primary cylinder of front brake [A] b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 250 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove Left lever assembly [B] Remove Mounting bolt of grip end assembly [A] Grip end assembly [B] a b Remove Left combination switch [A] .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 251 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove Right combination switch [A] Throttle grip [B] Remove Left handlebar cover [A] *Note: Compress the compressed air between the left handlebar and left handlebar grip [1] and slowly press the left handlebar grip. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 252 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the mounting screw at the upper seat of handlebar [A] Remove upper seat of handlebar [B] Remove the handlebar assembly 7.4.2 Inspection test. Handlebar Deformation / bending→replacement a b is n ra 7.4.3 Installation Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Torque value: Mounting screw at the upper seat of handlebar 22-29N•m Mounting screw of grip end 10-12 N•m Mounting bolt of left lever assembly 10-12 N•m Mounting bolt of primary cylinder of front brake 10-12 N•m I N A .A S S R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 253 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d *Note: When installing the mounting screw at the upper seat of handlebar, finally fix the 2 screws [A] below *Note: When installing the left lever assembly, first fix the screw [A] below 7.5 Front Fork a 7.5.1 Disassembly Support the center stand of motorcycle. Remove the meter (see Chapter VI for details) Remove headlight (see Chapter VI for details) Remove the handlebar (see this section for details) Remove the front wheel (see this section for details) Remove the front fender (see Chapter VI for details) Remove the caliper of front brake (see Chapter V “Brake” for details) b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 254 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Loosen the clamp bolt of upper bracket [A] Disassemble Supporting bolt [A] Upper bracket [B] Loosen the clamp bolt of lower bracket[A] Remove the front shock absorber a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 255 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Remove locknut of steering stem [E]. Special tool - steering stem locknut wrench (four-claw): ●Remove nut of steering stem [E]. Special tool - steering stem nut wrench (seven-claw): Special tool - steering stem locknut wrench (four-claw): 300-QCLM4-001 Special tool - steering stem nut wrench (seven-claw): 300-QCLM7-001 a b Disassemble Upper steel bowl of upper bearing [A] .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 256 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble Support and lower bracket [A] 7.5.2 Inspection of Steering Column test. Steering column Deformation / bending→replacement a Clean the rolling ball and bearing race test. Bearing race[A] Ball[B] Wear/damage→Replacement b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 257 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Replacement step: Disassemble the bearing race with a long rod ① and a hammer and remove it from the groove of head pipe, as shown in the figure Disassemble the bearing race of steering lever with a flat chisel ② and a hammer, as shown in the figure *Note: Balls, bearing races and dust seals are always replaced in sets. The ball and bearing race mounted obliquely will cause the wear of rack, therefore, they shall be mounted horizontally carefully. Do not strike the surfaces of ball and direction axle. 7.5.3 Installation Install it in the reverse process of disassembly *Note Apply grease to the steel bowl of bottom bearing confirm that the number of balls (21), check whether the handlebar is not rotatable (to prevent the steel balls from falling) and then install the steering stem. Support the handlebar, apply grease to the steel bowl of top bearing and confirm the number of balls (19). (17) Apply grease to the race of top seat. Apply grease to the race of top seat. Rotate the handlebar horizontally to make the steel balls contact tightly. *Note When installing the front shock absorber, first tighten the clamping bolts. Ensure that the end of inner fork is flush with the head of handlebar. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG Torque value: Nut of steering axle 2 N·m Locknut of steering axle 70 N·m Upper clamp bolt of front shock 22∼29 N· absorber Lower clamp bolt of front shock 22∼29 N·m O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 258 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d absorber Mounting bolt at the bracket of headlight Mounting bolt at the lower bracket of headlight Mounting bolt of brake clamp Mounting bolt of front fender bracket 10∼12 N·m 10∼12 N·m 10∼12 N·m 10∼12 N·m ● Replace the inner race of bearing and oil seal with new ones. ●Apply grease to oil seal. ● Put the oil seal [A] on the steering stem, then install the inner race of lower ball bearing [B] and apply grease to the steering stem [C]. Special tool - special tooling for installing the steering tube bearing [D]: ● Install the lower ball bearing [A] to the steering stem. ● Apply grease to the following parts. Inner and outer races, lower and upper ball bearings ○The lower ball bearing is the same as the upper ball bearing. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 259 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Note: Assemble or disassemble the steering axle nut [1] with a steering nut wrench [1]。 Note: Make the torque wrench perpendicular to the steering nut wrench. Rotate the direction axle left and right several times to check whether it rotates smoothly. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 260 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Diagram of front shock absorber O-ring ø33×2.65 End cap Liner tube Washer Dust cap Oil seal clip Oil seal 41×54×11 Collar clip DU collar 1 Damping spring a Piston ring Buffer spring b DU collar 2 Front branch tube combination .A S S Piston pipe Positioning sleeve Y A W I N A R B Sealing washer A K Inner hexagon screw EM10×30 G OROuter cylinder E G O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 261 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 7.6 Front Shock Absorber 7.6.1 Disassembly Disassemble Cap bolt ① and O-ring seal Oil drainage Disassemble Plug ① Spring ② Disassemble Dust ring ① Wire clamp ② a Note: Do not damage the surface of inner tube b is n ra Disassemble Bolt ① Hold the shock absorber lever and loosen the bolts with the T-shaped handle ② and the shock absorber clamp. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 262 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble Bolt ① Washer ② Disassemble Oil seal ① 7.6.2 Inspection test. Bending degree of inner tube a b in both ships Free length of front shock absorber spring: 319.5mm Minimum free length: 314.5mm .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 263 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d test. Damper rod ① Shock absorber piston ring ② Scratch, damage, bending → Replacement Spring ③ Oil plug rod ④ Wear, damage→Replacement Waste→Clean all oil holes using the compressed air Note: Do not attempt to straighten the bent damper bar, otherwise, it may seriously damage the damper rod. 7.6.3 Installation Install it in the reverse process of disassembly Note Be sure to use the following new parts when reassembling the shock absorber Oil Seal Dust ring Ensure that all parts are clean before re-installation Installation Shock absorber piston ring ① Spring ② a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 264 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Installation Damper rod ① Oil plug rod ② Inner tube ③ Outer tube ④ Installation Washer ①New Bolt (damper rod) ② Note: When assembling bolt adhesive ② , add thread-locking Tighten Bolt (damper rod) ① Torque value: 15-20N•m Note a Tighten the bolt ① of damper rod with the T-shaped handle ② and the shock absorber clamp. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 265 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Installation Oil seal ①New Installation Dust ring ①New Wire clamp ②New test. Extension of inner tube Unable to extend smoothly - recheck after disassembly a Refuel Measuring cup ① Shock absorber: SA40 Oil capacity: 450±2ml b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 266 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d After refueling, slowly move the shock absorber [1] up and down, to fill the tube with oil Installation Plug ① Spring ② Installation Cap bolt ① and O-ring seal Note Do not damage the surface of inner tube Torque value of cap bolt: 12-18 N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 267 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Rear wheel and rear drive A Tire size: 130/80-18 Rim specifications: 3.00×18/spoked wheel B Rim runout limit value: Vertical: 2.0 mm Horizontal: 2.0 mm C Diameter of rear fluid brake disc: 240mm D Bending limit of rear wheel axle: 0.2mm E Chain specification: 525HO-1×110 F Sprocket specification: 46 teeth a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 268 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m Note 1 Rear wheel axle M16×1.5×310 1 100~113 10.0~11.3 2 Left collar of rear wheel 1 — — 3 Lip-type seal assembly 1 — — R、G 4 Circlip Φ62 1 — — R 5 Bearing 0×62×23.8 1 — — 6 O-ring seal φ53×φ3.55 1 — — 7 Chain drive collar 1 — — 8 Self-locking nut M10×1.25 5 45~50 4.5~5.0 9 Chain 525HO-1×110 1 — — 10 Sprocket 46-gear 1 — — 11 Sprocket hub 1 — — 12 Sprocket mounting bolt M10×1.25×41 5 45~50 4.5~5.0 13 Rear wheel damper 5 — — 14 Air valve 1 — — 15 Rear wheel rim assembly 1 — — 16 Inner tube and cushion belt 1 — — 17 Tire and tube 130/80-18 1 — — 18 Dust seal of rear hub 1 — — 19 Right collar of rear wheel 1 — — 20 Rear brake disc component 1 — — 21 Screw M6×20 6 10~12 1.0~1.2 22 Screw M6×12 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 23 Rear wheel speed sensor mounting base 1 — — 24 Rear wheel speed sensor 1 — — 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 25 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×12/polished head 26 Rear brake bracket assembly 1 — — 27 Slef-locking nut M16×1.5 1 100~113 10.0~11.3 G R、G AL、S R、G L、S a is n ra AL b Ka AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 269 - im D - s o i r it k -d Rear Suspension a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 270 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m Note 1 Rear rocker arm mounting shaft 1 85~98 8.5~9.8 G 2 External collar of rear rocker arm 2 — — 3 Oil seal of rear rocker arm 2 — — G 4 Elastic collar for hole φ30 2 — — R 5 Needle bearing NA6903 2 — — G 6 Rolling bearing 61903-2RS/P26 2 — — 7 Middle shaft sleeve of rear rocker arm 1 — — 8 Self-locking nut M14×1.5 1 85~98 8.5~9.8 AL 9 Rear rocker arm welding assembly 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 AL 10 Chain protective block 1 — — 11 Screw M6×12 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 12 Collar 2 — — 13 Chain adjuster assembly 2 — — 14 Rubber washer of protector 1 — — 15 Drive chain cover 1 — — 16 Screw M6×15.2 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 17 Washer 6 — — 18 Rear shock absorber assembly 2 — — 19 Rear rack mounting collar 2 — — 20 Cap nut M10×1.25 4 45~50 4.5~5.0 AL AL AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 271 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d VIII. Rear wheel/rear suspension Preparatory Information---------------------8.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 8.2 Rear Wheel------------------------------------8.3 Rear Shock Absorber------------------------ 8.4 Rear Rocker Arm-----------------------------8.5 Chain Drive ----------------------------------8.6 8.1 Preparation of Information Note for operation There should be no oil stains attached on the surface of brake disc or friction pad. Technical parameters Item Swinging amplitude of rear wheel Standard value (mm) Available limit (mm) Vertical direction 2.0 Horizontal direction 2.0 a is n ra Torque value Mounting nut of rear wheel Nut at the top of rear shock absorber Nut at the bottom of rear shock absorber Mounting nut of rear rocker arm axis Mounting nut of rear sprocket R B A K E RG 8.2.1 Rear Wheel Shimmy O E G Y A W Deformation of rim Wear of rear wheel bearing Tire fault Wear or damage of rocker arm pivot shaft bearing O CO Y P .A S S I N A 8.2 Fault Diagnosis T O M b 100-113 N•m 45-50 N·m 45-50 N·m 85-98 N·m 45-50N·m - 272 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Improper adjustment of drive chain adjuster Bent frame or rocker arm 8.2.2 Inflexible rotation of wheel Incorrect adjustment of brake Wear of rear wheel bearing Too tight drive chain 8.2.3 Poor brake performance Incorrect adjustment of brake The friction pad of brake is worn The fluid brake disc is worn Improper installation of brake friction pad 8.2.4 Inflexible Brake Pedal or Slow Return Wear or break of return spring Incorrect adjustment of brake The fluid brake disc is worn or dirty Improper installation of brake friction pad 8.2.5 Abnormal sound of brake The friction pad of brake is worn The fluid brake disc is worn The friction pad of brake is dirty The fluid brake disc is dirty a 8.3 Rear wheel 8.3.1 Disassembly b Support the center stand and park the motorcycle, so that the motorcycle is lifted from the ground. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 273 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove Rear brake caliper [A] Loosen Chain adjuster bolt [A] Disassemble Rear wheel axle mounting nut [A] a b is n ra Disassemble Rear wheel axle [A] Pull out the rear wheel axle from right side to left side .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 274 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble rear wheel 8.3.2 Inspection 8.3.2.1 Bending Inspection of Wheel Axle Put the wheel axle on the V-shaped seat and measure the eccentricity with a dial gauge. Available limit: Replace the wheel axle if the eccentricity is 0.2mm above a Axle is n ra 8.3.2.2 Rear Rim Shimmy Inspection Put the rim on an accurate bracket and check the amplitude of the rim. Rotate the wheel with hands and read the amplitude. Available limit: Vertical direction: Replace the rim if the amplitude is 2.0mm or above. Horizontal direction: Replace the rim if the amplitude is 2.0mm or above. b swinging swinging .A S S swinging swinging I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 275 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 8.3.2.3 Inspection of Rear Wheel Bearing Bearing The front wheel rotates unsmoothly or it is too loose→Replace the bearing Oil Seal Damage/wear→Replacement 8.3.2.4 Inspection of spoke Check the spoke ①, replace it if bent or damaged; tighten it if loose. Tighten the spoke; the locking torque of spoke is 3.0n ·m. 8.3.3 Replacement of Bearing a 8.3.3.1 Disassembly of Bearing is n ra Remove the oil seal [1]. b Note: To avoid damaging the rim, please put a cloth [2] between the screwdriver and the surface of rim .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 276 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the bearing [3] with a bearing puller. 8.3.3.2 Inspection of Bearing Clearance Check the rolling conditions of bearing. If the bearing does not roll, it may be worn or loose and thus it should be replaced with a new one. Clearance Axial direction Radial direction 8.3.3.3 Installation of Bearing Note: The bearing disassembled should be replaced with a new one. a Then push the bearing with bearing installation tools. *Note b Do not apply pressure on the inner race ring [1] or ball bearing [2] of wheel bearing and only apply pressure to the outer race ring [3] of bearing Use the seat in line with the diameter of outer race ring [4] of bearing .A S S 8.4.4 Installation Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Note I N A R B A K E RG •The oil seal on the rear wheel should be lubricated. Torque value: Rear wheel axle locknut O E G Y A W 100 -113 N·m O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 277 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 8.4 Rear shock absorber 8.3.1 Disassembly Firmly support the motorcycle Disassemble Lower mounting bolt of rear shock absorber [A] Upper mounting bolt of rear shock absorber [B] Rear shock absorber [C] a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 278 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 8.3.2 Inspection Rear shock absorber test. Rear shock absorber lever Bending/damage → Replacement of rear shock absorber test. Rear shock absorber spring Fatigue → Replacement of rear shock absorber a b is n ra .A S S 8.3.4 Installation I N A R B A Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Install the mounting nut of rear shock absorber. Lock it to the specified torque value. Torque value: Nut at the top of rear shock absorber 45-50 N·m Nut at the bottom of rear shock absorber 45-50 N·m K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 279 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 8.5 Rear Rocker Arm 8.5.1 Disassembly Firmly support the motorcycle Disassemble the rear shock absorber (see this chapter for details) Disassemble the rear wheel (see this chapter for details) Disassemble Left / right cover [A] Disassemble Mounting nut of rear rocker arm axle [A] a b is n ra Disassemble Rear rocker arm shaft Pull out the rear rocker arm shaft from right side to left side .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 280 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove Rear rocker arm 8.5.2 Inspection test. Rear rocker arm Bending/damage→replacement test. Tightness of rear rocker arm If it is loose→tighten the rear rocker arm nut or replace the collar Vertical movement of rear rocker arm If the movement is not smooth, or there is any bent or rough parts → replace the axle sleeve a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 281 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d test. Rear rocker arm shaft Put the rear rocker arm shaft on the V-shaped seat and measure the eccentricity with a dial gauge. Available limit: Replace the wheel axle if the eccentricity is 0.2mm above *Note Never try to straighten a bent axle. Rear rocker arm axle test. Rear swing arm collar Damaged → replace test. Chain protective block Wear/damage /crack→ replacement a b is n ra 8.5.3 Installation Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Clean the mounting axle parts of rear rocker arm in the solvent, and apply grease to the mounting shaft. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG Torque value: Mounting nut of rear rocker arm axis O E G Y A W 85~98 N·m O CO Y P T O M - 282 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 8.6 Chain drive 8.6.1 Disassembly Put the motorcycle on a flat surface and secure it. Disassemble Drive sprocket cover [A] Remove the chain [A] from the drive sprocket [B]. a Disassemble the rear wheel (see this chapter for details) b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 283 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble the rear rocker arm (see this section for details) Remove the drive chain Disassemble Mounting nut of sprocket mounting bolt [A] Note: When disassembling the mounting nut of sprocket mounting bolt, follow the instructions on the right figure. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 284 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the retainer [A] using the retainer caliper. Disassemble Retainer [A] Sprocket base [B] Sprocket [C] Disassemble Rear wheel damper [B] a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 285 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 8.6.2 Inspection Check the chain Measure the length of 10 links . The drive chain should be replaced if the length does not match the specified value. The length limit of 10 links is 158.75 mm. *Note: Take measurements after stretching the chain by hands. Measure the length of 10 links within the range from the link roller ① to the inside of roller . Measure the length of 10 links in different positions for 2-3 times. Clean the drive chain Wash with a neutral detergent and clean the dust as much as possible. Apply the chain lubricant thoroughly after washing. Warning Never use volatile substances such as steam, gasoline or solvents. Check rotor ① and side panel ② If it is damaged or worn, replace the drive chain. Lubricate the drive chain and purchase drive chain lubricants from the store. a b is n ra Check drive chain hardness If it is hard, clean, lubricate or replace. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 286 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Check the driving sprocket and the driven sprocket. If there is a quarter of gear wear sprocket. If the gear is bent, replace the sprocket. , replace the test. Rear wheel damper Damage / crack→Replacement test. Sprocket seat bearing Bearing clearance or rotation is unbalanced→ replacement. a b test. Oil Seal Wear, damage and cracking → replacement. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 287 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d test. Chain drive collar Wear, damage→replacement. 8.6.3 Replacement of bearing 8.6.3.1 Disassembly of bearing Remove the oil seal [1]. Note: To avoid damaging the sprocket seat, please put a cloth [2] between the screwdriver and the surface of rim Remove the bearing [3] with a bearing puller. a is n ra b 8.6.3.2 Inspection of Bearing im D Clearance.A S S Check the rolling conditions of bearing. If the bearing does not roll, it may be worn or loose and thus it should be replaced with a new one. I N A s o i r it Ka Clearance R B A K E RG O E G Y A W Axial direction O OT P O C M Y - 288 - Radial direction k -d 8.6.3.3 Installation of Bearing Note: The bearing disassembled should be replaced with a new one. Then push the bearing with bearing installation tools. *Note Do not apply pressure on the inner race ring [1] or ball bearing [2] of wheel bearing and only apply pressure to the outer race ring [3] of bearing Use the seat in line with the diameter of outer race ring [4] of bearing 8.6.3 Installation Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Adjust the drive chain slackness. If the chain slackness is too smallness, the engine and other important parts may be overloaded. The chain slackness should be kept within the specified limits. Torque value: Locknut of sprocket bolt 45~50 N·m *Note a The side of sprocket marked with the number of teeth [A] is outward. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 289 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d *Note Tighten the nut by 2-3 times in the order shown in the right figure. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 290 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Seat Cushion No Chinese name and specifications Torque Number of N·m kgf·m 1 Boss bolt M10 2 40~45 4.0~4.5 2 Front seat cushion spring 2 — — 3 Pressing sleeve of front seat cushion spring 2 — — 4 Front seat cushion assembly 1 — — 5 Rear seat cushion assembly 1 — — 6 Rear seat mounting plate assembly 1 — — 7 Rear grab rail 1 — — 8 Bolt M6×30 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 9 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×14 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 10 Self-locking nut M8 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 Note a Ka b is n ra AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 291 - im D - s o i r it k -d Fuel tank A Fuel tank volume: 12L±0.5L a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 292 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Fuel tank assembly 1 — — 2 Rear rack screw II 2 — — 3 Rubber washer liner tube 2 — — 4 Buffer rubber of fuel tank 2 — — 5 Screw M4×5 2 — — 6 Left cover assembly of fuel tank 1 — — 7 Right cover assembly of fuel tank 1 — — 8 Cushion 2 — — 9 Sensor rubber washer 1 — — 10 Oil level sensor assembly 1 — — 11 Hexagon flange nut M6 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 12 Fuse hose assembly 1 — — 13 Filter assembly 1 — — 14 Filter jacket 1 — — 15 Fuel pump assembly 1 — — 16 Bolt M5×16 6 3~4 0.3~0.4 17 Dump valve assembly 1 — — 18 Plate clamp 3 — — 19 Fuel hose 4.5×8.5×190 1 — — 20 Fuel hose 4.5×8.5× 1 — — 21 Wire clamp Φ10.5 1 — — 22 Fuel hose 7×11×800 1 — — Note R S AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 293 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d IX. Fuel Tank/Seat Preparatory Information--------------------- 9.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 9.2 Seat---------------------------------------------9.3 Fuel Tank-------------------------------------- 9.4 9.1 Preparatory Information Precautions for operation The disassembly site should be away from the fire source. Tighten bolts and nuts to the specified torque values during assembly. Check whether all the parts are installed or operated correctly after assembly. Technical parameters Item Standard Allowable limit Tank capacity 12L±0.5L / a Locking torque Mounting bolt of front seat Mounting bolt of rear seat Fuel tank mounting bolt Fuel level sensor mounting bolt Fuel pump mounting bolt 40-45 N·m 10-12N·m 10-12 N·m 5–9 N·m 3-4 N·m b .A S S 9.2 Fault Diagnosis Reduction of gasoline quantity Natural consumption of gasoline Gasoline leakage I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 294 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 9.3 Seat 9.3.1 Disassembly Disassemble Mounting bolt of front seat [A] Front seat [B] Disassemble Front mounting bolt of rear seat M6×14[A] Bolt M6×30[B] Rear grab rail [C] Rear seat [D] Disassemble Self-locking nut M8 [A] Pressing sleeve of front seat cushion spring [B] Front seat cushion spring [C] a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 295 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 9.3.2 Inspection test. Seat Cushion Breakage or damage → replacement 9.3.3 Installation Install it in the reverse order of “disassembly” Torque value: Mounting bolt of front seat Mounting bolt of rear seat 40-45 N·m 10-12N·m 9.4 Fuel Tank 9.4.1 Disassembly a Warning Gasoline is extremely flammable and may even cause explosion in some cases.Therefore, it must be ensured that the above operations are performed in a well-ventilated area, and any fire source or spark is strictly prohibited, including any devices with indicators.No smoking!Close the electric door lock!Disconnect the negative electrode (-) of battery In order to minimize the amount of spilled fuel, the fuel in the fuel tank should be extracted when the engine is cool.If some fuel spills, it must be thoroughly cleaned. b .A S S I N A R B A K E G"Cushion" Remove the front seat cushion (see R EO "Removing") G Y A OW T O M Y P O C is n ra - - 296 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble Bolt [A] Remove fuel level sensor wire connector. Disconnect: Connector between fuel hose and fuel pump [B] Warning The fuel hose connector must be covered with a cloth when being removed.The residual pressure in the fuel pipeline when the hose is removed may cause the ejection of fuel. Note: Remove the fuel hose with hands. Do not remove the hose with tools forcibly. Although the fuel in the fuel tank has been removed, there may still be fuel residuals, so be careful when disassembling the fuel hose. Do not remove the fuel hose from the fuel hose connector. Remove the connector from the fuel pump interface. a Remove the fuel tank from the frame Disassemble Screw M4×5[A] Fuel tank lock [B] b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 297 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Disassemble Nut [A] Fuel level sensor assembly [B] Sensor rubber washer [C] Disassemble Bolt [A] Fuel pump assembly [B] Note Do not drop the fuel pump, especially avoid falling on hard surfaces, otherwise the fuel pump may be damaged. a b 9.4.2 Inspection ● Inspection Fuel tank Rust / damage / oil leakage→replacement .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 298 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Inspection Rubber part Buffer rubber [A] Rubber cover [B] Sensor rubber washer [C] Crack/damage→Replacement ● Inspection Inspect fuel pump Fuel pump Block-clean it Crack/damage→Replace fuel pump assembly Performance inspection of fuel pump (see Chapter XVII for details) a b is n ra ● Inspection Fuel hose If any wear, crack [B] or expansion [C] is found → the fuel pipe must be replaced. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 299 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Inspection Dump valve Damage/fault→Replacement 9.4.3 Installation Install it in the reverse order of “disassembly” Torque value: Fuel tank mounting bolt Fuel level sensor mounting bolt Fuel pump mounting bolt 10-12 N·m 5–9 N·m 3-4 N·m Note: Do not damage the mounting surface of fuel tank when installing the fuel pump Use new fuel pump seal ring Note: See Chapter XVIII for the details of fuel pump a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 300 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Frame a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 301 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Bolt M10×1.25×135 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 2 0Bolt M8×60 4 22~29 2.2~2.9 3 Rear front hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 4 Front buffer collar of engine 2 — — 5 Right front hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 6 Self-locking nut M10×1.25 4 45~50 4.5~5.0 7 Frame welding assembly 1 — — 8 Bolt M10×1.25×155 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 9 Frame cover 2 — — 10 Hexagon bolt with flange M10×1.25×170 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 11 Left rear hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 12 Front buffer collar assembly of engine 2 — — 13 Bolt M8×25 4 22~29 2.2~2.9 14 Right rear hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 15 Rubber washer of protector 3 — — 16 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×16 3 10~12 1.0~1.2 17 Left clamp of frame II 1 — — 18 Rubber washer of cover 4 — — 19 Bolt M8×75 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 20 Left cover mounting base of engine 1 — — 21 Left upper hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 22 Hexagon bolt with flange M10×1.25×60 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 23 Right upper hanging panel of engine 1 — — 24 Right cover mounting base of engine 1 — — 25 Self-locking nut M8 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 26 Right clamp of frame 1 — — 27 Hexagon flange nut M6 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 28 Headlight bracket collar 1 — — 29 Ignition coil mounting base 1 — — 30 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×80 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 31 Left clamp of frame I 1 — — 32 Seat mounting base 1 — 33 Screw M6×12 4 10~12 34 Buffering rubber ring of seat cushion 2 I N A A —. S S s o i r it Note AL、S AL、S AL、S AL、S AL a is n ra b Ka im D - 1.0~1.2 — — AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 302 - k -d Pedal a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 303 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m Note 1 Front pedal welding assembly 1 — — AL、S 2 Pedal mounting screw 4 22~29 2.2~2.9 3 Mounting bushing of front foot rest lever 4 — — 4 Front pedal buffer rubber washer 4 5 Rubber cover of pedal 2 — — 6 Thin nut M12×1.25 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 7 Spring washer φ12 1 — — 8 Mounting washer of sidestand 1 — — AL 9 Sidestand welding assembly 1 — — AL 10 Sidestand flameout switch 1 — — 11 Bolt M5×0.8×14 2 4~7 0.4~0.7 12 Mounting screw of sidestand 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 13 Sidestand spring assembly 1 — — 14 Washer 6 1 — — 15 Bolt M6×8 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 16 Mounting bolt of sidestand 2 45~50 4.5~5.0 17 Hexagon nut M10×1.25 2 45~50 4.5~5.0 18 Center stand welding assembly 1 — — 19 Sidestand spring 1 — — 20 Rubber damper 1 21 Rear pedal assembly 2 — — AL R、G AL、S AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 304 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d Muffler No CO Chinese name and specifications Torque Number of N·m kgf·m 1 Muffler welding assembly 1 — — 2 Exhaust seal ring assembly 1 — — 3 Oxygen sensor 1 — — 4 Hexagon nut with flange M8 4 22~29 2.2~2.9 5 Bolt M8×35 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 6 Guard bush 2 — — 7 Rubber cover II — — a is n ra b s o i r it im D - torque. AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking A . G: Apply grease. S S L: Apply locking agent. I N M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. A R B disulfide. (A mixture of engine MO: Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum A Kratio of 10:1) disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight E G R: Replace the part. R S: Observe the specified tightening EOsequence. G Si: Apply silicon grease. Y A SS: Apply silicone sealant. OW T O M - 305 Y P 2 Note Ka oil and molybdenum k -d X. Frame Preparatory Information--------------------- 10.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 10.2 Frame------------------------------------------ 10.3 Sidestand-------------------------------------- 10.4 center stand----------------------------------- 10.5 Footpeg ---------------------------------------10.6 Muffler-----------------------------------------10.7 Disassembly / installation of engine------- 10.8 10.1 Preparatory Information Precautions for operation Keep the disassembly site clean. Lift the engine using a jack or other supporting devices. Tighten bolts and nuts to the specified torque values during assembly. Check whether all the parts are installed or operated correctly after assembly. Disassemble the engine when repairing the following parts: —Cylinder head box valve —Cylinder and piston a b is n ra Specifications 2.4 L when changing oil 1.2L when disassembling Oil capacity of engine: Locking torque Sidestand bolt Locknut of side stand bolt center stand bolt Locknut of center stand bolt Mounting screw of front pedal bracket Front exhaust pipe mounting nut Rear mounting bolt of muffler cylinder Lower mounting bolt of engine I N A BR A K E G R O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M .A S S - 306 - im D - 45~50 N·m 45~50 N·m 45~50 N·m 45~50 N·m 22~29 N·m 22~29 N·m 22~29 N·m 45~50 N·m s o i r it Ka k -d Upper mounting bolt of engine Front mounting bolt of engine Rear upper mounting bolt of engine Upper hanging panel mounting bolt of engine Left front hanging panel assembly mounting screw of engine Right front hanging panel assembly mounting screw of engine Left rear hanging panel assembly mounting screw of engine Right rear hanging panel assembly mounting screw of engine 45~50 N·m 45~50 N·m 45~50 N·m 22~29 N·m 22~29 N·m 22~29 N·m 22~29 N·m 22~29 N·m 10.2 Fault Diagnosis 10.2.1 Compression pressure is low Wear, burning loss or damage of piston Wear or damage of cylinder and piston 10.2.2 The gear cannot be engaged Variable-speed shift fork is broken or deformed The guide pin of shift fork is broken 10.2.3 It's hard to shift gears The clutch is not completely disengaged The return spring of transmission is not working properly 10.2.4 Abnormal sound of crankcase Scattered or broken parts in the crankcase a 10.2.5 Engine is automatically stopped Stuck clutch b 10.3 Frame 10.3.1 Disassembly of frame ● Drain the oil (see "Periodic Maintenance" - "Replacing Oil" for details), ●Disassemble: Seat cushion (see “Frame” – “Removing Seat Cushion”) Fuel tank (see “Fuel Tank” – “Removing Fuel Tank” for details) Cover (see “Cover Parts”) Rear fender (see “Cover Parts” for details) Muffler (see “Muffler” – “Removing Muffler” for details) .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P is n ra T O M - 307 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Engine (see "Engine" - "Removing Engine" for details) Brake (see "Front Calipers" - "Removing Front Calipers", "Rear Calipers" - "Removing Rear Calipers", "Front Master Cylinder" - "Removing Front Master Cylinder", "Rear Master Cylinder" - "Removing Rear Master Cylinder") Rear wheel (see “Rear Wheel” – “Removing Rear Wheel”) Front wheel (see “Front Wheel” – “Removing Front Wheel”) Suspension system (see “Front Shock Absorber” – “Removing Front Shock Absorber”, “Rear Shock Absorber” – “Removing Rear Shock Absorber” for details) Rear swing arm (see “Rear Swing Arm” - "Removing Rear Swing Arm" for details). Sidestand (see "Sidestand" - "Removing Sidestand") Front and rear footpegs (see "Front Footpeg Assembly" "Removing Front Footpeg", "Rear Left Footpeg" "Removing Rear Left Footpeg", "Rear Right Footpeg" "Removing Rear Right Footpeg") Center stand (see "Center Stand" - "Removing Center Stand") ● Remove cables and other electrical components. 10.3.2 Installation of frame ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly (see the corresponding chapters). 10.3.3 Inspection of frame a ● Visually check the frame [A] for cracks, dents, bends or deformations. ★ If the frame is damaged, please replace it! b Warning A repaired frame may fail during use and thus cause an accident.Therefore, if there is any crack, dent, bend or deformation on the frame, please replace it! .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 308 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 10.4 Sidestand 10.4.1 Disassembly of sidestand ● Lift the rear wheel from the ground by fixing the center stand[A]. ●Remove the screw [B], and remove the sidestand stop switch [A]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 309 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Disassemble: Sidestand spring [A] Thin nut M12×1.25[B] Spring washer φ12[C] Bolt M6×8[D] Washer 6 [E] Mounting screw of sidestand [F] Mounting washer of sidestand [G] Sidestand welding assembly [H] 10.4.2 Installation of sidestand ● Apply grease to the movable parts of sidestand [H]. ● Apply locking agent to the threads of sidestand bolt [F]. ● Tighten the bolt and lock it with the nut [B]. Locking torque: Sidestand bolt [A]: 45-50 N·m Locknut of sidestand bolt [B]: 45-50 N·m ● Install the spring [A] with the long one facing up. 10.5 Center stand 10.5.1 Disassembly of center stand a ● Put away the center stand [A], support the sidestand [B], and park the motorcycle on the ground. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 310 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Disassemble: Sidestand spring [A] Hexagon nut M10×1.25[B] Bolt [C] Center stand welding assembly [D] Rubber damper [E] 10.5.2 Installation of center stand ● Apply grease to the movable parts of center stand [E]. ● Apply locking agent to the threads of center stand bolt [C]. ● Tighten the bolt and lock it with the nut [B]. Locking torque: Center stand bolt [A]: 45-50 N·m Locknut of center stand bolt [B]: 45-50 N·m ● Install the spring [A] with the long one facing up. 10.6 Pedal 10.6.1 Front pedal assembly 10.6.1.1 Disassembly of front pedal assembly a ●Disassemble: Screw [A] Front pedal assembly [B] Mounting bushing of front foot rest lever [C] Front pedal buffer rubber washer [D] b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 311 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Remove rubber cover of footpeg [B] from the welding assembly [A] of front pedal. 10.6.1.2 Installation of front pedal assembly ●Add grease to the footpeg mounting bushing before installation. ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly. Locking torque: Front footpeg bracket mounting screw: 22-29 N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 312 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 10.6.2 Left rear footpeg 10.6.2.1 Disassembly of left rear footpeg ●Disassemble Cotter pin [A] Footpeg mounting pin [B] Left rear pedal [C] 10.6.2.2 Installation of left rear footpeg ●Add grease to the footpeg mounting pin before installation. ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 313 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 10.6.3 Rear right footpeg 10.6.3.1 Disassembly of right rear footpeg ●Disassemble Cotter pin [A] Footpeg mounting pin [B] Right rear pedal [C] 10.6.3.2 Installation of rear right footpeg ●Add grease to the footpeg mounting pin before installation. ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 314 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 10.7 Muffler 10.7.1 Disassembly of muffler Warning Do not remove the muffler while the engine is heated up, to avoid burns.Do not disassemble the muffler before it has cooled down. ● Disconnect the oxygen sensor cable connector. ● Remove the mounting nut of front exhaust pipe [A]. ●Remove the muffler hanging panel and frame mounting bolt at the left side [A] ●Remove the muffler [B]. a b is n ra ●Disassemble: Oxygen sensor [A]. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 315 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 10.7.2 Installation of muffler ● Install the parts that have been removed before in the reverse order of disassembly (see the corresponding chapters). ● Replace the exhaust pipe gasket [A] with a new one. Locking torque: Front exhaust pipe mounting nut: 22-29 N·m Rear mounting bolt of muffler barrel: 22-29 N•m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 316 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 10.8 Disassembly/installation of engine 10.8.1 Exploded View of disassembly/installation of engine a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 317 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m Note 1 Frame welding assembly 1 — — 2 Self-locking nut M8 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 3 Right cover mounting base of engine 1 — — 4 Self-locking nut M10×1.25 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 5 Right upper hanging panel of engine 1 — — 6 Bolt M8×25 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 AL、S 7 0Bolt M8×60 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 AL、S 8 Self-locking nut M10×1.25 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 AL、S 9 Right rear hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 10 Self-locking nut M10×1.25 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 11 Front buffer collar of engine 1 — — 12 Self-locking nut M10×1.25 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 13 Right front hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 14 Bolt M10×1.25×135 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 15 Rear front hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 16 Front buffer collar of engine 1 — — 17 Bolt M10×1.25×155 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 AL、S 18 0Bolt M8×60 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 AL、S 19 Left rear hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — 20 Hexagon bolt with flange M10×1.25×170 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 AL、S 21 Bolt M8×25 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 AL、S 22 Hexagon bolt with flange M10×1.25×60 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 AL、S 23 Bolt M8×75 2 22~29 2.2~2.9 AL、S 24 Left cover mounting base of engine 1 — — 25 Left upper hanging panel assembly of engine 1 — — AL、S AL、S AL、S AL、S AL、S AL: Tighten the fastening bolts alternatively in accordance with the higher locking torque. G: Apply grease. L: Apply locking agent. M: Apply the grease containing molybdenum disulfide. MO:Apply the oil solvent containing molybdenum disulfide. (A mixture of engine oil and molybdenum disulfide-containing grease prepared in a weight ratio of 10:1) R: Replace the part. S: Observe the specified tightening sequence. Si: Apply silicon grease. SS: Apply silicone sealant. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 318 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d 10.8.2 Disassembly of Engine ● Lift the rear wheel from the ground by fixing the center stand[A]. ● Slowly grab the brake rod, and fasten it using a tire. Warning When disassemble the engine, the worker must grip the brake rod, otherwise, the motorcycle may topple and fall, thus causing accidents and resulting in personal injury. ● Drain the oil (see "Periodic Maintenance" - "Replacing Oil" for details), ●Disassemble: Seat cushion (see "Cushion" - "Removing Seat Cushion" for details), cover (see “Frame” – “Removing Cover” for details). fuel tank (see “Electronic Fuel Injection System (EFI)” -“Removal of Fuel Tank” for details), muffler (see “Frame” – “Removing Muffler” for details), Drive chain (see "Drive" - "Removing Drive Chain") ●Support the engine with a suitable frame to keep the engine in balance. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 319 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Loosen the nut [A] and remove the clutch wire connector [B] ●Loosen the nut [A] and remove the throttle cable connector [B]. a ●Disconnect each air tube [A] b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 320 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Remove the spark plug cap [A]. ●Loosen the clamp between throttle and air filter [A] ●Loosen the clamp at the joint between throttle and intake manifold [B] ●Remove the rocker arm of shift rod [A]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 321 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Disconnect the connectors of each cable. ●Loosen: Front mounting bolt of engine [A]. ●Disassemble: Left front hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine [A]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 322 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Disassemble: Right front hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine [A]. ●Disassemble: Remove the rear lower mounting bolt of engine [A]. ●Disassemble: Remove the rear upper mounting nut of engine [A]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 323 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Disassemble: Remove the upper mounting nut of engine [A]. ●Disassemble: Right rear hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine [A]. ●Disassemble: Left rear hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine [A]. a b is n ra ●Disassemble: Right upper hanging panel assembly mounting nut of engine [A]. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 324 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Disassemble: Left upper hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine [A]. ●Disassemble: Rear lower mounting bolt of engine [A]. ●Remove the engine with a frame. a 10.8.2 Installation of Engine b ●Support the engine with a suitable frame. ●Install the rear lower mounting bolt of engine [A], and do not tighten the corresponding nut too tightly; .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 325 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Install the left upper hanging panel of engine [A] and install the bolt [B]. ●Install the right upper hanging panel of engine [A], install the nut [B] and do not tighten it too tightly; a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 326 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Install the upper mounting bolt of engine [A], and do not tighten the corresponding nut too tightly; ●Install the right rear hanging panel of engine [A], install the bolt [B] and do not tighten it too tightly; ●Install the left rear hanging panel of engine [A], install the bolt [B] and do not tighten it too tightly; a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 327 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Install the rear upper mounting bolt of engine [A], and do not tighten the corresponding nut too tightly; ●Install the left front hanging panel of engine [A], install the bolt [B] and do not tighten it too tightly; ●Install the right front hanging panel of engine [A], install the bolt [B] and do not tighten it too tightly; a b is n ra ●Install the front mounting bolt of engine [A], and do not tighten the corresponding nut too tightly; .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 328 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Tighten the bolts, screws or nuts as follows: ○Step I: Lock the locknut of rear lower mounting bolt of engine ○Step II: Lock the locknut of upper mounting bolt of engine ○Step III: Lock the locknut of front mounting bolt of engine ○Step IV: Lock the locknut of rear upper mounting bolt of engine ○Step V: Lock the clamping nut on the upper hanging panel of left engine ○Step VI: Lock the clamping bolt on the left front hanging panel assembly of left engine ○Step VII: Lock the clamping bolt on the right front hanging panel assembly of right engine ○Step VIII: Lock the clamping bolt on the left rear hanging panel assembly of left engine ○Step IX: Lock the clamping bolt on the right rear hanging panel assembly of right engine ○Step X: Mark each fastening bolt, screw and nut that locked to the specified torque. Note ○ Fasten the mounting bolts, screws or nuts in three steps ○Locking torque: Rear lower mounting bolt of engine: 45-50 N·m Upper mounting bolt of engine: 45-50 N·m Front mounting bolt of engine 45-50N·m Rear upper mounting bolt of engine: 45-50 N·m Upper hanging panel mounting bolt of engine: 22-29 N·m Left front hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine: 22-29 N·m Right front hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine: 22-29 N·m Left rear hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine: 22-29 N·m Right rear hanging panel assembly mounting bolt of engine: 22-29 N·m ● Properly arrange the wire, cable and hose (see "Appendix" - "Winding Method of Cables, Wires and Hoses" for details). ●Install the parts disassembled previously (see the corresponding chapters). ●Adjustment: ○ Throttle cable (see “Periodic Maintenance” – “Checking Throttle Control System”), ● Drive chain (see “Periodic Maintenance” – “Inspection of Slackness of Drive Chain” for details) ● Fill the engine with oil (see "Periodic Maintenance" "Replacing Oil" for details), a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 329 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 330 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Inspection and maintenance of engine Table of torque value of engine fastener Fastening location and fastener name Tightening torque (N•m) Fuel pump mounting screw 10∼12N·m Fuel pump base mounting screw 10∼12N·m Mounting bolt of cylinder head cover 10~12N·m Double end stud of inlet air pipe 10~12N·m Double-end stud at air exhaust side 10~12N·m Bolt at sprocket cavity side 9.8N·m BR7ES/CR7HSA spark plug: 10~12N·m Sprocket bolt 38N·m Crank shaft retaining nut 135~140N.m Hexagon nut with flange M14×1.5 160~165N.m Hexagonal thin nut 45~50N.m Assembling bolt 10N·m Oil seal cover bolt 10N·m Gear sensor mounting bolt Breather valve clamp plate assembly screw Bearing retainer screw CO Y P A R B A K E G Block chain plate bolt R EO G Holder Y bolt A OW Stud T MO NI .A S S - s o i r 6N·m it m Di 4N·m 10N·m 10N·m 10N·m 45N·m - 331 - a Ka b is n ra k -d Clutch locknut 45~50N·m Clutch spring bolt 10~12N·m Right cover mounting bolt 10~12N·m Oil filter mounting nut 10~12N·m Crankshaft retainer bolt 5N·m Star wheel screw 8~10N·m Positioning roller rocker bolt 8~10N·m Sprocket mounting nut 110~115N·m Flywheel locknut 90N·m Stator assembly mounting bolt 10~12N·m Trigger probe mounting bolt 5~7N·m Star wheel combination mounting bolt 10~12N·m Starter motor mounting bolt 10~12N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 332 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Main parameters of engine Four stroke, single cylinder, four valves, double Engine type spark plugs Cooling mode Air-cooled Cylinder diameter×stroke (mm) 72.7×90 Displacement (ml) 373.5 Compression ratio 8.5:1 Maximum net power / corresponding speed 15.5kW/5500 r/min Maximum torque/ corresponding rotating speed 29.0N.m/4500 r/min Injection type Electronic fuel injection Starting mode Electric starting Idle speed 1400r/min Spark plug model BR7ES/CR7HSA Maximum lift range of Intake intake/exhaust valve Maximum lift range 10.5mm Opening angle 354° Closing angle 572° Maximum lift range 10.5mm Opening angle 150° Closing angle 367° valves, opening and closing angle with respect to the Exhaust dead point, and valve valve clearance Lubrication mode I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO im D - 2.8L .A S S Y P is n ra b Ka Splash lubrication, pressure lubrication Amount of oil added T O M s o i r it a - 333 - k -d Lubrication System Diagram a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 334 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra ①Camshaft ②Crankshaft ③Oil filter ④Fuel pump ⑤Oil filter ⑥Primary shaft ⑦Primary shaft ⑧Piston ⑨Clutch .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 335 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 336 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fuel pump No Chinese name and specifications Torque Number of N·m kgf·m 1 Bolt M6×15 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 2 Pressure plate 1 — — 3 Retainer 10 1 — — 4 Washer 10.5×16.5×1.5 1 — — 5 Fuel pump gear assembly 1 — — 6 Cross recessed pan head screw 1 — — 7 Screw M6×30 3 10~12 1.0~1.2 8 Fuel pump shaft 1 — — 9 Fuel pump cover 1 — — 10 Inner rotor 1 — — 11 Outer rotor 1 — — 12 Pin 3×8 2 — — 13 Fuel pump body 1 — 14 Roller pin 1 — 15 Pin 2.5×16 1 — 16 Oil drip pan 1 — 17 Decompression valve assembly 1 18 Bolt M6×35 1 NI RA E G R B A K O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M .A S — S - 337 - 10~12 s o i r — it m Di — — - — — 1.0~1.2 Note a Ka b is n ra k -d XI. Lubrication System Preparatory Information--------------------- 11.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 11.2 Fuel Pump------------------------------------- 11.3 111.1 Preparatory Information Action of Lubrication System: The function of the lubricating system of engine is to provide lubricant to the friction surface of workpiece to make the dry surface friction become into the liquid friction between lubricant particles so as to reduce the wear of parts; cool the parts with high heat loads; absorb the impacts of bearing and other parts and reduce noise; increase the sealability between the piston ring and cylinder wall; clean and remove the impurities on the surfaces of parts. Precautions for operation Note If the used engine oil is stuck to the skin for a long time, skin cancer may be caused. Although it is unlikely the waste oil will be disposed of every day, wash the hands thoroughly with soap as soon as possible after disposing waste oil. ·Fuel pump can be used only when it is installed in the case of engine. a ·The service contents in this section must be performed after engine oil is drained. ·When removing and installing the fuel pump, prevent dust and b dirt from entering the engine. ·If the wear of any parts of fuel pump wear exceeds the use range, the fuel pump needs to be replaced. ·After installing the fuel pump, check whether the fuel pump is leaking and the oil pressure is correct. Technical parameters Item .A S S I N A R When replacing the oilB Oil capacity A K When disassembling E between G Radial clearance OR inner and outer rotors E G Clearance between outer rotor Fuel pump rotor Y A and pump W Rotor end gap TO O M - 338 Y P O C is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka Standard Allowable limit 2.4L _ 2.8L _ 0.05-0.095 0.15 0.11-0.17 0.24 0.07-0.12 0.15 k -d Locking torque Mounting screw of fuel pump 10-12 N·m Mounting bolt of fuel pump base 10-12 N·m Tools Oil Pressure gauge Connector of oil pressure gauge 11.2 Troubleshooting 11.2.1 Oil level is too low · Oil consumption · External leakage · Piston ring is worn · Improper installation of piston ring · Cylinder body is worn · Valve seal is worn a · Valve guide is worn is n ra 11.2.2 Oil pressure is low b · Oil level is low · Oil filter is blocked · Fuel pump is leaking · Waste oil is used .A S S 11.2.3 There is no oil pressure · Oil level is low · Fuel pump gear is damaged R B A K E RG · Fuel pump gear or big gear of clutch is damaged · Fuel pump is damaged · Fuel pump is leaking I N A O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 339 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 11.2.4 Oil pressure is high · Oil filter is blocked · Waste oil is used 11.2.5 Oil is polluted · Oil filter is not changed often · Piston ring is worn 11.2.6 Oil is emulsified ·Cylinder head washer is leaking ·Coolant is leaking ·There is water in the engine 11.3 Fuel Pump 11.3.1 Disassembly Remove the right cover [A] a b Disassemble: Bolt [A] Retainer [B] Screw [C] Fuel pump [D] .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P is n ra T O M - 340 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove fuel pump base. Disassemble fuel pump Fuel pump body Outer rotor Fuel pump shaft ④Inner rotor 11.3.2 Inspection of Fuel Pump Check the radial clearance of internal and external rotors. Allowable limit: 0.15mm. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 341 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Check the clearance between external rotor and fuel pump base. Allowable limit: 0.24mm. Check the end clearance of rotor. Allowable limit: 0.15mm. 11.3.3 Assembly of Fuel Pump As shown in the figure a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 342 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d A. Retainer 10 B. Washer 10.5×16.5×1.5 C. Fuel pump gear assembly D. Cross recessed pan head screw M6×16 E. Fuel pump cover F. Outer rotor G. Inner rotor H. Fuel pump shaft J. Pin 3×8 K. Fuel pump body L. Roller pin M. Pin 2.5×16 Note: After assembly, the inner and outer rotors should be able to rotate flexibly without clamping stagnation. 11.3.4 Installation Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Locking torque: Mounting bolt of fuel pump base 10-12 N·m Mounting bolt of fuel pump base 10-12 N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 343 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Cylinder Head Cover 10-12N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 344 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Cylinder Head Cover No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Bolt M6×16 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 2 Cylinder gasket 4 — — 3 Cushion 4 — — 4 Right cylinder head cover 1 — — 5 Left cylinder head cover 1 — — 6 Hexagon bolt with flange M6×30 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 7 Bolt M6×14 2 10~12 8 Cylinder Head Cover 1 — 9 Cylinder head cover sealing washer 1 I N A — .A S S R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 345 - s o i r it im D — - 1.0~1.2 — Note a Ka b is n ra k -d XII. Cylinder Head Cover Preparatory Information--------------------- 12.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 12.2 Cylinder Head Cover------------------------ 12.3 12.1 Preparatory Information Precautions for operation This section includes the services of cylinder head cover component, cylinder head cover gasket and bolts. When removing and storing parts, mark them to make sure they are reinstalled in their original positions. The disassembled parts need to be cleaned. When removing the cylinder head cover, be careful not to damage the matching cylinder head joint surface. Locking torque Mounting bolt of cylinder head cover 10-12 N·m a 12.2 Fault Diagnosis 12.2.1 Oil leakage or seepage of cylinder head cover · Cylinder head cover sealing washer is damaged · Cylinder head cover is damaged .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 346 - im D - b is n ra s o i r it Ka k -d 12.3 Cylinder head cover 12.3.1 Disassembly Disassemble: Bolt [A] Right cylinder head cover [B] Disassemble: Bolt [A] Left cylinder head cover [B] a Disassemble: is n ra Bolt [A] Cylinder head cover [B] b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 347 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the cylinder head cover sealing washer [A] 12.3.2 Inspection Cylinder Head Cover Damaged → replace 12.3.3 Installation Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Note When cylinder head cover is removed and reinstalled every time, the gasket of cylinder head cover must be replaced with a new one.When installing, ensure that the seal is installed in the groove of cylinder head cover, and that the groove of cylinder head cover and the cylinder head mounting surface should be cleaned and free of debris. a b Locking torque: Mounting bolt of cylinder head cover: 10-12 N·m Mounting bolt of left / right cylinder head cover: 10-12N·m .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 348 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Cylinder Head / Distribution a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 349 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Cylinder head a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 350 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Chinese name and specifications Torque Number of kgf·m 1 Clamp assembly 1 — — 2 Nut 6 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 3 Double end stud M6×35 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 4 Intake tube components 1 — — 5 Heat insulated pad 1 — — 6 O-Ring 42.5×1.8 2 — — 7 Damping block 3 — — 8 Spark plug 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 9 Taper plug 4 — — 10 O-Ring 2 — — 11 Valve seal components 2 — — 12 Cylinder head machining assembly 1 — — 13 Short double-end stud 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 14 O-ring seal 20×2.5 1 — — 15 Retainer 28 1 — — 16 Spark plug sleeve 1 — — 17 O-ring seal 27.4×2.4F 1 — — 18 Spark plug 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 19 Pressure plate 1 — — 20 Hexagon bolt with flange M5×12 2 4~7 0.4~0.7 21 O-ring of sprocket cover 1 — — 22 Sprocket cover 1 — — 23 Clamp 1 — — 24 Washer φ6.5 1 — — 25 Bolt M6×22 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 26 Bolt M6×25 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 27 Dowel pin Φ8×8 2 — — 28 Inner hexagon screw M6×134 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 29 Cylinder head washer 1 — — 30 Temperature sensor 1 — 31 Fuel injector 1 — 32 Fuel Injector seat assembly 1 — 33 Bolt M5×12 2 .A S S 4~7 I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO N·m Y P T O M - 351 - s o i r — it m Di — — - 0.4~0.7 Note a Ka b is n ra k -d Valve mechanism a No CO Chinese name and specifications Torque Number of N·m kgf·m 1 Intake valve 1 — — 2 Valve lower spring seat [5] 2 — — 3 Inner spring of valve 2 — — 4 Outer spring of valve 2 — 5 Valve lock clamp 4 — 6 Upper spring seat of valve 2 im— D - 7 Inlet rocker arm assembly 8 Bolt M10×25 9 Exhaust rocker assembly 10 Camshaft sprocket 11 Inlet rocker arm shaft 12 Exhaust rocker arm shaft NI 1 A 1 BR — .A S S— 1 E Camshaft assembly G 13 Y Exhaust valveA 14 OW T O M Y P O E G R KA s o i r it — — — 38 3.8 — — 1 — — 1 — — 1 — — 1 — — 1 — — - 352 - is n ra Note b Ka k -d a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 353 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Timing drive mechanism a is n ra b No Chinese name and specifications of 1 Bolt M6×25 2 2 Camshaft chain regulator 1 3 Washer 4 Screw at primary guide chain plate 5 Primary guide chain plate assembly 6 Timing chain 7 Auxiliary guide chain plate component O E G Y A W N·m NI CO Y P — — — 1 — — 1 — — 1 — — O T O M 1.0~1.2 — A 1 BR KA .A S S— 10~12 im D - kgf·m — 1 E G R Torque Number s o i r it - 354 - Ka Note k -d XIII. Cylinder Head Preparatory Information--------------------- 13.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 13.2 Cylinder Head-------------------------------- 13.3 13.1 Preparatory Information Function of Cylinder Head: Cylinder head is used to seal the cylinder and it forms a combustion chamber with the piston to withstand the high temperature and high pressure gas. And it can also complete the intake and exhaust through the distribution mechanism. Operation Precautions: In order to ensure the sealing of cylinder head and upper box, the cylinder head withstands great bolt locking force. Tightening force: 19-23 N•m. Before the inspection and measurement, all parts shall be cleaned and blown with high-pressure air. Technical parameters Item Standard (mm) Operating limit (mm) Planeness of cylinder head 0.05 0.05 Intake 0.08-0.12 _ Exhaust 0.1-0.14 _ Intake 6.975-6.985 6.925 Exhaust 6.965-6.975 Intake 7-7.015 Exhaust 7-7.015 Intake im D 0.025-0.05 - 0.1 1-1.2 1.5 1-1.2 1.5 37.4 36.4 37.4 36.4 36.06 35.5 35.92 35.4 11.977-11.988 11.88 12.000-12.018 12.02 0.012-0.041 0.045 Valve clearance Outer diameter of valve stem Valve Valve guide Inner diameter of valve guide: Clearance between valve seam and valve guide Width of valve seat Valve spring CO Free length Exhaust Intake IS N Intake A R B Exhaust Exhaust A K Intake Camshaft Camshaft height E G Exhaust R O Outer diameter of Erocker arm shaft Intake / exhaust G Inner diameter Y of rocker arm hole Intake / exhaust Rocker arm A Clearance between rocker arm W Intake / exhaust O shaft and rocker arm hole T O M - 355 Y P s o i r it 0.015-0.04 S.A is n ra b6.915 Ka 7.55 7.54 0.1 a k -d Locking torque Stud bolt of air inlet duct 10~12 N·m Stud bolt at exhaust side 10~12 N·m Bolt at sprocket cavity 9.8 N·m BR7ES/CR7HSA spark plug Sprocket bolt 10-12N·m 38 N·m Tools Feeler gauge Caliper a Micrometer Runout gauge 13.2 Fault Diagnosis 13.2.1 Compression pressure is low Valve clearance is not adjusted properly CO R B A O E G The spark plug is not installedY properly A OW T O M Y P The washer of cylinder head is leaking I N A K E RG Valve burns out or is bent The airtightness of valve seat is not poor .A S S - 356 - im D - s o i r it Ka b is n ra k -d 13.2.2 The sound of cylinder head is abnormal Valve clearance is not adjusted properly Valve spring is damaged 13.2.3 Compression pressure is too high Excessive carbon deposition in the combustion chamber 13.3 Cylinder head 13.3.1 Disassembly Remove the cylinder head/ (see 12.3.1 for details) Remove the retainer [A] at the auxiliary spark plug using a circlip pliers. Remove the auxiliary spark plug [B] using a straight screwdriver. a Screw out the auxiliary spark plug [A] using a spark plug is n ra socket. Observe whether the spark plug washer is clean. b If the organic oil burns out, the airtightness is poor, and O ring [B] below the spark plug needs to be replaced. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 357 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove 2 fastening bolts [A], and then the tensioner assembly [B]. Loosen 3 screws [A] and remove the sprocket cover [B] and O-ring. Loosen the camshaft sprocket bolt [A]. Remove camshaft driven sprocket [B] and chain. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 358 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Loosen the bolt at the side of sprocket cavity[A] and cylinder bolt [B]. Remove the cylinder head components. Remove cross recessed countersunk head screw [A], take out the rocker shaft windshield[B], and remove the rocker shaft. a b Remove the camshaft components .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 359 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Valve spring compressor [1][2] Compress the valve spring with valve spring compression tool and remove valve cotter [B]. Remove upper base of valve spring [A], outer valve spring [C], inner valve spring [D], lower base of valve spring [E], valve [F]. 13.3.2 Inspection ●Measure valve clearance with feeler gauge [A] ○Standard of valve clearance: Intake valve clearance: 0.98-0.12mm Exhaust valve clearance: 0.10-0.14mm ★If there is a difference between the measured actual valve clearance and the standard valve clearance, the actual measured data can be compared with the standard clearance and the valve adjusting screw can be adjusted to achieve the standard valve clearance. a ●Measure the dimensions of rocker shaft using a micrometer. ○Allowable limit: 11.88mm. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 360 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Measure the inner diameter of rocker arm hole. Allowable limit: 12.02mm. ●Clearance between rocker arm hole and rocker arm shaft. ○Allowable limit: 0.045mm. ●Measure the height of camshaft with a micrometer [a] ○Allowable limit: intake cam height: 36.06 mm Exhaust cam height: 35.92 mm ●Clear the carbon deposits on the cylinder head. ●Measure the flatness of the cylinder head joint surface. ○Allowable limit: 0.05mm ★ When the flatness of the cylinder head joint surface exceeds the use limit, place a fine sandpaper on the flat plate, make the cylinder head joint surface fit the sandpaper and sand the surface in 8 shape. a b is n ra ●Measure the gradient of intake / exhaust spring of valve. ○Allowable limit: intake spring: 37.4mm. Exhaust spring: 37.4mm. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 361 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Measure the gradient of intake / exhaust spring of valve [a]. ○Allowable limit: 1.6mm Measure the external diameter of valve stem. Allowable limit: Intake valve: 6.925mm. Exhaust valve: 6.915mm. ●Measure the run-out of valve stem ○Allowable limit: 0.04 mm a ●Check the valve guide and remove the carbon deposits in the valve guide with a reamer before check. Valve reamer Note Rotate the reamer clockwise and do not rotate the reamer counterclockwise. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 362 - im D - s o i r it Ka b is n ra k -d ●Measure the inner diameter of valve guide. Allowable limit: ○Intake valve: 6.925mm, ○Exhaust valve: 6.915mm. ●Allowable limit of clearance between valve and valve guide: ○Intake valve: 0.1mm. ○Exhaust valve: 0.1mm. ●Clean the carbon deposits in the combustion chamber and valve, and thoroughly rinse the intake and exhaust valves. ●Check the width of valve seat contact surface (width of valve seat ring) [A]. ○Allowable limit: intake /exhaust: 1.5mm 13.3.3 Replacement of Valve Guide a Note: If the clearance between valve and valve guide exceeds the limit, replace the valve guide. After the valve guide is replaced, the valve seat ring surface must be finished. b ●Put the valve guide in the freezing cavity of refrigerator to cool it for an hour. ●Use the electric furnace or oven to heat the cylinder head to 100-150℃. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 363 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Fix the cylinder head and remove the valve guide from the upper side of cylinder head with the valve guide disassembly tool [1]. ●Put a new O-ring on the new valve guide. ●Install the valve guide from the top of cylinder head. ○Install new valve guide using valve guide mounting tool [2] and guide using valve guide remover [1]. a is n ra Note: Do not damage the cylinder head when installing the valve guide. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 364 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d After the valve guide is embedded, carry out the finishing by using the valve guide reamer. Valve reamer Note: Add an appropriate amount of cutting oil during cutting with a reamer. The reamer shall be rotated clockwise. 13.3.4 Finishing Valve Seat Ring ●Use a 45°cutter to remove the rough or uneven parts [A] on the surface of valve seat ring. Note: Apply a layer of transparent or Prussia blue coating to the valve seat ring. so that it can be seen more clearly. ●Remove 1/4 of outer end of valve seat ring with a 25° cutter. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 365 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Remove 1/4 of bottom of valve seat ring with a 60° cutter. Take the cutter and check the positions which have been disposed. ●Grind the valve seat ring with a 45° finishing cutter to reach an appropriate width. ○Make sure to remove all dents and uneven parts. ○Standard valve seat ring width: intake: 1mm-1.2mm Exhaust: 1mm-1.2mm ○If the contacted position is in the too high part of valve, please The contact surface is high lower the valve seat ring with a 25° flat cutter. ○If the contacted position is in the too low part of valve, raise the a valve seat ring with a 60° internal cutter. ○Use the 45° finishing cutter to finish the valve seat ring again to make it meet the required specification. The contact surface is low ●After the valve seat ring is grinded, apply polish to the valve surface and gently polish the valve. I N A 13.3.5 Installation R B A K E G contrary ●Installation shall be carried out in the order R to the disassembly order. EO G ●Please adjust the ignition timing after installation. (see Y timing”) A “inspection/adjustment” —“ignition Precautions for Installation OW of Valve: T O M Y P O C .A S S - 366 - im D - b is n ra s o i r it Ka k -d ●When the valve is installed, apply appropriate amount of engine oil to the surface of the valve stem and then install the valve stem into the valve guide. Valve spring retainer① Valve oil seal② Valve③ Valve spring④ Spring plate⑤ Note: New product Before installation, check whether there are burrs at the end of the valve. If there are burrs at the end of the valve, polish the end of the valve stem with an oilstone. ●When installing the valve spring, install the end of spring with smaller pitch toward the combustion chamber. ●Use the valve spring compression tool ② when installing the valve lock clip ①. a ●Knock the valve lock plate gently with a soft hammer to fix it on the valve stem. Note: b Do not knock the valve lock plate overly to avoid damaging the valve. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 367 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Cylinder Block, Piston Crankshaft connecting rod 45~50N.m a is n ra b .A S S I N A 160~165N.m R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 368 - im D - s o i r it Ka 135~140N.m k -d Cylinder Block a is n ra b No Chinese name and specifications 1 Dowel pin 6×10×16 2 Damping block 3 Cylinder block assembly 4 Cylinder block washer 5 Dowel pin 10.5×13×13 Torque Number N·m 2 NI — — 1 — — 2 — — O CO Y P T O M — — O E G Y A W kgf·m — 1 A 1 BR E G R .A S S— of KA im D - s o i r it - 369 - Ka Note k -d Piston connecting rod crankshaft balance shaft a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 370 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Piston ring 1 10~12 1.0~1.2 2 Piston 1 — — 3 Piston pin 1 — — 4 Piston pin retainer 2 — — 5 O-ring seal 1.8×17 1 — — 6 Balance shaft 1 — — 7 Straight key 1 — — 8 Balancer shaft gear components 1 — — 9 Washer 1 — — 10 Nut M12×1.25 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 11 Hexagon nut with flange M14×1.5 1 160~165 16.0~16.5 12 Washer 14.2×30×3 1 — — 13 Washer 2 — — 14 Key 1 — — 15 Crankshaft components 1 — — 16 Flat key 8×7×25 1 — — 17 Gear sprocket 1 — — 18 Clutch drive gear 1 — — 19 Fuel pump drive gear 1 — — 20 Washer (II) 1 — — 21 Washer (I) 1 — — 22 Crank shaft retaining nut M16×1 1 135~140 13.5~14.0 Note a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 371 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d XIV. Cylinder Block and Piston Preparatory Information--------------------- 14.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 14.2 Cylinder -------------------------------------- 14.3 Piston------------------------------------------ 14.4 14.1 Preparatory Information Function of cylinder block: The cylinder block provides a space for gas compression, combustion and expansion and guides the movement of piston. It can also transfer some heat in the cylinder to the surrounding cooling mediums. Function of piston: a 1. It can withstand the pressure generated by the combustion of combustible gas mixture in the cylinder and transmit the is n ra pressure to the connecting rod to drive the crankshaft to rotate. 2. Form a combustion chamber together with the cylinder head b and other parts. Operation Precautions: s o i r it im D Before the inspection and measurement, all parts shall be cleaned and blown with high-pressure air. A . S S I AN R B A K E G R EO G Y A OW T O M - 372 Y P CO Ka k -d Technical parameters Item limit Inner diameter 72.7~72.715 72.815 Cylindricity 0.008 0.05 Roundness 0.007 0.05 Planeness 0.03 0.06 Outer diameter of piston (measurement point) 72.735~72.75 (7mm at the bottom of piston skirt) 72.7 Inner diameter of piston pin hole 17.002~17.008 17.04 Outer diameter of piston pin 17~17.006 16.96 Clearance between piston and piston pin 0.002~0.014 0.07 Cylinder Piston and piston ring Allowable standard value Clearance between piston First ring 0.03~0.07 0.1 ring and ring groove Second ring 0.03~0.07 0.1 First ring 0.15~0.3 0.55 Second ring 0.25~45 0.75 Oil ring 0.20-0.7 _ Piston ring joint clearance Connecting rod small Inner diameter of connecting rod small end 17.012~17.021 17.05 end Clearance between connecting rod and piston pin 0.012~0.027 0.10 Lateral clearance of big end of connecting rod 0.1~0.30 0.50 Radial clearance of big end of connecting rod 0.03~0.058 0.05 Run-out 0.02 0.1 Crankshaft components Locking torque Crank shaft retaining nut 135~140N.m Hexagon nut with flange M14×1.5 Hexagon thin nut 45-50N.m 160~165N.m a is n ra Tools b .A S S im D - s o i r it I N A R B A Feeler gauge K E RG O E G Y A W Caliper O CO Y P T O M - 373 - Ka k -d Micrometer Runout gauge ① Opening clamp ② Piston Piston ring opening clamp Piston pin pull-out device a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A Cylinder diameter tester K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 374 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 14.2 Fault Diagnosis 14.2.1 Compression pressure is low Wear, burning loss or damage of piston Wear or damage of cylinder and piston Damage of washer and leakage between crankcase and gas 14.2.2 Compression pressure is too high Excessive carbon deposition in the combustion chamber 14.2.3 Exhaust pipe is emitting white smoke Wear and damage of piston ring Wear or damage of piston and cylinder 14.2.4 The sound of piston is abnormal Damage of cylinder, piston and piston ring Wear of piston pin hole and piston pin 14.3 Cylinder Block 14.3.1 Disassembly Remove the cylinder head/ (see 12.3.1 for details) Disassemble the cylinder head. (see 13.3.1 for details) a Remove the cylinder block [A]. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 375 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Remove the washer [A] and dowel pin [B]. 14.3.2 Inspection Check the wear situation of inner wall of cylinder. If the wear is serious, please replace it. 14.3.3 Installation of cylinder a Install the washer [A] and dowel pin [B] on the crankcase. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 376 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Apply oil to the inner wall of cylinder, piston and piston ring. Install the piston ring into the cylinder carefully. *Note: Do not damage the piston ring. 14.4 Piston 14.4.1 Disassembly ●Remove the piston pin retainer. Note: During disassembly, do not drop the retainer into the crankcase. ●Take out the piston pin [A] and remove piston. a ●Remove the piston ring. ○Check the piston, piston pin and piston ring. is n ra Note: Do not break or damage the piston ring. b ○Clear the carbon deposits inside the piston ring groove. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 377 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 14.4.2 Inspection ●Install the piston ring. ●Measure the clearance between piston ring and piston ring groove. ○Allowable limit: top ring: 0.1mm. Second ring: 0.1mm. ●Remove the piston ring and install the piston rings at the bottom of cylinder. *Note: Note: Press the piston ring [A] in the cylinder by using the piston head [B]. ● Measure the piston ring joint clearance. ○Allowable limit: first ring: 0.55mm. Second ring: 0.75mm ●Measure the inner diameter of piston pin hole. ○Allowable limit: 17.04mm. a b is n ra ●Measure the outer diameter of piston pin. ○ Allowable limit: 16.96mm. ●Clearance between piston pin hole and piston pin. ○ Allowable limit: 0.07mm. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 378 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Measure the outer diameter of piston pin. *Note: The measurement position forms an angle of 90 degrees with the piston pin and it is 7mm below the piston skirt part. ○ Allowable limit: 72.7mm. ●Check the damage and wear on the inner wall of cylinder. *Note: Measure the inner diameter of cylinder in the upper, middle and lower positions in the direction which forms a right angle (90 degrees) with the piston pin. ○ Allowable limit: 72.815mm. ●Measure the clearance between cylinder and piston , whichever is the greater ○Allowable limit: 0.115mm. ●Measure the roundness of inner wall of cylinder (inner diameter difference between X and Y directions). Allowable limit: 0.05mm ●Measure the cylindricity of inner wall of cylinder (inner diameter difference between X and Y directions in upper, middle and lower positions). Allowable limit: 0.05mm a Upper b Middle .A S SLower I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 379 - is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Check the planeness of cylinder surface. ○Allowable limit: 0.06mm. ●Measure the inner diameter of small end of connecting rod. ○Allowable limit: 17.05mm. 13.4.3 Installation of Piston ●Apply oil to the piston ring and piston evenly, make the piston ring mark side up and install it properly. *Note: Do not scratch the piston and do not break the piston ring. After the piston ring is installed, it can rotate freely in the piston ring groove. Top ring Second ring Oil ring b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 380 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d ●Clean the washers attached to the crankcase[A]. *Note: Foreign matters shall not fall into the crankcase. ●Install the piston, piston pin and piston pin retainer. *Note: Install the piston into the intake valve according to the “IN” mark [A] at the top. 14.5 Crankshaft connecting rod 14.5.1 Inspection a ●Measure the lateral clearance of big end of connecting rod. ○Allowable limit: 0.55mm. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra Plug gauge - 381 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Measure the clearance of big end of connecting rod in X-Y direction. ○ Allowable limit: 0.05mm ●Measure the run-out of crankshaft. ○ Allowable limit: 0.1mm Measuring point ●Check whether the crankshaft bearing rotates with abnormal noise or whether it is loose. ★ If there is abnormal noise or it is loose, replace the crankshaft assembly. Crankshaft bearing a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 382 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Crankshaft connecting rod 45~50N.m 160~165N.m 135~140N. m Crankcase a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 383 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Crankcase a No Chinese name and specifications 1 Torque Number of N·m kgf·m Crankcase machining assembly (matte black) 1 — — 2 Taper plug 1 — — 3 Bolt M6×75 4 10~12 4 Conical plug M10×1 3 — 5 Seal I 1 6 Oil Seal 1 7 Oil seal cover 1 8 Bolt M6×10 9 O-Ring 20.3×2.65 10 Gear sensor 11 Screw M5×16 12 13 14 Y P CO E G Throttle plug Y A Oil filter OW O-ring 22.4×1.8 T O M - O E G R .A S S— — I N A s o i r it 1.0~1.2 im— D — — — — 10~12 1.0~1.2 1 — — 1 — — 2 5~7 0.5~0.7 2 — — 1 — — 1 — — KA B2R - 384 - is n ra Note b Ka k -d 15 Oil filter plug 1 — — 16 Stud 4 — — 17 Washer 10.5×19.8×2 4 — — 18 Self-locking nut M10×1.25 4 45~50 4.5~5.0 19 Bolt M6×60 14 10~12 1.0~1.2 20 Rolling bearing 2 — — 21 Bearing I 2 — — 22 Bearing II 2 — — 23 Rubber Blanket 1 — — 24 Plug screw 1 — — 25 Sealing washer 1 — — 26 Screw M6×12 5 10~12 1.0~1.2 27 Bearing retainer II 5 — — 28 Rolling bearing 1 — — 29 Dowel pin 2 — — 30 Rolling bearing 1 — — 31 Limit retaining screw 1 — — 32 Rolling bearing 1 — — 33 Rolling bearing 1 — — 34 Rolling bearing 1 — — 35 Breather pipe 1 — — 36 Taper plug M14×1.5×10 1 — — 37 Filter housing 1 — — 38 Assembling washer 1 — — 39 Holder 1 — — 40 Bolt M6×14 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 41 Combination screw M4×10 6 3.5~4.5 0.35~0.45 42 Rivetφ3×13 1 — — 43 Breather valve retainer 1 — — 44 Paper washer of breather valve 1 — — 45 Screw M6×14 2 — — 46 Block chain plate 1 — — 47 O-Ring 1 — — 48 O-ring Φ12.5×1.8 1 — — .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 385 - im D - s o i r it a Ka b is n ra k -d XV. Crankcase Preparatory Information------------------------------------------------------- 15.1 Dismounting and Mounting Diagram of Crankcase Bearing------------- 15.2 Crankcase------------------------------------------------------------------------ 15.3 15.1 Preparatory Information Function of crankcase: The crankcase is the bearing part of engine. Its main function is to support the crankshaft, clutch, gearbox, cylinder block and cylinder head, withstand the combustion explosion impact and inertia force of movement of crankshaft connecting rod mechanism and form a part of closed (oil and air seal) space. Operation Precautions: The crankcase is also equipped with suspension holes, and the engine is connected with the frame and other parts through the connection with the suspension holes on the motorcycle. a This section mainly introduces the disassembly and installation of parts of crankcase, torque value of bolt specifications, Note is n ra for disassembly and installation and other services; b Locking torque Assembling bolt 10 N·m Apply oil Oil seal cover bolt 10 N·m Apply oil Gear position sensor mounting screw 6 N·m Apply oil Breather valve retainer assembly screw 4 N·m Apply oil Bearing retainer screw 10 N·m Block chain plate bolt 10 N·m Bracket bolt 10 N·m .A S S Apply I locking agent N A Apply oil R B A K 45 N·m E RG Two-headed bolt O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M im D - - 386 - Apply oil Apply oil s o i r it Ka k -d 15.2 Disassembly and Installation of Crankcase Bearing Serial number Note Designation: 1 Needle bearing 6203 Apply oil 2 Rolling bearing 6322 Apply oil 3 Oil Seal Apply oil 4 Rolling bearing 6304 Apply oil 5 Oil Seal Apply oil 6 Rolling bearing 6304 Apply oil 7 Rolling bearing 6905 Apply oil 8 Rolling bearing 6205 Apply oil 9 Rolling bearing 6004 Apply oil Locking torque a Bearing retainer screw 10 N·m Apply locking agent Precautions 1. 2. 3. The bearing disassembled cannot be reused and should be replaced with a new one; Bearings and oil seals should be disassembled by using special tools, to prevent damaging the crankcase body; When installing new bearing and oil seal, apply oil or lubricating grease with the specifications shown in the figure; K E RG O O CO Y P T O M .A S S I N A R B A E G Y A W b - 387 - im D - is n ra s o i r it Ka k -d 15.3 Crankcase 15.3.1 Disassembly of crankcase ●Steps for opening crankcase: ○Right crankcase assembly ① a. Remove assembling bolt of crankcase Precautions: For the crankcase assembling bolt marked as shown in the figure, first loosen 1/4 of the engagement length and then completely loosen assembling bolt later in the staggered mode; ○Left crankcase assembly ② b. Open the components of right crankcase Precautions: Insert a screwdriver to the disassembling point in the box, and then carefully open the upper and lower boxes; Tap the side of box using a soft hammer, only tap the reinforced part of box but not the processing surface of box, tap it carefully and slowly, to ensure that the upper and lower boxes are evenly separated; a b c.Remove the dowel pin; 15.3.2 Inspection of crankcase Precautions: 1. 2. .A S S Clean the disassembled crankcase parts with detergent; I N A Clean the disassembling surface of crankcase and the R B A joint surface of left and right covers; 3. The crankcase is a thin-walled casting. Heavy impact K E RG should be avoided during the operation to prevent deformation or breakage. 4. Check Item CO O E G Y A W Before operation, the lubricant in the crankcase should be released. Y P O T O M is n ra - 388 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Check the crankshaft for defects such as cracks. ★ If there is any defect, replace crankshaft components. ●Check the oil filter for clogging and damage. ★If there is any defect, replace oil filter. ● Check the timing chain ○ Visually check whether the chain is worn, and feel with two hands whether the chain is rotating unsmoothly and inflexibly. ★ If necessary, replace the timing chain, and adjust the initial position of the main chain guide plate tensioner. a b is n ra ● Check crankcase bearing ○ Rotate the inner ring of bearing with your fingers to check whether the bearing cannot rotate flexibly and is blocked. ★If necessary, replace the new bearing with special tools. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 389 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Check oil seal ○ Check the seal lip for damage or deformation, and whether there is any edge cut deformation in the outer ring. ★If necessary, replace the new bearing with special tools. 15.4.3 Assembly of crankcase Precautions ● Clean the parts, apply oil or grease with the specified specifications evenly on the seal of bearing to be replaced for future use. ● Bearing, bearing plate: Note: The round edge side of retainer of bearing faces the pressing surface of bearing, and the tightening torque of retainer bolt should be ensured (7N•m). ● Clean the assembling surface and other joint surfaces. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 390 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Apply sealant at the assembling surface: Note: Apply sealant around the bolt hole evenly, and prevent sealant going into the lubricating oil passage of crankcase. ● After the internal parts of left crankcase are assembled, assemble the right crankcase to left crankcase, and slightly knock the crankcase with a soft hammer; a ●Assembling bolt Note: Tighten the assembling bolt on the left crankcase, the tightening torque of which should meet the requirements (10N•m); Then tighten the assembling bolt on the right crankcase, the tightening torque of which should meet the requirements (10N•m); b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 391 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Clutch Position of right cover 10N·m 12N·m Position of clutch 10N·m 45N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 392 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Right Cover No CO Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Bolt M6×38 2 10~12 1.0~1.2 2 Bolt M6×30 12 10~12 1.0~1.2 3 Inner hexagon screw M6×30 3 10~12 1.0~1.2 4 Filter cover 1 — — 5 O-Ring 1 — — 6 Engine oil filter assembly 1 — — 7 Oil level indicator assembly 1 — — 8 Conical plug M12×1.5 1 — — 9 Conical plug M10×1 1 — — 10 Right Cover 1 — — 11 Dowel pin 2 — 12 Washer on the right cover 1 — im D - — 13 Plug screw of oil filler 1 — — 14 O-Ring 18×3.5 1 — — 15 Lever spring — — 16 Needle bearing 12×16×10 — — 1 — — 1 — — 1 — — 1 .A S S I N A K Lever oil seal 17 E G Operating lever riveting component 18 R Nameplate 19 EO G Y A OW T O M Y P R B 2 A - 393 - s o i r it — Note a Ka b is n ra k -d Clutch No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Driving hub assembly of clutch. 1 — — 2 Spline washer 1 — — 3 Clutch component 1 — — 4 Driven hub assembly of clutch 1 — — 5 Lock washer 1 — — 6 Slef-locking nut 1 45~50 4.5~5.0 7 Friction pad 2 4 — — 8 Clutch plate 6 — — 9 Friction pad 1 3 — — 10 Clutch lever 1 — — 11 Plane needle bearing 1 — — 12 Bolt assembly 4 10~12 1.0~1.2 13 Filter spring 4 — — 14 Driven hub base of clutch 1 — .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 394 - s o i r it im— D - Note a Ka b is n ra k -d XVI. Clutch Preparatory Information--------------------- 16.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 16.2 Right Cover----------------------------------- 16.3 Clutch ---------------------------------------- 16.3 16.1 Preparatory Information Operation Precautions: ·Install the engine on the frame, and disassemble right cover and clutch. ·Engine oil viscosity and oil level may affect clutch separation. When the clutch is not separated or unclear, check the engine oil level before repairing the clutch system. Technical parameters Item Standard Allowable limit 10°-20° — Free length of clutch spring 35 33.7 Thickness of clutch friction 2.9-3.0 2.6 wrapping of clutch metal plate — 0.3 Inner diameter of clutch bushing — — Outer diameter of clutch bushing — Free corner of clutch operating lever 45-50 N·m Clutch spring bolt 10-12 N·m Right cover mounting bolt 10-12 N·m Oil filter mounting bolt 10-12 N·m Crankshaft retainer bolt 5 N·m .A S S I N A K E RG R B A Apply locking agent to threads O Tools E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M im D - - 395 - s— o i r it is n ra b Ka Locking torque Clutch lock nut a k -d Central pivot universal fixer of clutch 16.2 Fault Diagnosis 16.2.1 Clutch lever is too hard to pull ·The detaching mechanism of clutch is damaged ·The detaching bearing of clutch fails ·The push rod of clutch is not installed properly 16.2.2 Clutch is slipping when accelerating ·The friction plate of clutch is worn ·The clutch spring is not elastic enough ·Engine oil is mixed with molybdenum or graphite additives 16.2.3 Clutch does not disengage or clutch disengages suddenly during the running of motorcycle b ·Clutch plate is wrapping ·Clutch lock nut is loosened ·The oil level is too high ·Oil viscosity is poor .A S S ·The detaching mechanism of clutch is damaged ·The push rod of clutch is not installed properly I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 396 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d 16.3 Right Cover 16.3.1 Disassembly of Right Cover Loosen the clamp bolt and remove the right cover. 16.3.2 Install the right cover ●Installation shall be carried out in the order contrary to the disassembly order. Locking torque: Right cover mounting bolt: 10-12 N·m a 16.4 Clutch b 16.4.1 Disassembly of clutch ●Fix the clutch driven hub base [A] using a dedicated clutch central pivot universal fixer, and the clutch cannot be rotated. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 397 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ○Central pivot universal fixer of clutch ●Loosen bolt assembly [A] and remove clutch driven hub base [B]. ● Remove the clutch spring [A]. ● Remove the clutch friction plate and clutch metal plate [B]. a ●Loosen clutch lock nut, and remove the clutch lock nut [A]. ●Remove clutch driven hub assembly [B] and spline washer. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 398 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Remove clutch driving hub assembly [A]. ●Remove clutch lever [A], thrust washer [C], plane needle bearing [B]. 16.4.2 Inspection ● Check the outer groove of clutch for any burrs or broken marks. ★ If necessary, finish it using a file, and replace it if the amount of finishing is too large. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 399 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Check the tooth forms of clutch central pivot plate [A] and retainer [B] for damage. ★If damaged, replaced it. ●Measure the free length of pressure spring [A]. ○Allowable limit: Replace it if the length is less than 29.7mm. a ●Measure the thickness of friction plate with a vernier calipers [A]. ○Allowable limit: Replace it if the thickness is less than 2.6mm. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 400 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Check the flatness of clutch metal plate with a feeler gauge. ○Allowable limit: Replace it if the flatness is more than 0.3mm. 16.4.3 Installation of clutch ●Install the clutch in the reverse order of disassembly. Locking torque: Clutch lock nut: 45-50 N·m Clutch spring bolt: 10-12 N·m a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 401 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Gearshift Mechanism a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 402 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Gearshift Mechanism a is n ra b No CO Chinese name and specifications of N·m — 1 Shift shaft assembly 1 2 Bolt M6×20 1 3 Washer 1 4 Stopper lever spring 1 5 Rocker arm assembly 6 Washer 7 Star wheel screw 8 Ratchet .A S S— 8~10 I N A E G Collar 9 Y Dowel pin A 10 OW T O M Y P O E G R - 0.8~1.0 — — — — — 1 — — 1 8~10 0.8~1.0 1 — — 1 — — 1 — — B1R KA s o i r it kgf·m m Di — Torque Number - 403 - Ka Note k -d a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 404 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d XVII. Gearshift Mechanism Preparatory Information--------------------- 17.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 17.2 Gearshift Mechanism------------------------ 17.3 17.1 Preparatory Information Locking torque Start wheel bolt 8-10 N·m Positioning roller rocker bolt 8-10 N·m Apply locking agent 17.2 Fault Diagnosis 17.2.1 It is difficult to shift gears ·Clutch operation is incorrect ·Oil viscosity is incorrect a ·Shift fork is bent is n ra ·Shift fork is bent ·Shift fork jaw is bent b ·Gearshift positioning star wheel is damaged ·Positioning roller rocker bolt is loosened ·Positioning roller rocker is damaged ·The shift shaft and shift arm are damaged .A S S 17.2.2 Shift pedal is not returned I N A ·The return spring of gearshift shaft is damaged or its elasticity is weakened R B A ·Gearshift shaft is bent K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 405 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 17.3 Gearshift Mechanism 17.3.1 Disassembly ●Pull out the gearshift shaft assembly [A] ●Disassemble the following parts in order: Positioning roller rocker bolt [A] Washer [B] Positioning roller rocker assembly [C] Roller rocker spring a Note: b There are two washers behind and pay attention to prevent missing .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 406 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Disassemble Star wheel bolt [A] Collar [B] Ratchet [C] ●Remove the dowel pin [A] 17.3.2 Inspection ●Before disassembly, the shift plate [A] should be able to return flexibly without clamping. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 407 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Check the shift shaft [A] ★Check it for bending, wear and damage ●Check the wear of shift locking plate. ★ If the wear is serious, please replace it. ●Remove the shift shaft spring [B]. ★ Check the shift shaft spring for damage and weakened elasticity, and replace it when necessary a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 408 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 17.3.3 Installation ●Tighten the star wheel screw [A] after assembling collar [B] and ratchet [C]. ○The tightening torque is12 N·m, and apply locking agent to the thread. ●Hook the rocker arm spring [D] to the rivet of box and positioning roller rocker arm, install upper washer [B] and positioning roller rocker arm [A]. ○Tighten the positioning roller rocker arm bolt with a tightening torque of 10N·m. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 409 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Drive system a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 410 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 411 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Drive system a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 412 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d No Torque Number Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 1 Shift drum 1 — — 2 Prod spring 1 — — 3 Shifting prod 1 — — 4 Elastic retainer for shaft 1 — — 5 Collar 1 — — 6 Thrust washer 1 — — 7 Auxiliary shaft combination 1 — — 8 O-Ring 1 — — 9 Output sprocket collar 1 — — 10 Sprocket 1 — — 11 Spline washer 1 — — 12 Nut M18×1 1 110~115 11.0~11.5 13 Shift fork shaft 1 — — 14 Shift fork III 1 — — 15 Shift fork I 1 — — 16 Primary Shaft Assembly 1 — — 17 Shift fork II 1 — — 18 Shift fork shaft I 1 — — Note a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 413 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d XVIII. Drive System Preparatory Information--------------------- 18.1 Fault Diagnosis------------------------------- 18.2 Drive system---------------------------------- 18.3 Installation------------------------------------ 18.4 18.1 Preparatory Information Function: Transmit torque, and decide the torque and speed of final output. Technical parameters Item Shift fork Shift fork shaft Shift drum standard value Limit value Inner diameter 10.016~10.034 10.05 Thickness of claw 4.93~5.00 4.90 Outer diameter 9.991~10.00 9.98 Outer diameter 41.8~42.0 41.7 Groove width 6.05~6.15 6.2 M4 25.020~25.041 25.06 M5 28.016~28.033 28.05 C1 20.020~20.41 C2 25.020~25.041 C3 25.020~25.041 Installation position of M5 27.967~27.98 27.95 Installation position of M4 im 24.98~24.993 D - 24.96 19.966~19.984 15.95 24.959~24.98 24.94 24.959~24.98 24.94 0.035~0.075 0.105 0.027~0.061 0.09 0.040~0.082 0.110 0.040~0.082 0.110 Inner diameter of gear Outer diameter of collar of internal spline Drive system CO Outer diameter of primary shaft Installation position of C1 .A Outer diameter of auxiliary shaft Installation positionS of C2 IS Installation N position of C3 Fit clearance between collar and RAC1 B A shaft K E M4 G Tolerance clearance between gear R C2 and shaftO E C3 G Y Locking torqueWA TObolt 110-115 N·m Sprocket mounting O M - 414 PY s o i r it is n a br25.06 20.06 Ka 22.06 a k -d 18.2 Fault Diagnosis 18.2.1 Drive system trips over stop or is out of gear ·Positioning roller rocker is damaged ·Positioning roller rocker spring is damaged or its elasticity is weakened· ·Positioning roller rocker bolt is loosened ·Shift fork shaft or shift fork is bent or damaged ·Gearshift star wheel is bent or damaged ·Shift fork is bent or damaged 18.2.2 The noise of engine is too large ·The gear of drive system is damaged ·The bearing of drive system is damaged 18.3 Drive system 18.3.1 Primary shaft component a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 415 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 18.3.2 Auxiliary shaft component 18.3.3 Inspection ●Check the shift fork (applicable to all shift forks) ·Shift fork head ① ·Shift fork claw ② ★Bending, damage, wear → Replace shift fork a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 416 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Measure the inner diameter of shift fork hole. Allowable limit: 10.05mm. Measure the thickness of shift fork. Allowable limit: 4.90mm. ●Check shift fork shaft ○Put the shift fork at a plane and roll it back and forth ★Bending→replacement a Warning Do not try to straighten the bent shift fork shaft b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 417 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Measure the outer diameter of shift fork shaft. Allowable limit: 9.98mm. ●Check the sliding of shift fork (along the shift fork shaft) ★ The shift fork cannot slide flexibly → Replace the complete set of shift fork and shift fork shaft ●Check the shift drum ○Shift drum stroke groove ★ Damage, scratches and wear → Replace shift drum component ○Shift drum shaft section ★Bending, wear → Replace shift drum component a b is n ra Measure the outer diameter of shift drum. Allowable limit: 41.7mm. Measure the width of lock groove of shift drum. Allowable limit: 6.2mm. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 418 - im D - s o i r it Ka Lock groove k -d ●Measure the main axle runout (with centering device and dial indicator) ★Exceed the limit size → replace the main axle Limit size of main axle runout: 0.03mm ●Measure the auxiliary axle runout (with centering device and dial indicator) ★Exceed the limit size → replace the auxiliary axle Limit size of auxiliary axle runout: 0.03mm ● Inspection ○Gear ★ Bluegrass, pitting corrosion, wear → Replace defective gears ○Gear pawl ★Cracks, damage, round edges → Replace defective gears ● Inspection ○ Gear engagement (gear teeth of each gear) ★Incorrect → Reassemble the drive shaft component a b is n ra ● Inspection ○Gear rotation ★Inflexible rotation → Replace defective parts .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 419 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ● Inspection ○Retainer ★Bending, damage, looseness → Replacement 18.4 Installation 18.4.1 Assembly of Primary Shaft Component and Auxiliary Shaft Component ●Installation ○Spline washer ② ○Retainer ① Note: Make sure that the sharp edge of retainer ○ A is located on the side opposite to spline washer; make sure that the opening of retainer ○ b is located on the spline groove of shaft○ c a b is n ra .A S S ●Installation ○2nd Gear of primary shaft ① CO R B A K E Gprimary shaft Install the 2nd Gear of primary shaft onR the ②, and then measure after compaction EO○a G Y A OW T O M Y P Note: I N A - 420 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 18.4.2 Assembly of parts at the shift drum ●Installation ○Shift prod ① ○Prod spring ② Note: First assemble prod spring ② to the shift drum ③ , and then assemble the shift prod ① to the shift drum ③ ; the assembly shall be conducted when installing the transmission system, to prevent parts from falling off 18.4.3 Installation of drive system 18.4.3.1 Installation ·Auxiliary shaft component ① ·Primary shaft component ② ·Shift drum component ·Left shift fork of auxiliary shaft ③ ·Right shift fork of auxiliary shaft ④ ·Shift fork shaft of auxiliary shaft ⑤ ·Middle shift fork of primary shaft ⑥ ·Shift fork shaft of primary shaft ⑦ a ·O-ring ⑧ ·Collar ⑨ ·Output sprocket ⑩ b 110~115N·m ·Lock nut ·Lock plate .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 421 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ·Thrust washer ·Collar · Retainer Note: ·When installing the left shift fork, make sure that the side of shift fork with the ribs on it is facing away from the right crankcase of engine. ·When installing the right shift fork, make sure that the side of shift fork with the ribs on it is facing away from the left crankcase of engine. Make sure that the shift fork head is located in the shift drum stroke groove. 18.4.3.2 Inspection ● Transmission system ★Inflexible rotation→Repair Note: ·Fully grease the gears, shafts, bearings and other parts. ·When assembling, ensure that the transmission system is in neutral and each gear can rotate freely a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 422 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Electric Starter a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 423 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Electric starting No Chinese name and specifications of N·m kgf·m 10~12 1.0~1.2 1 Bolt M6×32 2 2 Starter motor assembly 1 3 Screw M8×14 3 22~29 2.2~2.9 4 Flywheel combination 1 — — 5 Electric starter gear shaft 1 — — 6 Electric starter idle shaft 1 — 7 Electric starter idle gear 1 — 8 Close-packed clutch assembly 1 im D - — 9 Starter gear assembly 1 10 Stator assembly 1 11 Screw M5×16 12 Screw M6×30 13 Electric starter gear E G Y A W O E G R .A S S— — I N A Y P T O M s o i r it — — — — — 5~7 0.5~0.7 3 10~12 1.0~1.2 1 — — KA B2R O CO Torque Number - 424 - Note Ka b is n ra a k -d XIX. Electric Starter Mechanism Preparatory Information---------------------19.1 Fault Diagnosis---------------------19.2 Electric Starter Mechanism-----------------19.3 19.1 Preparatory Information Technical parameters Item Starter gear Outer diameter of axle section standard value Limit value 45.653~45.677 45.573 Locking torque Flywheel locknut 90 N·m Stator assembly mounting bolt 10-12N·m Trigger probe mounting bolt 5-7N·m Star wheel combination mounting bolt 10-12N·m Starter motor mounting bolt 10-12 N·m a 19.2 Troubleshooting b 19.2.1 Engine cannot start ·Overrunning clutch is damaged · Starter wheel or idle gear is damaged .A S S Starter motor is damaged I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 425 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 19.3 Electric starter mechanism 19.3.1 Disassembly of electric starter mechanism ● Loosen left cover bolt [A]. *Note: Note: Loosen the bolt in a criss-cross form, and loosen the bolt by 1/4 each time and then remove the left cover ● Remove the left cover [B] ● Loosen the outgoing line retainer mounting bolt [A], and take down the outgoing line retainer [B]. a b ●Loosen stator assembly mounting bolt [A] and trigger mounting bolt [B], and remove the stator assembly [C] .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 426 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Loosen flywheel locknut [A] using the electric tools, pull out the flywheel clutch assembly [B] using three-jaw chuck, remove the electric starter idle gear [E], electric starter idle gear shaft [F], electric starter gear [C] and electric starter gear shaft [D] ●Anticlockwise rotate starter gear assembly [A], as shown in the figure. ●Take out the starter gear assembly. ●Loosen star wheel combination mounting bolt [A] and remove the star wheel combination [B]. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 427 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Loosen motor mounting bolt [A] and remove the starter motor [B]. 19.3.2 Installation of electric starter mechanism ●Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 428 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Muffler catalyst a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 429 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Emission Control a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 430 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d a b is n ra Ka k -d Temporarily absorb the fuel steam overflowing from the fuel tank into the charcoal canister using the adsorption effect of the activated carbon in the canister; When negative pressure is generated in the fuel tank, air will enter the canister from the atmosphere entry, enter the evaporating tube from the absorbing port, and finally enter the fuel tank. When the engine is running under certain conditions, it will be absorbed under the control of EVBP, fuel steam will be led to the engine for combustion, and the absorption capacity of the activated carbon in the canister will recover. When the evaporation plant is blocked, the breather valve will play the following roles: 1. When positive pressure (8-15kpa) is generated in the fuel tank, the breather valve will automatically exhaust air. 2. When negative pressure (-1.0- -1.5kpa) is generated in the fuel tank, the breather valve will be automatically opened, and air will enter the fuel tank through the breather valve. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 431 - im D - s o i r it XX. Exhaust Emission Control System Guarantee of Exhaust Emission Control System-------------------- 20.1 Regular Maintenance Notice/Guarantee Emission Standard------ 20.2 Mechanical Function of Exhaust Control System------------------- 20.3 Catalytic Conversion System------------------------------------------ 20.4 20.1 Guarantee of Exhaust Emission Control System 1. 1. The exhaust emission control system of the motorcycle complies with the provisions of Regulation (EU) No 134/2014. This Company will provide the guarantee in the case of completely normal use and maintenance as required within the effective service life of the exhaust emission control system. 2. Scope of guarantee 1) Function guarantee of exhaust emission control system It is guaranteed that the system meets the regular or irregular exhaust inspection performed by government agencies within the scope of use (15,000 km). 3. If the following situations exist, this guarantee clause will not be applicable, but the provincial or city dealers or service departments of this Company are still willing to serve customers at a reasonable price if there are maintenance needs. 1) The regular maintenance is not performed according to the time or mileage specified by this Company. 2) The regular inspection, adjustment or maintenance is not carried out at the dealers or service centers of this Company or the maintenance record certificates cannot be provided. 3) Overload or improper use. 4) The motorcycle is transformed, original parts are disassembled or other devices are installed at will. 5) The motorcycle is used for races or frequently ridden on the roads which are applicable to non-motor vehicles. 6) Damage is caused due to typhoon, flood and other weather disasters or damage and faults are caused due to negligence, accident or impact of foreign objects. 7) The motorcycle is disused in a long term without regular maintenance. 8) The odometer is damaged and not maintained immediately or it is transformed, disused or changed artificially. 9) The motorcycle is sent to the inspection station for exhaust inspection every three months. The new motorcycles of this Company have passed the UNECE regulation No 41 including all amendments up to Series 04, Supplement 3 standard implemented by EU through the noise inspection results. is n ra b 20.2 Regular Maintenance Notice .A S S In order to ensure that the degree of environmental pollution will not become increasingly serious, the state requires that all the motor vehicles produced by all manufacturers must meet the air pollution emission standards. The production of this Company meets the provisions of air pollution emission standards, meanwhile, the Company also strives to purify the air and take efforts to reduce air pollution. This motorcycle has passed rigorous inspection before leaving the factory and meets the provisions of air pollution emission standards. However, due to the different service conditions of this product, we have formulated the following regular checklist on exhaust emission. To ensure normal emission, the users should carry out inspection, adjustment or maintenance in accordance with the specified time. For other individual problems on use, please ask the dealers or Service Center. The relevant emission provisions are shown below: I N A R B A K E RG O CO im D - s o i r it Ka Y P E G Y A W O T O M - 432 - a k -d Emission regulation Emission standard CO ≤1.14g/km HC ≤0.38g/km NOX 0.07g/km ※ If the emission standard changes, the newest national provision shall prevail. If the regular inspection is not carried out at the dealers or service centers of this Company, this Company will not be responsible for the prohibition. Please make necessary inspection at any time to maintain the best motorcycle conditions. Note: ①The cleaning frequency of air filter should be increased if the motorcycle is ridden on sandy roads or in the seriously polluted environment to prolong the service life of engine. ② If the motorcycle is always ridden at a high speed or in a frequent manner with large mileage, the maintenance degree should be increased. Precautions for guarantee of emission standards 1) 2) 3) 4) The unleaded gasoline should be restricted. The engine oil with the specification specified should be used. Please carry out maintenance in accordance with the provisions of the regular maintenance table. For the exhaust control system, arbitrary adjustment or replacement (including use of spark plug, idle adjustment and ignition timing) is strictly prohibited. 5) Precautions: The catalyst device will be greatly affected due to the block of ignition system, charging system or fuel system; therefore, please go to the dealers or service centers specified by this Company for inspection, adjustment or maintenance if you feel that the engine is unsmooth. 6) The exhaust control system of the motorcycle complies with the national regulations. Therefore, if any parts of the system need to be replaced, make sure to use the original parts of this Company and carry out replacement by the specified dealer or service center 20.3 Mechanical Function of Exhaust Control System Summary The exhaust countermeasure is to use four-stroke single-cylinder engine and air induction device, maintain a good level of exhaust and adopt activated carbon canisters for exhaust from fuel evaporation. ※ Engine improvement is n ra Strive to increase the combustion efficiency depending on improved spark plug, combustion chamber, compression ratio, ignition time, exhaust system and other engine elements and high intake and exhaust efficiency. b ※ Air induction device im D - s o i r it Ka After air is induced into the exhaust pipe, the chemical reaction of incompletely burnt CO and HC will occur to generate harmless gases. Distinction Device .A S S Constituent part Exhaust system I N Catalyst device Catalyst converter RA B A K E G OR E G Y A W O OT P O C M Y - 433 - Function The canned oxydic catalyst installed in the middle of exhaust pipe will oxidize CO, HC and NOX. a k -d 20.4 Catalyst Conversion System 20.4.1 Structure: a is n ra b 20.4.2 Description: 1. im D - s o i r it Ka The function of catalyst conversion is to convert the completely burnt gases (including HC, CO and NOX) into H2O, CO2, N2 and other harmless gases and then discharge them. 2. When the catalyst containing platinum, rhodium and other rare metals is converted, unleaded gasoline should be used. ※Leaded gasoline will lead to the failure of catalyst. • General precautions during maintenance of motorcycles (exhaust pipes) with catalytic converters: 1) The motorcycle with a catalytic converter should not be touched after the engine is turned on or off, because the temperature is high in a short time. 2) The motorcycle with a catalytic converter should not be close to combustibles. 3) The carbon monoxide in the exhaust pipe is harmful to human body, so do not operate the engine in a closed space. 4) The motorcycle with a catalytic converter should not use leaded gasoline. (to prevent catalyst poisoning) .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 434 - k -d 5) 6) 7) 8) Do not start the engine by pushing the motorcycle. If necessary, start the engine by pushing the motorcycle after the temperature of the engine and catalytic converter is reduced. Do not ride the motorcycle by putting into gear or turning off the motorcycle during downhill running. Do not ride the motorcycle with poor ignition. When maintaining the ignition system of engine, it is not allowed to start the engine to check whether the spark plug can generate sparks by removing the spark plug. If it is necessary, the time should not be too long. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 435 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d XXI. Fuel injection system (EFI) 21.1 Introduction to EFI This motorcycle adopts the small engine electronic injection system from Delphi Corporation. For this system, the closed-loop control is realized by an oxygen sensor and the ECU oil injection and ignition are controlled. A three-way catalyst is used to carry out after treatment for the gas burnt by the engine to convert it into harmless gas and discharge it to the air. This system adopts the closed-loop control self-learning system which can effectively eliminate the manufacturing differences between the system and related mechanical parts, improve the overall consistency of the motorcycle and remove the errors caused due to wear and other factors after actual use. Idle control valve Throttle valve position sensor Crankshaft position sensor Burglar alarm Throttle body Optional 23X crankshaft position target gear Ignition coil Heating oxygen sensor Engine temperature sensor Engine control module Nozzle intake temperature neutral position switch a Down switch Serial communication interface of fault diagnosis switch intake pressure sensor b Ignition switch Fault indicator light Battery Engine speed signal .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 436 - is n ra im D - s o i r it Ka Metal carrier catalytic converter k -d Connector O CO Y P T O M O E G Y A W R B A K E RG - 437 - I N A .A S S im D - Battery power supply Oxygen sensor signal of cylinder 1 5V reference voltage Ignition power supply Cooling water temperature signal 23X signal is low Throttle position signal Intake pressure signal 5V reference voltage grounding (signal grounding) Fuel pump control signal Intake temperature signal Oxygen sensor of cylinder 1 is heated Nozzle A 23X signal is low KW2000 The power supply (system) is grounded Ignition coil drive A (cylinder 1) Neutral clutch switch Sidestand shutdown signal Idle stepper motor B low Idle stepper motor B high Idle stepper motor A low Ignition coil drive B (cylinder 2) The power supply (system) is grounded CAN line signal is high CAN line signal is low Tachometer Fault light EVBP Idle control valve A high Function Description 21.2 EFI system a b s o i r it Ka is n ra k -d Number of ECU connector Connector J1-1 J1-2 J1-3 J1-4 J1-5 J1-6 J1-7 J1-8 J1-9 J1-10 J1-11 J1-12 J1-13 J1-14 J1-15 J1-16 J1-17 J1-18 J2-1 J2-2 J2-3 J2-4 J2-5 J2-6 J2-7 J2-8 J2-9 J2-10 J2-11 J2-12 J2-13 J2-14 J2-15 J2-16 J2-17 J2-18 Function Description Idle control valve A high Canister solenoid valve Fault light Tachometer CAN line signal is low CAN line signal is high The power supply (system) is grounded Idle control valve A low Idle control valve B high Idle control valve B low Vehicle-down sensor signal (optional) Fuel pump control signal circuit Neutral position switch Ignition coil drive A: The power supply (system) is grounded K line communication pin 23 gear signal is low Nozzle A Oxygen sensor is heated Inlet temperature signal Fuel pump control signal 5V reference voltage grounding Inlet pressure signal Throttle position signal 23 gear signal is high Cylinder head temperature signal Ignition power supply 5V reference voltage Oxygen sensor signal Battery power supply a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 438 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.3 EFI part position a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 439 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.4 Technical parameters Item Standard Electronic Fuel Injection System Idling Throttle valve assembly: identity Diameter Negative pressure value of throttle valve Bypass screw ECU: Manufacturer identity 1400 ±100 r/min (rpm) Cylinder-shaped Φ37 mm ––– MT05.2 Delphi Electronic memory type with built-in IC igniter, sealed with resin 100 ∼ 15000 r/min (rpm) 250 kPa Available engine speed range Fuel pressure (high pressure hose): Fuel pump: identity Oil pump capacity Fuel injector: Nozzle type Resistance: Main throttle sensor: Input supply voltage Output supply voltage Resistance Inlet air pressure sensor / atmospheric pressure sensor Input supply voltage Output supply voltage Inlet temperature sensor: ECU output voltage Resistance Fuel tank built-in friction pump ≥67 mL (2.3 US oz.) every 3 seconds Fine atomization type, ≈10-15 Ω at 20°C (68°F) DC 4.75 ∼ 5.25 V DC 0.25 - 4.65 V (throttle opening is idle to fully open) 3 ∼ 12kΩ DC 4.75 ∼ 5.25 V DC 3.80 ∼ 4.20 V [standard atmospheric pressure] 2.0 - 2.69 kΩ at 20°C (68°F); 0.30-0.37 kΩ at 80°C (176°F) Oxygen sensor (model with oxygen sensor): Output power supply voltage (peak value at the highest ≥DC 0.8 V air-fuel ratio) Output power supply voltage (peak value at the lowest air-fuel ≤DC 0.45 V ratio) Heating coil resistance =6.7-12Ω at 20°C (68°F) .A S S I N A Throttle handle and throttle cable Free clearance of throttle handle Air filter Element material G Y WA EO K E RG R B A 3∼5 mm Dry paper filter element O CO Y P T O M im D - - 440 - s o i r it Ka b is n ra a k -d 21.5 Precautions for EFI Overhaul 21.5.1 Precautions for EFI Overhaul There are the following important precautions in the process of overhauling the EFI system. ○The power supply of this EFI system must be supplied by a 12V battery. Do not use any other battery as a power source for the EFI system. ○Do not connect the battery cable reversely. Otherwise, the ECU may be damaged. ○ To avoid damage to EFI parts, do not disconnect the battery cable or any other electrical connectors while the electric door lock is in the “ON” position or while the engine is running. ○Be careful not to short-circuit the cable that directly connect the positive (+) electrode of the battery and the ground wire of the chassis. ○ Disconnect the connecting wire between battery and motorcycle during charging to avoid excessive voltage and damage to the ECU. ○ Turn off the electric door lock before disconnecting the EFI electrical connection, and then disconnect the battery (-) pin. Do not pull the wire and only pull the connector. Conversely, make sure that each EFI electrical connector has been properly connected before starting the engine. ○ Connect the connector adapter to the power supply with bridges properly. a b is n ra ○ Do not open the electric door lock if no EFI electrical connectors are connected. The ECU will remember the fault code. ○Do not spray water on electrical parts, EFI parts connectors, leads and electric wires! ○If the motorcycle is equipped with a transceiver, ensure that the operation of the EFI system is not affected by the radio waves emitted by the antenna. Run the engine at idle speed and check the operating status of system. The antenna shall be kept away from the ECU as far as possible. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 441 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ○ Do not open the electric door lock if any fuel hose is disconnected. Otherwise, the fuel pump will run, thereby causing fuel to be ejected from the fuel hose. ○Do not operate when the fuel pump is completely dry to prevent the fuel pump from getting stuck. ○ Before disassembling the parts of the fuel injection system, blow off the dirt or dust on the outside of the parts with compressed air. ○ When any fuel hose is disconnected, fuel may be ejected due to residual pressure in the hose Therefore, cover the hose joint with a clean rag to prevent fuel from overflowing. ○ When installing the hose, avoid bending, twisting or warping the hose, and do not bend the hose as much as possible to avoid blocking the oil circuit. Arrange the fuel hose in accordance with section "Winding Method of Cables, Wires and Hoses" of chapter "Appendix". ○ Do not add any fuel antifreeze chemicals to the fuel to avoid corroding the fuel injection system or causing deposits in the fuel injection system. ○ If the operation method is improper, the high pressure inside the fuel hose may cause fuel leakage [A] or fuel hose rupture. Bend and twist when inspecting the fuel hose. ★If the fuel hose is found to be broken or swelled, it must be replaced! a ○ In order to maintain the correct mixing ratio of fuel and air (F/A), there must be no air intake leakage in the EFI system. Always tighten the filler plug [A] after adding the oil. Locking torque of filler plug: tighten by hands. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 442 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.6 ECU 21.6.1 Engine controller (MT05 ECU) The engine controller can detect the operating state of the engine in real time through various sensors. Ensure the original motorcycle emission and fuel economy while optimizing the driving performance of motorcycle under various working conditions through reasonable calculation and self-learning control output devices. The engine controller can also wake up the self-diagnosis when the system is faulty. 21.6.2 ECU Appearance The upper part of MT05 engine controller housing is made of plastic and the bottom is made of aluminum alloy. The picture shows the front and back of MT05 controller. a b is n ra .A S S I N A 21.6.3 ECU disassembly R B A K E RG O ●Remove rear seat cushion (see "Frame" - "Removing Rear Seat Cushion") E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 443 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●Disassemble: ECU[A] Bolt [B] 21.6.4 ECU installation ●Install it in the reverse order of disassembly. Tightening bolt torque of ECU: 3.9N•m Warning The mounting surface must be flat to prevent generating external force to the controller and thus making the circuit board bent. 21.6.5 Precautions for ECU Precautions Cause Do not: Place the ECU near the exhaust pipe or engine High temperatures may reduce the service life of ECU and even directly damage the ECU Do not: place the ECU near water drops, engine oil or any liquid ECU may be damaged by liquid Do not: Allow mud or other contaminants to cover the ECU Mud or other pollutants may cover the ECU and thus surface affect the heat dissipation Do not: Connect the additional power voltage to the ECU It may cause problems with ECU performance and even cause damage to the ECU Do not: Wash the ECU with solvents or corrosive liquids. It may cause damage to the ECU housing Ka b is n ra Please: ensure that water or large amounts of moisture should The ECU connector may be short-circuited, thus causing not drip or adhere to the ECU connector damage to the ECU Please: Clean the ECU with a damp cloth and dry it s o i r t It can prevent ECU from ibeing damaged m Di .A S NIS 21.6.6 ECU power supply requirements Power supply: If the battery voltage is greater than 6.3 volts, the ECU's power supply module can start the control chip, and this is automatically controlled by the ECU. Power range: The ECU can operate within the range of 9 to 16 volts of battery and ignition voltage. Shutdown: Shut down the ECU when its ignition voltage is below 6.2 volts. The ECU can enter the shutdown procedures and store important information in the ECU's A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 444 - a k -d memory. Restart: All outputs are set to a preset state during the restart process. The ECU can monitor itself in real time and automatically enter the restart when an internal error is detected. After restart, ECU will follow the normal procedures. Overvoltage: The ECU will not be permanently damaged if it is operated for 1 minute under the DC voltage of below 24V. Reverse voltage: The ECU will not be permanently damaged if it is operated for 1 minute under the DC inverse voltage of below 13V. 21.6.7 ECU temperature requirements Operating temperature: The ECU is able to work normally between minus 20 degrees Celsius and minus 85 degrees Celsius. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 445 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.7 Fuel Pump 21.7.1 Working of fuel pump The fuel pump assembly can provide the fuel whose gasoline pressure meets the system requirements at 250Kpa. It is installed at the bottom of tank to provide the required fuel oil to engine through the connecting pipes. ●Fuel pump: The electrical principle of electric fuel pump is that when the DC motor drives the turbine-type fuel pump to run, the fuel in the circumferential groove of turbine rotor will move at high speed along with the turbine rotor.Due to the action of high-speed centrifugal force, the fuel pressure at the outlet is increased, and at the same time, the high-speed rotating turbine generates a certain vacuum at the inlet of oil pump, so that the fuel is sucked from the inlet into the space of turbine blade.The differential pressure of fuel inlet and outlet may cause the fuel source to be continuously pumped to the outlet side and transmitted to the fuel line of system. The fuel transfer pressure generated by the fuel pump can be up to 250 kPa. ●Pressure regulating device: It is mechanical diaphragm type, and can be used to make pressure regulation to fuel pump device, so as to achieve the constant fuel pressure required by the system. 21.7.2Appearance of fuel pump a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 446 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.7.3 Fuel pump composition 21.7.4 Fuel pump label and logo fume pump assembly: Make it at fuel pump assembly installing plate in the form of label. Fuel pump: make engraved mark at fuel pump. Oil pressure regulator: make engraved mark on the shell. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 447 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.7.5 Working environment of fuel pump The fuel pump assembly needs to be installed at the bottom of fuel tank according to the requirements. The pump assembly is generally designed for only gasoline fuel and the fuel with a ethanol-gasoline fuel ratio of 22% Make sure that there is enough fuel in the fuel tank in the first operation of fuel pump assembly, and do not run it in the absence of oil. 21.7.6 Maintenance process of fuel pump: 21.7.6.1 Safety protection: When conducting maintenance operation for fuel system, care should be taken to ensure personal safety. Disconnect the negative electrode of storage battery of motorcycle. Smoking is prohibited and a “no smoking” sign should be placed near the operating area. Ensure that there is a fire extinguishing device. The operating environment is well ventilated and away from open flames. Wear safety goggles. To release fuel vapors in the fuel tank, open tank cover and refit it. There is still a high pressure in the fuel line after the engine stops running, then oil may be injected after disassembling or releasing fuel line. Refer to “Fuel Pressure Release Process” in this section. A small amount of fuel may flow out after disassembling fuel line, in order to avoid the risk, the blocking device at the fuel pipe should be used for blockage. After maintenance is completed, please ensure that the fuel line and clamp are properly installed. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 448 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d After maintenance is completed, check system oil leakage according to the provisions of “Fuel Leakage Check Process”. After maintenance is completed, connect the negative electrode of battery and ensure that there is sufficient fuel in the fuel tank when the fuel pump is running. 21.7.6.2 Fault diagnosis of fuel pump assembly Step 1 2 3 4 5 Operation Yes If you can hear that the fuel After ignition key is started, fuel pump will pump is running, please go to run for 3 seconds. Step IV directly. Disconnect the connector of fuel pump, and check whether the supply voltage of fuel Conduct Step III pump is within the range of 10-14V Supply 12V DC current to fuel pump. 1. Check the circuit from Ensure that there is sufficient oil in the tank, fuel pump to ECU; to prevent dry running of fuel pump 2. Check ECU Is fuel pump running? Check whether the front fuel supply pressure Fuel pump assembly is of nozzle is within the range of 220-270kpa running normally when engine is in idle running. 1. Check whether there is Use the oil pressure gauge to test whether the leakage at fuel pipe joint 2. Check fuel pump fuel hose pressure is lower than 220kpa 3. Check pressure regulator No If you cannot hear that the fuel pump is running, please conduct Step II. Check the power supply circuit of fuel pump 1. Check fuel pump harness 2. Check fuel pump Perform Step IV 1. Check whether the fuel filter is blocked 2. Check whether fuel pipe is bent and twisted 3. Check pressure regulator 21.7.6.3 Disassembly of fuel pump assembly: Refer to “Fuel Pressure Release Process” to release the fuel pressure in the fuel line. Disconnect the negative electrode line of storage battery. Disconnect fuel pump assembly harness connector. Remove the remaining fuel from the fuel tank and store it in a suitable container, to ensure safety and reduce contamination. Remove the connecting fuel hose to fuel pump assembly using spring compressor assembly Remove the fuel tank from the motorcycle. Do not invert the fuel tank, to avoid tank scratches and bumps. Affect fuel pump assembly mounting bolt. Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly from the fuel tank Be careful to not damage fuel pump filter screen. a b is n ra I N A .A S S R B A 21.7.6.4 Installation of fuel pump assembly: K E assembly Replace the sealing washer of fuelG pump R (Used washer may lead to fuelO leakage) E Lightly support the fuel pump strainer and carefully G put the fuel pump Y assembly into the tank. Avoid Ascreen of fuel pump. damaging the W filter Installation of fuel pump assembly: TOthe direction Arrange installing screw holes of fuel pump O M - 449 Y P CO im D - s o i r it Ka k -d assembly asymmetrically, and installed it in the specified direction. The pressure regulator should face the rear of fuel tank, and ensure that the installing surface of fuel tank is clean and flat. Install mounting bolts on the fuel pump assembly cover plate and tighten them evenly in the order indicated in the following figure. Installing torque of screw: 3- 4 Nm The fuel pump assembly should be secured with special bolts.It should be tightened according to specified tightening order and torque during the installation.Over torque an incorrect tightening order may cause washer deformation and thus result in leakage. Install the fuel tank on the motorcycle. Connect fuel pipe and fix it with a suitable clamp. Connect the fuel pump harness connector. Check for leaks according to “Fuel Leakage Check Process” before the operation of engine. 21.7.6.5 Fuel pressure release process: Precautions: Do not operate when the engine is in warning-up state. After confirming that the engine is in cooling state, conduct the following fuel pressure release operation: The motorcycle is in “neutral” state. Disconnect the connector between fuel pump assembly harness and motorcycle harness. Turn on motor to start engine until the engine is automatically extinguished. Then continuously turn on and off the ignition key for 2-3 times, with an internal of 3 seconds each time. After completing the above operations, connect the fuel pump assembly harness connector. a 21.7.6.6 Fuel leakage check process: After performing any fuel system maintenance, perform fuel leakage check test. Fill the tank with sufficient fuel. Turn on ignition key for 3 seconds, and then turn off it for 15 seconds, repeat the above operations for 3-4 times, to establish the oil pressure in the fuel line. Check whether there is leakage in the parts of fuel system (fuel tank, connecting pipes, pipe joint, etc.). 21.7.7 Note for use: Precautions b .A S S im D - s o i r it Ka I N A R B A K E RG Cause It may cause damage to the internal of fuel pump O E Do not: "dry run" fuel pump (there G is no oil at fuel Y pump inlet and filter screen) It may cause damage to the internal of fuel pump A W Please ensure thatO there is sufficient fuel in the tank T O M - 450 Y P CO Do not: throw or touch fuel pump is n ra k -d Do not: damage filter screen during the maintenance Impurities may go into the fuel pump from damaged filter screen and thus damage the fuel pump body Do not: disassemble the internal parts of fuel pump “Three guarantees” will not be provided after disassembly and pressure regulator Do not: regulate fuel pump and pressure regulator without permission (except replacement) Do not: lift fuel pump assembly through fuel pump assembly harness Harness is damaged / the power supply of fuel pump is Do not: lift fuel pump harness in the direction vertical disconnected to fuel pump cover plate Do not: use damaged pipe clamp Pressure leakage/fuel leakage Do not: use seriously damaged fuel pump filter screen Impurities may go into the fuel pump from damaged filter screen or cut fuel pump assembly and thus damage the fuel pump body Do not: pump oil from fuel tank using fuel pump Fuel pump is not designed for this purpose Do not: Install screws to fix other parts using fuel Affect fuel pump assembly installation pump assembly Do not: Damage fuel pump harness during the The terminal may be damaged and thus poor contact is caused / the maintenance of fuel pump assembly power supply of fuel pump is disconnected Do not: Contact fuel pump assembly when fuel Avoid damaging fuel pump assembly pumping oil from the tank manually Please: Ensure that the tank is not damaged during Avoid oil leakage maintenance Please: Only use “original” fuel pump assembly Fake washer may cause fuel leakage sealing washer Please: Use designated hose clamp Ensure that there is no fuel leakage and seepage at pipe joint Please: Fix fuel pump harness at motorcycle Reduce shock Please: Use standard fuel The fuel with poor quality may damage the fuel pump too early Please: Replace fuel filter within the specified time Blocked filter may reduce fuel supply Please: Use specified and qualified fuel filter Unqualified filter may damage nozzle, oil pressure regulator and fuel pump Please: Ensure to correctly arrange the ways of fuel Incorrect ways and interference may damage fuel pipe pipes and not interfere with other parts Please: Ensure that there is sufficient fuel in the tank Avoid “running in dry state” of fuel pump (submerge fuel pump filter) is n ra b Ka s o i r Please: During the pressure regulator maintenance, it curve of pressure regulator Ensure the correct pressure regulation m i replace two O rings simultaneously D Please: Take care to connect fuel pump assembly A of connector Avoid damaging the.terminal harness connector S IS Please: Return any collided , damaged and suspicious N EnsureA to quickly and correctly find the root cause of problem parts and describe the problems R B A K Warning: E G Because there is no gasoline in theRfuel tank of new O motorcycle at the beginning, aElot of air is generated at G fuel pipe, so it needs Y to start it for several times to A empty the air inW the fuel line, and then the engine can O work properly, T which is normal. Motorcycle will be O M - 451 Y P CO a k -d started easily in the future. Because gasoline can cool fuel pump, do not let fuel pump work little oil or no gasoline, which may burn fuel pump. 21.7.8 common problems a) The fuel pump assembly plug-in is reversed, which enables the fuel pump to reverse and fail to provide the engine with sufficient fuel pressure, resulting in engine failure. b) The fuel pump is damaged and fails to rotate. 21.7.9 Fault maintenance and diagnosis method The fault light is located on the meter panel with a FI mark below. Under normal circumstances, after the key is turned, if the fault light is on, it indicates that the electronic injection system is powered and it can work; if the fault light is off, it indicates that the electronic injection system circuit is disconnected, it will not work and the connection of positive and negative electrodes of fuse and battery should be checked. If the fault light is off after the engine is started, it indicates that there is no fault; on the contrary, if the fault light is still on after the engine is started, it indicates that the electronic injection system works abnormally and the fault should be removed if any. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 452 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.8 Throttle Body 21.8.1 Working principle of throttle body: The throttle body assembly is mainly composed of the following parts: main casting valve body, bearing, shaft and valve plate, return spring, throttle cable part, throttle position sensor system, idle stepper motor and by-pass flow control system. All of the above subsystems work together to meet the requirements for following functions: Intake flow control Control of air flow at idle speed Throttle position detection – provide throttle opening feedback signal for engine control system The throttle body position sensor provides the ECU with a throttle opening; the stepper motor on the throttle body controls the engine idle speed to be maintained near the target idle speed required by the ECU; 21.8.2 Appearance of throttle body: a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 453 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.8.3 Technical parameters 21.8.3.1 Throttle body: D37mm aperture 21.8.3.2 Throttle position sensor: The reference voltage is 5±0.1VDC Resistance between T1 and T2: 3kΩ - 12kΩ. 21.8.3.3 Idle air control valve: Operating voltage: 7.5~14.2 VDC Winding resistance: 53Ω ± 20% Winding inductance: 33mH ± 20% 21.8.4 Operating temperature of throttle Normal operating temperature: -30 ~120°C 21.8.5 Disassembly of throttle body a Turn off the power switch Disconnect the negative electrode line of storage battery. Disconnect the connectors on throttle position sensor, stepper motor, inlet temperature/pressure sensor (if installed on the throttle body assembly) Disassemble the throttle cable Disassemble the connecting hose between the air filter and intake manifold 21.8.6 Cleaning method of throttle b .A S S I N A R B A Clean throttle body using carburetor cleaner (3M product is recommended). Spray cleaner at the inner wall of throttle body, and gently remove dust and carbon deposit and other items using a brush. Be careful to prevent the bypass air duct from being blocked by dirt. K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 454 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.8.7 Installation of throttle body Note the followings for installing the throttle body: Adjust throttle wire Ensure that all moved parts have been installed properly, such as stepper motor assembly. Install the connecting screw properly 21.8.8 Note for the installation of throttle body Do not immerse the throttle position sensor in the liquid. Always use the throttle cable to open the valve plate. Do not insert tools or other items into the inside of the throttle body to maintain the opening of the valve plate. This may deform the valve plate or scratch the inner wall of throttle body. This damage may cause the valve to be extremely easy to open or difficult to open. 21.8.9 Note for the use of throttle body Precautions Cause Please: be careful to install the connectors of all throttle Avoid damage to wiring terminal. body Please: avoid any liquid from entering throttle body Make sure it works properly Please: Take out one throttle from the part tray and install it So as not to damage critical parts every time Please: send the falling, damaged parts or parts with suspected problems, and label to specify the existing Quickly confirm the cause of problem problems (only for the components within the scope of “three guarantees") Do not: use any dropped or squeezed parts May cause damage to the internal of parts Do not: store or transport near salt water without protection Corrosion may affect normal use Do not: expose it to the environment before the completion Corrosion may affect normal use of assembly (such as humid environment) Do not: test under non-system operating voltage It may cause damage Do not: use additional fixtures It may cause damage Do not: remove the packaging so that the parts may touch It may affect minimum air leakage or cause other damages each other Do not: release the throttle completely from any position It may cause damage Do not: block the bypass channel by dust or small particles It may affect idle speed stability Do not: pick up, store or hold parts in a manner that might It may cause damage come into collision with other parts. b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 455 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d 21.8.10 Idle speed stepper motor 21.8.10.1 Working principle of idle speed stepper motor The function of idle speed control valve is to control the flow area of bypass air passage of throttle body, so as to adjust the air volume of engine and control the idle speed of engine. 1.Valve plate 2.Intake manifold 4. Idle stepper motor 5. By-pass port 21.8.10.2 Appearance of idle speed stepper motor As shown below a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 456 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.8.10.3 Definition of pin Dust cover When the adjusting head is extended to the utmost, the adjusting head corresponds to , it can be moved from 0.44 to 2.00mm. Connector Position where it is fully retracted Working position 21.8.10.4 Characteristic parameters: Rated voltage: Maximum / minimum operating voltage: Resistance per roll (@27°C): Minimum resistance (@-40°C): Inductance per roll (@25°C): Stepping distance (step): Maximum stroke: Operating temperature range: Minimum storage temperature: Weight: 12Vdc 7.5Vdc/14Vdc 53±5.3 a 35 b 0.04167mm 8.5mm(204 steps) -40°Cto125°C(150°C peak value) -40°C 110 g .A S S I N A 21.8.10.5 Fault determination of idle stepper BR motor: A K E G R Before inspection, check whether the stepper motor 4 PIN (black) connector and ECU plug-in connector are loosened or improperly connected, and then check the flashing of malfunction indicator light. Check the stepper motor: Use multimeter to measure pins A and B respectively; Resistance between pin C and pin D Standard: 53±20%Ω at the air temperature of 20-30℃ O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra 33.5mH±6(1kHz) - 457 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.8.10.6 Inspection of circuit of idle speed stepper motor: Stepper motor A-J1-01 On NG: A+Open circuit Stepper motor B-J1-11 On NG:A-Open circuit Stepper C-J1-12 motor On NG:B+Open circuit Stepper D-J1-13 motor On NG:B-Open circuit 21.8.10.7 Cleaning The stepper motor assembly is integrated on the throttle valve body. When cleaning, first remove the stepper motor and clean it with a clean rag 21.8.10.8 Resetting of speed stepper motor The resetting method of the idle speed stepper motor is hereby explained: After the production and debugging of new motorcycle are finished, the debugger will take off the storage battery and wait for packing the vehicle. This will cause a sudden power down of the ECU and all self-learning of ECU (including self-learning of the stepper motor), result in the lost step of stepper motor and forget their current locations; after the storage battery is installed and powered on next time, the stepper motor will be in a “chaotic” state, thus resulting in instable idle speed, high or low idle speed. At this time, we need to reset the stepper motor. Method: after starting the motorcycle, turn off the key and wait for 15 seconds. Then turn on the key and start the motorcycle to check whether the stepper motor has returned to normal. If it has not returned to normal, repeat the resetting operation. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 458 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.9 Fuel injector 21.9.1 Working principle of fuel injector The injector is an actuator that injects the appropriate fuel into the engine inlet in a timely and accurate manner, and then inhales it into the combustion chamber and mix it with the oxygen in the filled fresh air for burning. The fuel injector should be replaced with that with the same part number only. 21.9.2 Appearance of fuel injector The appearance of fuel injector is shown in the right picture. O-ring seal connected to oil gauge or fuel injector cap O-ring seal connected to air inlet duct end a 21.9.3 Fuel injector seal ring As shown above, O-ring seal can ensure that leakage will not occur when fuel injector works within the range of -40°C -150°C (-40 -302°F), and it can resist various fuel additives (such as: ethyl alcohol). The following data is the existing sealing ring design. b 21.9.3.1 O-ring seal connected to oil rail or oil injection cap Dim .A S S • Size: •Inner diameter: 6.35 mm •Outer diameter: 14.85 mm •Section thickness: 4.25 mm I N A R B A K E pipe end 21.9.3.2 O-ring seal connected to Gintake • Size: •Inner diameter: 9.61 mm •Outer diameter: 14.49 mm •Section thickness: 2.44 mm Y A W R O GE O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 459 - - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.9.3.3 Recommended lubricants To facilitate the installation of fuel injector, lubricant should be applied at O-ring seal. The following table shows the list of usable lubricants. Tests show that the following lubricants do not have any impact on the fuel injector. List of recommended lubricants Name of lubricant Manufacturer Viscosity (cSt) @ 40 C Spindura 10 Spindura 22 DTE-24 DTE-25 DTE-26 Norpar 15 Drawsol 60 NocoLube AW 46 NocoLube AW 32 Advantage Spindle Oil Equilon Equilon Mobil Mobil Mobil Exxon / Mobil DA Stewart NOCO Energy NOCO Energy Advantage Lubrication Specialties 10 21 32 46 68 <1 1-2 46 32 10 21.9.4 Overvoltage Impact of fuel injector The fuel injector can run at the voltage of 24V and the working conditions of 100ms (pulse) and 200ms (one cycle time) for 1 minute at most (run with oil). It will not affect the flow rate, cause permanent damage to the solenoid coil or weaken the electromagnetic performance. 21.9.5 Temperature range of fuel injector: The standard injector operating temperature range is as follows. Within the qualified operating temperature range, the fuel injector flow is within the tolerance range and fault will not be caused. Meanwhile, in a reasonable operating environment, leakage, degradation or reduction of service life will not be caused to fuel injector. Operating temperature range: - 30 ~ 125 C Extreme operating range (may cause some functional degradation): - 40 ~ 150 C Storage temperature: -60 ~ 60 C a b 21.9.6 Fuel contaminants of fuel injector Although the fuel injector has a self-cleaning function, it is not a serviceable part, because it is designed to remove only the impurities with small diameter accumulated in the fuel line from the fuel filter to the injector. The impurities with large diameter may cause injector bonding, flow deviation and leakage and other faults, so fuel filter system is very important. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG is n ra EO G Y harness arrangement 21.9.7 Fuel injector A OW harness should be located away from The injector T O M - 460 Y P CO im D - s o i r it Ka k -d heat sources and the harness should be protected from external wear or damage. If not necessary, do not insert or remove the injector connector. 21.9.8 Note for Use of Fuel Injector Precautions Do not: Reuse the sea. If it needs to reuse it in special conditions, please carefully check whether the sealing ring is damaged before use. Do not: Immerse the end of nozzle in the lubricant. Do not: Operate it without load in the case of no oil pressure Do not: Make water go into the fuel way during leakage inspection. Do not: Apply force to the head of fuel injector during installation Do not: Strike fuel injector when installing it at intake pipe. Do not: Apply tension to connector. Do not: Use fuel injector that has fallen Do not: Store fuel injector, fuel rail or engine that has been loaded into fuel injector in an unprotected environment. Do not: Take fuel injector as a handle when lifting assembly parts. Do not: make parts be in touch with each other during storage. Do not: Parts are in contact with each other during transportation. Do not: Knock fuel injector for troubleshooting when an fault occurs. Do not: Replace the original fuel injector with one with the part number not recommended. Please: Pay special attention to protect sealing ring from being cut by the installing seal during the installation of fuel injector. Please: Use correct lubricant for installation, and immediately it into the installing hole after applying lubricating oil. Please: Add tests for the fuel injector whose needle valve is stuck or cannot be mounted. (Apply the pulse to fuel injector for less than 5 seconds using 9-15 V voltage). Please: Before assembling fuel injector, make an oil-free leak test to confirm that the needle valve of fuel injector has been mounted. Please: Prevent liquid from damaging fuel injector Please: Be careful to disassemble harness Please: Use recommended lubricant when installing connector. Please: Do not use the components that are dropped, damaged or whose materials have problem, and describe the problem using label. Cause Avoid leakage It may block spray hole. It may damage internal mechanical components. It may damage fuel injector. During the installation on nylon intake pipe, allow to apply force in the direction of 45 degrees It may cause fuel injector and sealing ring. It may cause intermittent power supply. It may be damaged. External environment may damage the electronic and mechanical parts of fuel injector. It may damage fuel injector. It may damage fuel injector. Collision may be caused and thus fuel injector may be damaged. It may damage fuel injector. It may seriously affect the performance of nozzle. a Protect sealing ring. Protect sealing ring, to reduce pollution. is n ra b Ka s o i r Confirm the fault form of fuel itinjector m i D It may prevent the needle valve of fuel injector forming Aoriginal position during the transportation returning to .the S and transfer IS process, thus resulting in fuel leakage N It may cause short circuit of solenoid coil RA O E G R E G Y A W B A K It may cause damage of terminal It may cause corrosion to terminal Ensure to quickly find the root cause of fault. O CO Y P T O M - 461 - k -d 21.9.9 Installation requirements for fuel injector During the installation and removal process, please strictly observe the following methods to avoid damage to the fuel injector body and electronic components. Lubrication: Apply a small amount of lubricant to the underside of the sealing ring. ISO 10 light mineral oil or equivalent product is recommended. When conditions allow, apply lubricant to the fuel injector seat, which is better than the effect of being applied the seal ring. So that the fuel injector contamination probability will be reduced to minimum. Do not allow the spray plate to come into contact with the lubricant, which may affect the injection quantity. Do not dip the top of the fuel injector to into the lubricant. All fuel injector sealing rings are factory assembled. In principle, the sealing seals should not be reused. Before reusing it in special conditions, please carefully check whether the sealing ring is damaged before use. Very small damage may cause leakage. Carefully insert the sealing ring into the installing seat during installation. When installing the fuel injector connector, take care not to damage the connector, and you can hear a click, indicating that it has been installed properly. Avoid unnecessary disassembly and assembly of connector. Harness should not be clamped too tightly, which may cause a short circuit. When installing the fuel injector connector, do not rotate the fuel injector. This may cause fuel injection target to shift. a 21.9.10 Replacement method of fuel injector The following is the disassembly and replacement method of fuel injector. Note: The injector and the surrounding objects are very hot. Turn off the motorcycle. Cut off the negative electrode of storage battery, to avoid accidentally starting the engine. Remove the fuel injector connector. Release the fuel pressure. Remove the fuel pipe from the fuel injector. Remove the fuel injector from the throttle valve body. Remove the fuel injector retainer and carefully remove the fuel injector from the seat ring. Carefully clean the impurities at the injector contact surface, and be careful not to damage the contact surface. Apply lubricant to the sealing rings on both ends of the new fuel injector. b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 462 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Carefully put the head of fuel injector into the intake pipe, and confirm that the installation direction is consistent with the original one. Press it in the fuel injector seat ring and secure the clamp. Install fuel injection hose. Insert the fuel injector connector. Power on the key, do not start the engine and check fuel injector for leakage. Start engine for running check. 21.9.11 Replaceability of fuel injector Only allow to replace the fuel injector with one with the same part number. 22.2.2.14 Blocking of fuel injector The accumulation of fuel impurities may cause flow offset and shorten fuel injector life. When the engine is standing, the heat of engine may produce fuel precipitation through the head of fuel injector, and the precipitation gathered in the injection hole may cause flow offset. Blockage may cause many problems, such as small flow, large friction and accumulation of impurities, and ultimately affect emissions and durability. Ultimately affect emissions and durability. Fuel and environmental factors may cause fuel crystallisation or fuel injector corrosion, which may also cause flow offset. Poor oxidation stability of fuel may cause precipitation, so please use high-quality gasoline. Add an appropriate amount of fuel cleaner to avoid precipitation. If fuel injector is blocked, please clean injector according to the following cleaning method. a b Warning: A filter is designed inside the fuel injector, but it is not a maintainable part, because its design function is to filter the accumulated impurities from the fuel filter in the oil line to the fuel injector only. Impurities can cause the cohesion, flow deviation, leakage and other faults of fuel injector, so the fuel filter is very significant. The fuel injector should be replaced with that with the same part number only. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 463 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.9.13 General failure mode and prevention and solving measures in using process Important note: All the following decisions are based on normal functions of motorcycle, wiring harness and other system parts. Block of fuel injector: Please clean the fuel injector by using special devices (such as ultrasonic wave) and special cleaning agent. Fuel leakage of fuel injector: Replace the fuel injector with that with the same part number or that specified by the motorcycle factory. Damage of electromagnetic coil: Please measure the resistance of electromagnetic coil of fuel injector with a multimeter. If the reading is about 12 (±5) Ohms, the electromagnetic coil of fuel injector is normal; if the coil resistance is infinite, it means that an open circuit fault has occurred to the coil. Bad Good Bad Atomization of oil atomizer a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 464 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.10 Intake pressure and temperature sensor 21.10.1 Working principles of inlet pressure and temperature sensor This sensor is used to measure the absolute pressure of air intake elbow, reflect the size of intake pressure according to the difference of resistance, and then calculate the intake volume in engine combustion chamber through indirect conversion, and it is also a non-serviceable part. It is used to measure the intake air temperature, its resistance will change with the intake air temperature and its characteristic is also the negative temperature coefficient resistance characteristic. It is also an irreparable part. 21.10.2Appearance of inlet pressure sensor See the right figure a 21.10.3 Working environment Operating pressure range: 20~115kPa Operating temperature range: -40~105°C Relative humidity: 0 - 100% RH. Extreme operating conditions: only 2 hours at maximum temperature of 125°C. b 21.10.4 Storage environment .A S S I N A Storage temperature: -50°C ~150°C 21.10.5 Electrical environment is n ra R B A K E G voltage of Typical voltage: The operating DC reference R sensor circuit is 5 ± 0.1 V. EO G Y A OW T O M - 465 Y P CO im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.10.5 Pin definition See the right figure 21.10.6 Appearance of inlet pressure sensor See the right figure Temperature sensor characteristic curve Temperature: ℃ Resistance value: Ω 21.10.7 Cleaning a If necessary, the sensor can be cleaned with isopropyl alcohol and then air dried. It should be soaked in isopropyl alcohol for not more than 1 minute, and sealing connector should be installed during cleaning to prevent cleaner from intruding into the sensor. b 21.10.8 Fault determination 1. 2. 3. 4. Check whether the plug-in is loose Check the fault or current data with a diagnostic instrument Check the connection between the sensor and ECU and check whether the abnormal operation of sensor is caused by cables Sensor inspection: connect it to the cable and turn on the power; measure the voltage between two pins with multimeter; Standard .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 466 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d The voltage is 4.0~ 4.65V under the atmospheric pressure of 100kPa when the equipment is not started. Otherwise, the sensor fails. 21.11 Oxygen sensor 21.11.1 Working principle of oxygen sensor Oxygen sensor can be used to detect the oxygen content in the waste gas of engine exhaust pipe for internal fuel closed loop control of ECU, thus maintaining engine combustion at the most reasonable state of air and fuel ratio (14.7). 21.11.2 Appearance of oxygen sensor See the right figure 21.11.2 Technical parameters a Partially thick limit of air-fuel ratio: >750mVDC Partially thin limit of air-fuel ratio: <120 mVDC Power of oxygen sensor heater: 7.0W (The above parameters are measured at engine bench, the working conditions: exhaust gas temperature: 450°C; duty cycle: 70%; 10Hz; voltage: 13.5V). The resistance of heater is: 9.6±1.5Ω (measured at 21°C) Operating temperature range: 260-850°C b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 467 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.11.3 Installation requirements Installation angle (angle with the horizontal plane): ≥10 degrees 21.11.4 Oxygen sensor pin definition: Connectors of oxygen sensor 1. Oxygen sensor heating control grounding 2. Oxygen sensor heating power supply 12V+ 3. Oxygen sensor signal - (OS-) a 4. Oxygen sensor signal+ (OS+) 21.11.5 Fault determination 1. 2. 3. b Conduct fault diagnosis with a diagnostic instrument and judge the fault type Check whether pins has fallen off Check the voltage between the sensor signal line and signal earth with a multimeter: Standard When the engine temperature is 80 degrees and the idle speed or constant speed is 3000 revolutions, 4000 revolutions or 5000 revolutions, the duration is more than 2 minutes.Measure whether the voltage at both ends changes between 0-1V constantly. Otherwise, the sensor fails. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 468 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.11.6 Characteristic curve a The oxygen sensor is located on the exhaust manifold. Please remove the oxygen sensor connector and then remove the oxygen sensor using open-end wrench. Be careful not to knot or twist the harness when disassembling. b 21.11.7 Requirements for fuel quality .A S S Pb≤0.005g/L P≤0.0002g/L S ≤ 0.04% (weight ratio) x MMT≤0.0085g/L Si≤4ppm I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 469 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.12 Temperature sensor of engine cylinder head 21.12.1 Working principle of temperature sensor of engine cylinder head The engine cylinder head temperature sensor is used in the air cooled engine to measure the temperature of engine cylinder head. Within the sensor temperature range, the resistance will change with the temperature of engine and the temperature characteristic is the negative temperature coefficient resistance characteristic. It is an irreparable part. 21.12.2 Appearance of temperature sensor of engine cylinder head See the right figure a 21.12.3 Working environment b The sensor is mainly used for air-cooled engine Normal operating temperature range: -40 -160°C (continuous work) Relative humidity at working environment: 0 ~ 100% Typical operating pressure: at minimum installation torque, the sensor is capable of sealing the engine coolant at an actual pressure of 206.8 kPa (30 psi) and a temperature of 135°C. Extreme working conditions: only 1 hour at maximum temperature of 160°C. .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 470 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.12.4 Electrical environment Typical working voltage: The reference voltage is 5±0.1VDC Maximum excitation current: During the characteristic test and calibration of the sensor under any temperature, the performance of the sensor should not be affected by the current of less than 1mA. 21.12.5 Fault Determination and Characteristic of Output Resistor Fault performance: This will have a large impact on start-up, because the ECU cannot monitor the temperature of engine or achieve accurate fuel injection. General faults are caused by the looseness of connection plug-in or the falling of the pin on the plug-in. The sensor can only be replaced with that of the same model. Internal resistance measurement: disconnect it from the cable; measure the resistance between pin 1 and pin 2 with multimeter (as shown in the figure) Standard: 25℃: 1.9-2.1KΩ 100℃:0.179~0.187KΩ Otherwise, the sensor fails. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 471 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.13 Canister solenoid valve (ECP) 21.13.1 Overview of working principle The canister solenoid valve is used to prevent the fuel vapor in the canister from entering the engine intake system and burning it in the engine. This can reduce fuel evaporative emissions. 21.13.2 Appearance The appearance of canister solenoid valve is as shown in the right figure: 21.13.3 Pin of ECP solenoid valve The connection method is as follows a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 472 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Charcoal canister interface Inlet manifold connector Electric interface The electromagnetic switch is always closed 21.13.4 Technical parameters Flow (standard L/min) Normal operating voltage: 8-16V VDC Operating temperature: -40~120°C Operating frequency: 16 Hz Maximum flow rate: 25-35L/min The flow curve is shown in the figure below: a b .A S S I N A Duty cycle (%) R B A 21.13.5 Installation requirements EK G R O The canister solenoid valve should be installed horizontally on the motorcycle The canister solenoid valve should be installed close to the central axis of crankshaft to reduce vibration E G Y A W O CO Y P is n ra T O M - 473 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.14 Ignition coil 21.14.1Appearance of ignition coil: 21.14.2 Fault description: Fault performance: If spark plug do not ignite or intermittently ignites, engine cannot work If the ignition coil fails and thus the spark plug does not ignite, the ECU will turn off the injection of corresponding cylinder, ie, do no inject fuel. If the high-voltage wire on the ignition coil is damaged, electrical leakage or poor ignition may be caused. Please check: whether the signal grounding from the ECUJ2-01 pin to ignition coil is conductive, and whether the connection from the output terminal of relay to the positive terminal of ignition coil is conductive. a b is n ra I N A .A S S im D - s o i r it R B A method of EFI system 21.15 Fault maintenance and diagnosis K E G ORusing the flashing fault lamp at meter 21.15.1 Diagnosis directly E G Y Alocated on the meter panel with a The fault light [A] is W mark below. Under TO normal circumstances, after the key is O M - 474 Y P CO Ka k -d turned, if the fault light is on, it indicates that the electronic injection system is powered and it can work; if the fault light is off, it indicates that the electronic injection system circuit is disconnected, it will not work and the connection of positive and negative electrodes of fuse and battery should be checked. If the fault light is off after the engine is started, it indicates that there is no fault; on the contrary, if the fault light is still on after the engine is started, it indicates that the electronic injection system works abnormally and the fault should be removed if any. In the case that a fault is confirmed, after opening and closing the key for 3 times, namely the operation of opening---closing--- opening---closing –opening key, the fault lamp will flash the flash code of corresponding fault. Then, corresponding fault can be identified through fault code table. Of them, when using the method to read fault using fault lamp, the flash code rule is as follows: for example, the fault is the open circuit of intake pressure sensor or short circuit of signal terminal pin to the negative electrode of storage battery, the fault lamp will flash for 10 times to represent 0, flash for 1 time to represent 1 after 1.2 seconds, flash for 10 times to represent 0 after 1.2 seconds, flash for 7 times to represent 7 after 1.2 seconds, namely P0107. It can be seen that except that number 0 is represented by flashing for 10 times, numbers 1-9 correspond to the times of flashing. If there are other fault codes, such as fault P0201, there is fault in the fuel injector of cylinder 1. After flashing P0107, wait for 3.2 seconds, continue to flash P0201 fault code; if there is no other fault, it will flash P0107 and P0201 cyclically. Then, relevant faults can be queried according to fault code table. When using PCHUD software, the software will report fault code using decimal numbers. In fault code table, there is an one-to-one correspondence relationship between decimal numbers and previous hexadecimal numbers, and thus corresponding faults may be found according to the correspondence relationship. For example, MULFCURR (current fault) = 263 in the software, it corresponds to P0107 in fault code table, namely intake pressure sensor fault. a b K E RG O O CO Y P T O M .A S S I N A R B A E G Y A W is n ra - 475 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d ●MT05 Fault Code Table (Remark: All fault display functions of Delphi are listed in the fault code table. If this model does not have the corresponding function, please ignore it.) DTC System or Component DTC Description Related Calibration P0107 MAP Circuit Low Voltage or Open KsDGDM_MAP_ShortLow Sensor (MAP) P0108 MAP Circuit High Voltage KsDGDM_MAP_ShortHigh Intake Air Temperature Sensor P0112 IAT Circuit Low Voltage KsDGDM_IAT_ShortLow (IAT) P0113 IAT Circuit High Voltage or Open KsDGDM_IAT_ShortHigh anifold Absolute Number Pressure P0117 Coolant/Oil Sensor P0118 Coolant/Oil Temperature Sensor Circuit Low Voltage Coolant/Oil Temperature Sensor Circuit High Voltage or Open KsDGDM_CoolantShortLow KsDGDM_CoolantShortHigh P0122 TPS Circuit Low Voltage or Open KsDGDM_TPS_ShortLow P0123 TPS Circuit High Voltage KsDGDM_TPS_ShortHigh P0131 O2S 1 Circuit Low Voltage KsDGDM_O2_1_ShortLow P0132 O2S 1 Circuit High Voltage KsDGDM_O2_1_ShortHigh P0031 O2S Heater Circuit High Voltage KsDGDM_O2_HeaterShortHigh P0032 O2S Heater Circuit Low Voltage KsDGDM_O2_HeaterShortLow Fuel Injector A P0201 Injector A Fault Fuel Injector B P0202 Injector B Fault P0230 FPR Coil Circuit Low Voltage or Open KsDGDM_FPP_CircuitShortLow P0232 FPR Coil Circuit High Voltage KsDGDM_FPP_CircuitShortHigh P0336 CKP Sensor Noisy Signal KsDGDM_CrankNoisySignal (CKP) P0337 CKP Sensor No Signal Ignition Coil A P0351 Cylinder A Ignition Coil fault Ignition Coil B P0352 Cylinder B Ignition Coil fault Idle Control System P0505 Idle Speed Control Error P0562 System Voltage Low P0563 System Voltage High P0650 MIL Circuit Malfunction KsDGDM_MIL_Circuit P1693 Tachometer Circuit Low Voltage KsDGDM_TAC_Circuit_Low Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) Oxygen Sensor Oxygen Sensor Heater Fuel Pump Relay (FPR) Crankshaft Position System Voltage MIL Oxygen Sensor 2 Oxygen Sensor Heater 2 O OT P O C h KsDGDM_INJ_CYL_B_FaultHig h .A S S I N A R B A K E P1694 G Tachometer Circuit High Voltage OR O2S 2 Circuit Low Voltage P0137 E GP0138 O2S 2 Circuit High Voltage Y A W Tachometer M Y Sensor KsDGDM_INJ_CYL_A_FaultHig P0038 O2S Heater 2 Circuit High Voltage - 476 - is n ra ab K KsDGDM_EST_A_Fault s o i r KsDGDM_EST_B_Fault it m Di KsDGDM_IdleControl KsDGDM_CrankNoSignal - KsDGDM_SysVoltLow KsDGDM_SysVoltHigh KsDGDM_TAC_Circuit_High KsDGDM_O2_2_ShortLow KsDGDM_O2_2_ShortHigh KsDGDM_O2_HeaterShortHigh a k -d P0037 O2S Heater 2 Circuit Low Voltage KsDGDM_O2_HeaterShortLow Vehicle Speed Sensor P0500 VSS No Signal KsDGDM_VSS_NoSignal Park Neutral Switch Diag P0850 Park Neutral Switch Error KsDGDM_ParkNeutralSwitch P0445 CCP short to high KsDGDM_CCP_CircuitShortHigh P0444 CCP short to low/open KsDGDM_CCP_CircuitShortLow Rollover Sensor Diagnostic P1500 Rollover Sensor malfunction/Triggered KsDGDM_RolloverSensor BLM_MaxAdapt P0171 Several BLM value hit maximum KsFDIAG_BLM_MaxAdapt BLM_MinAdapt P0172 Several BLM value hit minimum KsFDIAG_BLM_MinAdapt PESystLean P0174 PE mode burned AFR keeps lean KsFDIAG_PESystLean CCP a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 477 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.15.2 Diagnose fault using diagnostic apparatus ●Diagnostic apparatus ●Operation method: a) Find the diagnose interface [A] at motorcycle; b) connect connecting wire and diagnostic apparatus interface; c) Open the key for diagnosis; Warning The XCM-PT100X diagnostic apparatus is a high-precision instrument that should be protected from shock and vibration; If the apparatus is not working properly or the display is unstable after it is turned on for the first time, please disconnect the power cable and try again; Please ensure that the connector is always fastened in the diagnostic connector; It is strictly forbidden to test the electrical signals that exceed the limit; It is strictly forbidden for the driver to operate the instrument during driving; Use and storage conditions: Environment temperature: 0~50 degrees Celsius Relative humidity: less than 90% a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 478 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.15.3 Inspection of fault using diagnostic software PCHUD PCHUD software is used to detect and record engine operating data, laptop should be connected to 6-port diagnostic port of motorcycle through K line before use, and the diagnosis port is below the rear seat cushion. Please note that the PCHUD system only supports 16Bit Microsoft Windows operating system or a very small number of 32bit Windows operating systems. It does not support 64bit systems such as Win7, Win8 or iOS. It is necessary to install K-line driver software on the notebook before use. ●Operating Instructions for PCHUD Software: (1) Connect laptop and 6-hole diagnostic port of motorcycle using K line and open the key; (2) Click “HUD.EXE” icon and start PCHUD software; (3) Select “File” in the software interface, click “open” to select “PCHUD.HAD”, and then click “OK” for confirmation. a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG (4) Select “Parameter File” under “Setup”, click MT05common.par file, select “Comm protocol under “Setup”, select “Keyword2000” and then click OK, at the same time select 17 as the Device Code. O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 479 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d (5) If the software interface cannot display the real-time communications data, it needs to conduct the following work: check whether there is problem in COM port connection setting under “Setup”, generally set COM Port: 4. Baud Rate:10400, and do not select DTR High at startup a b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG EO G And then conduct normal Y communications, display the current A fault code at MALFCURR, W and display historical fault code at O MALFHIST. T O M - 480 Y P CO im D - s o i r it Ka k -d And then query the corresponding fault according to fault code table. ●PCHUD Software Parameter Interpretation: VRPM Engine speed engine speed VTHROT Throttle opening throttle position VBARO Atmospheric pressure BARO Intake manifold pressure manifold air pressure Estimated value of intake manifold pressure expect manifold air pressure Storage battery voltage ignition key voltage Temperature of cylinder temperature or coolant cylinder temperature or coolant temperature Intake temperature intake air temperature Status flag 5 STATUSBYTE5 Airflow learning conditions are met airflow correction met VBAROCMET Atmospheric pressure updating conditions are met Baro update met VCSINSYNSPR K Sequential ignition flag sequential spark enable tip-in ignition angle correction conditions are met tip-in Spark Advance retard trigger Catalyst work logic is enabled catalyst light-off logic enable Normal working flag position of engine engine work in run state VMAP VMAPEXP VIGN VCLTS VIAT STATUSBYTE5 VAFCMET SATITRIG CATLOENB IF ENGSTATE=3 NISTBLIDLE FCNO Long-term learning unit of intake efficiency block learn memory cell Long-term learning value of cylinder cylinder 1 block learn memory FCLCINT1 Item I of closed loop learning integral of close loop correction FCLCMUL1 Correction of closed loop learning close loop correction IARDRPM Rotating sped of desired idle speed desired idle rpm IARPMERR Deviation of idle speed idle rpm error Fuel injection pulse width of cylinder base pulse width of cylinder 1 Oxygen sensor signal Oxygen sensor signal Status flag 3 STATUSBYTE3 FO2STAT1 Concentration mark of oxygen sensor of cylinder cylinder 1 oxygen sensor signal rich lean state FCLREST1 Correction and resetting mark of closed loop of cylinder 1 close loop correction reset cylinder FOSHTREN Oxygen sensor heater is enabled FO2REDY1 Heating completion mark of oxygen sensor of cylinder 1 Oxygen sensor ready cylinder FBLMCOR1 FPWVC1 VO2 STATUSBYTE3 IF IACV MODE=0 IACMVIHB VIGNS FVE1 Y P im D - s o i r it a is n ra b Ka A sensor heater enable .Oxygen S S I N A R B A Closed loop learning of idle speed stepper motor is idle airflow control valve close loop correction enabled enable IAMTRLOST CO The idle speed conditions for warming up machine stable warm idle are met K E G Lost step flag position of idle speed stepper motor R O Flag positionE where the movement of idle speed G stepperY motor is disabled A Ignition state flag position W MO TOCylinder filling efficiency - 481 - IACV lost IACV move disable ignition state cylinder 1 Volumetric efficiency k -d VMAPRANG Intake pressure reading angle MAP read angle Target air fuel ratio target air fuel ratio Ignition advance angle of cylinder cylinder 1 Spark Advance SAIDLDYN Dynamic ignition angle at idle speed idle dynamic Spark Advance SPDWELL Magnetizing time dwell time Airflow learning value of idle speed stepper motor airflow integral of idle air control valve Number of desired steps of idle speed stepper motor desired position of idle air control valve Status flag 2 STATUSBYTE2 FCLCEN1 Closed loop correction of cylinder is enabled cylinder 1 close loop correction enable PPDSEBL Flag position where pilot injection is disabled prime pulse disable FPENABL Flag position where fuel pump is enabled fuel pump enable FTRNSAES Acceleration and enriching are enabled acceleration enrich enter FTRNSDES Deceleration and thinning are enabled deceleration enlean enter FTRNSAEDCLO AD Acceleration and enriching exit acceleration enrich exit FTRNSDEINLO AD Deceleration and thinning exit deceleration enlean exit AFFNLAFR SAESTA IAINTEGOFST IACVDSMP STATUSBYTE2 ●Diagnosis process: 1.Insert the key on vehicle and do not start the motorcycle, please check: Parameter Check and Record Min Max Description Units VIGN □Norm □Abnormal 11.5 14.6 battery voltage volt VTHROT □Norm □Abnormal 0 1 fully closed throttle position percent VTHROT □Norm □Abnormal 98 100 fully open throttle position percent VTHROTRAW □Norm □Abnormal 4000 9000 Absolutely throttle body voltage AD None VBARO □Norm □Abnormal 98 103 atmospheric pressure kpa VIAT □Norm □Abnormal -15 40 intake air temperature degC VCLTS □Norm □Abnormal -15 40 cylinder temperature or coolant temperature degC Parameter Check and Record Min Max Description Start □Norm □Abnormal - - TERRCNT □Norm □Abnormal 0 0 FUELCOFF □Norm □Abnormal 0 0 VRLVENBL □Norm □Abnormal 0 s o i r it counter Fly wheel tooth error m i Dthe fuel cut-off enable, normal flag is white, if A . not blue S S I sensor enable, normal is white, if not NRollover is n ra 2.Starting: - A 0 K E RG R B A blue b Ka Units count None None 3. Idle The parameters can be checked 1 min for idle speed after vehicle starting. And then check the stability of EFI parameter after 3 minutes of long idle. EO G □Norm Y□Abnormal A W Parameter VRPM VTHROT O OT P O C M Y Check and Record □Norm □Abnormal Min Max Description Units 1300 1700 engine speed rpm 0 1 fully closed throttle position percent - 482 - a k -d MALFCURR □Norm □Abnormal 0 0 current MALF code None VBARO □Norm □Abnormal 98 103 atmospheric pressure kpa VMAP □Norm □Abnormal 47 53 intake pressure measured value kpa VIGN □Norm □Abnormal 12 16 battery voltage volt PNSWTCH □Norm □Abnormal 0 0 Neutral and Clutch switch enable flag, blue is working None IACVDSMP □Norm □Abnormal 10 80 stepping motor target value step vehicle speed □Norm □Abnormal 0 0 vehicle speed Km/h FBLMCOR1 □Norm □Abnormal 0.75 1.15 cylinder 1 block learn memory factor FBLMCOR2 □Norm □Abnormal 0.75 1.15 cylinder 2 block learn memory factor FCLCINT1 □Norm □Abnormal -15 15 cylinder 1 integral of lose loop correction count FPWVC1 □Norm □Abnormal 1.5 2.8 base pulse width of cylinder 1 ms VO2 □Norm □Abnormal 45 850 cylinder 1 oxygen sensor voltage mv VO2B □Norm □Abnormal 45 850 cylinder 2 oxygen sensor voltage mv Min Max Description Units 4. Run with stable speed Parameter Check and Record MALFCURR □Norm □Abnormal 0 0 current MALF code None VCLTS □Norm □Abnormal 40 105 cylinder temperature or coolant temperature degC VIGN □Norm □Abnormal 12 16 battery voltage volt FBLMCOR1 □Norm □Abnormal 0.75 1.15 cylinder 1 block learn memory factor FCLCINT1 □Norm □Abnormal -15 15 cylinder 1 integral of lose loop correction count VO2 □Norm □Abnormal 45 850 cylinder 1 oxygen sensor voltage mv 5. Top speed with full throttle(PE mode, power enrich) PE mode : 70% < VTHROT < 100%, in this situation,the value of oxygen sensor(VO2 VO2B) is around 800mv. Ka Parameter Check and Record Min Max Description VCLTS □Norm □Abnormal 80 105 cylinder temperature or coolant temperature VIGN □Norm □Abnormal 12 16 battery voltage volt VO2 □Norm □Abnormal 750 950 cylinder 1 oxygen sensor voltage mv .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO b is n ra Y P T O M - 483 - im D - s o i r it Units degC a k -d 21.16 Common troubleshooting methods for electronic fuel inject system 21.16.1 Maintenance tool a) Disassembly and assembly of electronic control system components - common automotive mechanical parts removal tool b) Electronic control system circuit and system electrical signal - digital multimeter (with buzzer) Electric control system fault diagnosis and engine working condition detection c) Electronic control system fault diagnostic apparatus (recommended) Fault diagnosis software (PCHUD) and interface connection (conditional use) d) Electronic control system fault code table (emergency use) e) Fuel pressure gauge, range: 0-300kP 21.16.2Engine Working Data Flow Displayed by Diagnostic Apparatus Analyze and determine engine fault using the engine working data flow displayed by the diagnostic apparatus. 21.16.2.1 Step I a) Engine harness and the vacuum pipeline—may affect the system to control air flow and fuel supply b) Whether oxygen sensor is assembled in place—may affect the system to determine the air to fuel ratio c) Engine fault indicator—may affect the system to give an alarm for fault d) Storage battery voltage—determine whether the power of storage battery is sufficient e) Determine whether coolant temperature sensor, intake temperature sensor, intake manifold absolute pressure sensor and oxygen sensor display value are normal f) a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG Working range of throttle position sensor—it cannot be fully opened or closed, which may affect engine power performance and some system functions O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 484 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.16.2.2 Step II Check whether ECU power is turned off—the communications between diagnostic apparatus and system is interrupted after turning off key switch 21.16.2.3 Step III a) Storage battery voltage (14V) —Indicate whether the generator is working properly. Too high: there may be fault in voltage regulator; Too low: there may be improper connection of generator or generator fault b) Intake manifold pressure—it can predict whether there is leakage in intake and valve clearance problems. Valve clearance is too small: this value is too high, so engine power performance may be affected; in addition, due to too early opening of exhaust valve and increase in exhaust temperature, oxygen sensor and three-way catalytic converter service life may be significantly shortened; Valve clearance is too large: it may cause low intake manifold pressure, and thus affect the system to determine the working state of engine, thus resulting in abnormal idle speed during warm-up of motorcycle. In addition, if the exhaust system is blocked, for example: a foreign body exists in the outlet; the oil consumption is too high, thus blocking three-way catalytic converter; three-way catalytic converter is blocked due to internal damage, which will cause slightly high value. c) a b Number of cycles of oxygen sensor value—the number of cycles is too small, indicating fault of oxygen sensor .A S S 21.16.3 Simple troubleshooting I N A R B A Please follow the following steps to repair EFI system. To repair fault in one step, the subsequent steps may be stopped. And then use diagnostic apparatus to conduct inspection and acceptance and clear fault code according to “Engine Working Data Flow Displayed by Diagnostic Apparatus”. K E RG O E G Y A W O T O M When using diagnostic apparatus, the voltage of CO Y P is n ra - 485 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d storage battery should not be lower than 8.5 V. 21.16.3.1 Daily use and maintenance Gasoline should be high quality without lead. ECU has a moisture-proof function, but high-pressure water gun should not be used to rinse its shell. The petrol filter should be changed every 18000km. Under normal conditions of use, clean the throttle body every 10,000 km or 1 year. 21.16.3.2 Fault phenomenon-Start fault a) Rotate ignition switch to “On” position, and check whether engine fault lamp is on. If it is off: It is be able to be on: b) Check fuse and grounding wire Check whether connected firmly It is able to check whether this lamp and line is normal using the check function of diagnostic apparatus actuator Check and repair bulb and its line Connect diagnostic apparatus system diagnosis interface ECU plug is to Check whether diagnostic apparatus can be connected to system for communications If not: c) Check fuse and grounding wire Check whether connected firmly Test whether diagnostic apparatus is working normally at another normal motorcycle If yes: a ECU Remove the fault diagnostic apparatus plug indicated is b by .A S S Check ignition system fault—whether normal ignition can be made for spark plug K E G Use another ignitionR coil for assembly EO judgment G Y ECU Judge using A W OCheck whether high-voltage line is T O connected to ignition coil and spark If not: If yes: M Y P O C I N A R B A Check whether high-voltage line and spark plug are plugged firmly or damaged is n ra - 486 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d plug properly d) Check oil supply system fault Check whether fuel pump is working—it is able to hear the sound that the fuel pump is working near the fuel tank when starting engine Check whether fuel pump relay is working normally Check whether the connection and working of crankshaft position sensor is normal Judge using ECU Check fuel pump line Not work: 1) Check whether fuel supply pressure is greater than 220Kpa 2) Insufficie nt pressure: Check whether there is sufficient fuel in the fuel tank Check whether fuel filter needs to be replaced (note: replace the fuel filter special for electronic injection should be replaced once every 18000km) Check whether fuel supply pipe and fuel return pipe are damaged Be able to work: 3) Normal pressure: e) Check whether there is any abnormality in nozzle control line Check whether nozzle needs to be cleaned After completely opening the throttle and turning on starting motor, there should be working sign in engine after several seconds If yes: .A S S I N A R B A K E RG Check whether crankshaft position sensor clearance is too large O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra b Confirm whether cylinder is submerged f) a - 487 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d 21.16.3.3 Fault phenomenon—Start failure with tempering a) Check whether ignition coil is loosened; b) Check whether timing gear ring is loosened. 21.16.3.4 Fault phenomenon—Instable idle speed Idle control system: Check whether the idle bypass bolt is loose Oil supply system: Check whether there is leakage in oil pipeline 21.16.3.5 Fault phenomenon—Too high or too low idle speed (idle speed is obviously inconsistent with target idle speed) When the water temperature is lower than 68 degrees, the system will increase idle speed to accelerate warming-up process, which is normal phenomenon. Check the items according to the following items except that Adjust the negative pressure balance of cylinder before check Check whether valve clearance, especially exhaust valve clearance is too large Too high idle speed: Too low idle speed: Check fuel quantity in fuel tank, fuel filter, fuel line pressure and nozzle Checking valve clearance and confirm whether it is too small a is n ra b s o i r it Ka 21.16.3.6 Fault phenomenon—Instable idle speed with deceleration im and flameout D A a) Checking valve clearance; b) Check whether idle speed bypass hole and throttle body are too dirt. . S S I N A R B A K power of deceleration 21.16.3.7 Fault phenomenon—Insufficient E G R EO G Y A b) Check fuel quantity in the W fuel tank and fuel filter; O c) Check whether T exhaust system is blocked, for O M Y P CO a) Check whether the parameters are normal at idle speed and high idle speed; - 488 - k -d example: whether three-way catalytic converter is blocked by burning oil or damage; d) Check fuel line pressure and nozzle; e) Check whether fault lamp is on, and whether normal ignition can be conducted for only one cylinder. 21.16.3.8 Fault phenomenon—Slight burning phenomenon Check whether the spark plug clearance meets specification of 0.6-0.7mm 21.16.3.9 Fault phenomenon—Fault lamp is on, but fault code is inconsistent with fault It may be caused due to instable connection of system grounding wire, reconnect the grounding wire, disconnect the power cable of battery for 3 minutes and then start the engine. 21.16.3.10 Fault phenomenon—Extremely high fuel consumption a) Check whether the oxygen sensors of two cylinders are assembled in place; if it is in the loose state, the oxygen sensor may incorrectly judge that the combustion in the cylinder is thin, and then increase fuel, which may result in unusually high fuel consumption. b) After confirming that the engine mechanical parts and oxygen sensor are in normal conditions, run the engine to observe the oxygen sensor reading. If the reading is always greater than 500 mV at normal water temperature, check whether there is leakage in fuel injector. a b Precautions CO The vast majority of EFI parts cannot be repaired; after the confirmation of damaged parts, generally replacement is taken. When starting the engine, do not operate any mechanism (including the throttle, do not pull the throttle for start) on the engine. is n ra I N A .A S S R B If engine fault lamp becomes on during the A engine K operation, cause must be checked and E eliminated as G soon as possible. OR E Do not use leaded gasoline, Gbecause lead may damage Y the oxygen sensor and Athree-way catalytic converter. W If oil consumption O is abnormal, the problem should be T resolvedOas soon as possible, because some of the M - 489 PY im D - s o i r it Ka k -d substances in the oil may damage the oxygen sensor and three-way catalytic converter. Valve clearance should not be too small, if the exhaust valve is not shut off tightly, exhaust temperature may become too high and thus shorten the life of three-way catalytic converter. At the temperature of below 10°C, if the vehicle and engine run at low speed for a long time, the exhaust pipe may have carbon deposition and become black, which is a normal phenomenon. It will be eliminated after a period of high-speed operation, or appropriate means should be taken to keep the engine coolant temperature within the specified temperature range. 21.16.4 Fault diagnosis instructions for Delphi Requirements of latest regulations of the fourth phase of EU and China National IV Motorcycle: the motorcycle with electronic fuel injection system must be equipped with OBD2 fault diagnosis system, namely: 1. When the motorcycle is started, the power fault light must be on. If there is no fault after start, the fault light will go out; if there is any fault, the fault light will be on. 2. If the motorcycle has experienced a historical fault (electric spray failed during assembly, debugging or riding, but it has returned to normal), fault light must be on after start, but it can only go out after 4 working cycles; at this time, historical faults cannot be detected using diagnostic apparatus, and no fault code can be read. The processing method is now described as follows: If the fault light is on, but no fault code can be read using diagnostic apparatus, it can be determined as historical fault. The method to remove historical fault is as follows: Delphi system resetting method: start the motorcycle and keep it at idle speed for 30 seconds, wait for 15 seconds after closing the key, and then quickly opening and closing the key for more than 5 times (the time interval should not exceed 1 second), the last operation is to turn off the power, wait for 15 seconds and then start to see whether the fault light is on. If the fault light is still on, repeat the resetting operation. a b .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M is n ra - 490 - im D - s o i r it Ka k -d Sample of diagnostic table Registration number plate number): Engine number: Name of rider: (license First registration year: Model: Frame number: Date of fault: Mileage: Environment where the fault occurs Weather □ Sunny □ Cloudy □ Rainy □ Snowy □ General □ Others: temperature □Hot □Warm □Cold □Very cold □General □Others: Frequency of fault □Usual □Frequent □Only once Road conditions □Street □Road □Mountain road (□ Uphill, □ Downhill) □ Rugged road □ Gravel road Altitude □Normal □High altitude (about 1000 m or above) The state of the motorcycle in the event of fault □ After the electric door lock is turned on for about 3 seconds, the FI warning message and the FI warning sign (EFI system failure) are alternately displayed on the LCD. Alarm indicator □ After the electric door lock is turned on for 3 seconds, the FI flashing burglar alarm system warning light (LED) message and sign are displayed on the LCD screen (anti-burglar control system is faulty). □ After the electric door lock is turned on for 3 seconds, the alarm light will go out. □The starter motor does not run. □ The starter motor rotates but the engine does not start. □ The starter motor and engine are not started. It is difficult to □Unable to supply oil (□ no fuel in the fuel tank, no running sound of fuel pump). start □ Submerge cylinder (Do not open the throttle valve when starting to avoid submerging the cylinder). □The spark plug cannot work properly. □Other: □ It will flame out after start. □ It will flame out after turning on the throttle. □ It will flame out after turning off the throttle. Flame-out of engine □ It will flame out when moving the motorcycle. □ It will flame out after stopping the motorcycle. □ It will flame out when running at a constant speed. □Other: □ The idle speed is very low, □ the idle speed is very high, □ and the idle speed is unstable. □ The battery voltage is low (test after charging). □ The spark plug is loose (tighten the spark plug). □ The spark plug is dirty, broken or the gap is improper (corrected). □ Tempering. It cannot run □Blasting. properly at a low □It is sluggish when accelerating. speed □ The oil viscosity is too high. □ Brake drags. □Engine overheating □The clutch is slipping □Other: □ The spark plug is loose (tighten the spark plug). □ The spark plug is dirty, broken or the gap is improper (corrected). □ The spark plug model is improper (replace it). □ Deflagration (poor or improper oil quality, replace it using the gasoline with high-octane rating). The acceleration is □ Brake drags. sluggish □The clutch is slipping □Engine overheating □ There is a lot of oil. □ The oil viscosity is too high. □Other: b is n ra .A S S I N A R B A K E RG O E G Y A W O CO Y P T O M - 491 - im D - s o i r it Ka a k -d Diode Main relay Fuel pump Ignition ECU Front brake switch R 15A 10A 15A 15A 15A 10A B/Y 1L Meter unit 1L LR R/W R R R R N G/Gr G/Y BL/B Gr/G LR LR M LR P/Y R LG/W P N/B G/Gr P/W R/W B 1R 2R 1R 2L Side stand Rear switch Rear wheel brake Flasher speed switch sensor Front wheel speed sensor N/O Y/Gr B 2R 2L LR/W Gr/R O N/P R/W P/Y LG O LBL R/W LR/BL BL G/B G/W R/W R/W G/B B/Y G/W P R/W Y/R Y/P P/N W/Y Gr/Y b Right R/W Starter circuit switch relay housing Left switch housing Ignition Fuse switch ABS 40A switch Y/R Gr O R/W Gr B G/W B LBL R/W BL B G/B B Clutch switch Y/W R/LBL B B G/W B G/B R/W BL/G R/W Gr/G LR/BL G/BL O Yellow Y Red R Rear left turn signal lamp Pink LR White W Purple P Gray Gr LIGHT GREEN LG Tail /Brake lamp License plate lamp B G R O GE Y/W BL/B R/B R/W B G N B/N G/P N/R LR B N R/W B O/B R/LBL BL/G Gr/Y W W W R W B B R R/BL B/N R/B R/W LR/B B/BL B/BL B/R W/N Y/W W/B Y/W W/R Y/W B BL/LR BL/Y B/BL B/BL Y/G W/Gr Y/W W/G BL/W O/B N/R LR B B/R W/Y LR/B Y/P Gr/R P/N LG/W B W/B BL/W G/P W/R W/Gr Y/G G/BL BL/LR W/G LG B/BL B/W W/N BL/Y B/P N LR/N LR/G N/O Gr W LR/W B B G/Y P/W N/O Gr/R B Y/Gr LR/W LR/G B/P B/BL Rectifier 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Battery 1#2 Rollover sensor Water temperature sensor 8 9 10 1112 1314 15 16 17 18 1#Gr ECU J1 1#1 Fuel Injector Fuel pump MAP sensor Ignition coils Oxygen sensor Pickup Intake air coil temperature sensor 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 9 10 1112 1314 15 16 17 18 R 7 8 9 10 1112 1314 15 16 17 18 1#BLACK ECU J2 Gear position sensor BL/W N/B ABS Y P Alternator Fuel level sensor R/W - 492 - CO W W N/B O LR/G R T O M Headlamp controller G Orange Rear right turn signal lamp R/W Y/W Diagnosis terminal N Green P B ECU main relay Brown Carbon canister valve B N/P ABS diagnosis terminal LBL R B A K E Horn Fuel pump relay BL Ligt blue I N A LG/W Headlight relay B Blue TPS sensor B/BL Y A W Front left turn signal lamp BL/Y .A S S Head lamp R/W im D - LG/W Diode Front right turn signal lamp CODE Black N/O LR/G LR/N W LR/W B/W R/BL G/B R/W B/N R/W G/Gr Gr/R B Gr G/W BL N/B O/B COLOR Instrument gear indication s o i r it ABS Headlight Y/R Idle stepping motor Ka Fuse box ABS R/W is n ra k -d Circuit Diagram of BJ400-8 (electronic injection version, exported)